1 ==============================
2 LLVM Language Reference Manual
3 ==============================
12 This document is a reference manual for the LLVM assembly language. LLVM
13 is a Static Single Assignment (SSA) based representation that provides
14 type safety, low-level operations, flexibility, and the capability of
15 representing 'all' high-level languages cleanly. It is the common code
16 representation used throughout all phases of the LLVM compilation
22 The LLVM code representation is designed to be used in three different
23 forms: as an in-memory compiler IR, as an on-disk bitcode representation
24 (suitable for fast loading by a Just-In-Time compiler), and as a human
25 readable assembly language representation. This allows LLVM to provide a
26 powerful intermediate representation for efficient compiler
27 transformations and analysis, while providing a natural means to debug
28 and visualize the transformations. The three different forms of LLVM are
29 all equivalent. This document describes the human readable
30 representation and notation.
32 The LLVM representation aims to be light-weight and low-level while
33 being expressive, typed, and extensible at the same time. It aims to be
34 a "universal IR" of sorts, by being at a low enough level that
35 high-level ideas may be cleanly mapped to it (similar to how
36 microprocessors are "universal IR's", allowing many source languages to
37 be mapped to them). By providing type information, LLVM can be used as
38 the target of optimizations: for example, through pointer analysis, it
39 can be proven that a C automatic variable is never accessed outside of
40 the current function, allowing it to be promoted to a simple SSA value
41 instead of a memory location.
48 It is important to note that this document describes 'well formed' LLVM
49 assembly language. There is a difference between what the parser accepts
50 and what is considered 'well formed'. For example, the following
51 instruction is syntactically okay, but not well formed:
57 because the definition of ``%x`` does not dominate all of its uses. The
58 LLVM infrastructure provides a verification pass that may be used to
59 verify that an LLVM module is well formed. This pass is automatically
60 run by the parser after parsing input assembly and by the optimizer
61 before it outputs bitcode. The violations pointed out by the verifier
62 pass indicate bugs in transformation passes or input to the parser.
69 LLVM identifiers come in two basic types: global and local. Global
70 identifiers (functions, global variables) begin with the ``'@'``
71 character. Local identifiers (register names, types) begin with the
72 ``'%'`` character. Additionally, there are three different formats for
73 identifiers, for different purposes:
75 #. Named values are represented as a string of characters with their
76 prefix. For example, ``%foo``, ``@DivisionByZero``,
77 ``%a.really.long.identifier``. The actual regular expression used is
78 '``[%@][-a-zA-Z$._][-a-zA-Z$._0-9]*``'. Identifiers that require other
79 characters in their names can be surrounded with quotes. Special
80 characters may be escaped using ``"\xx"`` where ``xx`` is the ASCII
81 code for the character in hexadecimal. In this way, any character can
82 be used in a name value, even quotes themselves. The ``"\01"`` prefix
83 can be used on global values to suppress mangling.
84 #. Unnamed values are represented as an unsigned numeric value with
85 their prefix. For example, ``%12``, ``@2``, ``%44``.
86 #. Constants, which are described in the section Constants_ below.
88 LLVM requires that values start with a prefix for two reasons: Compilers
89 don't need to worry about name clashes with reserved words, and the set
90 of reserved words may be expanded in the future without penalty.
91 Additionally, unnamed identifiers allow a compiler to quickly come up
92 with a temporary variable without having to avoid symbol table
95 Reserved words in LLVM are very similar to reserved words in other
96 languages. There are keywords for different opcodes ('``add``',
97 '``bitcast``', '``ret``', etc...), for primitive type names ('``void``',
98 '``i32``', etc...), and others. These reserved words cannot conflict
99 with variable names, because none of them start with a prefix character
100 (``'%'`` or ``'@'``).
102 Here is an example of LLVM code to multiply the integer variable
109 %result = mul i32 %X, 8
111 After strength reduction:
115 %result = shl i32 %X, 3
121 %0 = add i32 %X, %X ; yields i32:%0
122 %1 = add i32 %0, %0 ; yields i32:%1
123 %result = add i32 %1, %1
125 This last way of multiplying ``%X`` by 8 illustrates several important
126 lexical features of LLVM:
128 #. Comments are delimited with a '``;``' and go until the end of line.
129 #. Unnamed temporaries are created when the result of a computation is
130 not assigned to a named value.
131 #. Unnamed temporaries are numbered sequentially (using a per-function
132 incrementing counter, starting with 0). Note that basic blocks and unnamed
133 function parameters are included in this numbering. For example, if the
134 entry basic block is not given a label name and all function parameters are
135 named, then it will get number 0.
137 It also shows a convention that we follow in this document. When
138 demonstrating instructions, we will follow an instruction with a comment
139 that defines the type and name of value produced.
147 LLVM programs are composed of ``Module``'s, each of which is a
148 translation unit of the input programs. Each module consists of
149 functions, global variables, and symbol table entries. Modules may be
150 combined together with the LLVM linker, which merges function (and
151 global variable) definitions, resolves forward declarations, and merges
152 symbol table entries. Here is an example of the "hello world" module:
156 ; Declare the string constant as a global constant.
157 @.str = private unnamed_addr constant [13 x i8] c"hello world\0A\00"
159 ; External declaration of the puts function
160 declare i32 @puts(i8* nocapture) nounwind
162 ; Definition of main function
163 define i32 @main() { ; i32()*
164 ; Convert [13 x i8]* to i8*...
165 %cast210 = getelementptr [13 x i8], [13 x i8]* @.str, i64 0, i64 0
167 ; Call puts function to write out the string to stdout.
168 call i32 @puts(i8* %cast210)
173 !0 = !{i32 42, null, !"string"}
176 This example is made up of a :ref:`global variable <globalvars>` named
177 "``.str``", an external declaration of the "``puts``" function, a
178 :ref:`function definition <functionstructure>` for "``main``" and
179 :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` "``foo``".
181 In general, a module is made up of a list of global values (where both
182 functions and global variables are global values). Global values are
183 represented by a pointer to a memory location (in this case, a pointer
184 to an array of char, and a pointer to a function), and have one of the
185 following :ref:`linkage types <linkage>`.
192 All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following types of
196 Global values with "``private``" linkage are only directly
197 accessible by objects in the current module. In particular, linking
198 code into a module with a private global value may cause the
199 private to be renamed as necessary to avoid collisions. Because the
200 symbol is private to the module, all references can be updated. This
201 doesn't show up in any symbol table in the object file.
203 Similar to private, but the value shows as a local symbol
204 (``STB_LOCAL`` in the case of ELF) in the object file. This
205 corresponds to the notion of the '``static``' keyword in C.
206 ``available_externally``
207 Globals with "``available_externally``" linkage are never emitted into
208 the object file corresponding to the LLVM module. From the linker's
209 perspective, an ``available_externally`` global is equivalent to
210 an external declaration. They exist to allow inlining and other
211 optimizations to take place given knowledge of the definition of the
212 global, which is known to be somewhere outside the module. Globals
213 with ``available_externally`` linkage are allowed to be discarded at
214 will, and allow inlining and other optimizations. This linkage type is
215 only allowed on definitions, not declarations.
217 Globals with "``linkonce``" linkage are merged with other globals of
218 the same name when linkage occurs. This can be used to implement
219 some forms of inline functions, templates, or other code which must
220 be generated in each translation unit that uses it, but where the
221 body may be overridden with a more definitive definition later.
222 Unreferenced ``linkonce`` globals are allowed to be discarded. Note
223 that ``linkonce`` linkage does not actually allow the optimizer to
224 inline the body of this function into callers because it doesn't
225 know if this definition of the function is the definitive definition
226 within the program or whether it will be overridden by a stronger
227 definition. To enable inlining and other optimizations, use
228 "``linkonce_odr``" linkage.
230 "``weak``" linkage has the same merging semantics as ``linkonce``
231 linkage, except that unreferenced globals with ``weak`` linkage may
232 not be discarded. This is used for globals that are declared "weak"
235 "``common``" linkage is most similar to "``weak``" linkage, but they
236 are used for tentative definitions in C, such as "``int X;``" at
237 global scope. Symbols with "``common``" linkage are merged in the
238 same way as ``weak symbols``, and they may not be deleted if
239 unreferenced. ``common`` symbols may not have an explicit section,
240 must have a zero initializer, and may not be marked
241 ':ref:`constant <globalvars>`'. Functions and aliases may not have
244 .. _linkage_appending:
247 "``appending``" linkage may only be applied to global variables of
248 pointer to array type. When two global variables with appending
249 linkage are linked together, the two global arrays are appended
250 together. This is the LLVM, typesafe, equivalent of having the
251 system linker append together "sections" with identical names when
254 Unfortunately this doesn't correspond to any feature in .o files, so it
255 can only be used for variables like ``llvm.global_ctors`` which llvm
256 interprets specially.
259 The semantics of this linkage follow the ELF object file model: the
260 symbol is weak until linked, if not linked, the symbol becomes null
261 instead of being an undefined reference.
262 ``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``
263 Some languages allow differing globals to be merged, such as two
264 functions with different semantics. Other languages, such as
265 ``C++``, ensure that only equivalent globals are ever merged (the
266 "one definition rule" --- "ODR"). Such languages can use the
267 ``linkonce_odr`` and ``weak_odr`` linkage types to indicate that the
268 global will only be merged with equivalent globals. These linkage
269 types are otherwise the same as their non-``odr`` versions.
271 If none of the above identifiers are used, the global is externally
272 visible, meaning that it participates in linkage and can be used to
273 resolve external symbol references.
275 It is illegal for a function *declaration* to have any linkage type
276 other than ``external`` or ``extern_weak``.
283 LLVM :ref:`functions <functionstructure>`, :ref:`calls <i_call>` and
284 :ref:`invokes <i_invoke>` can all have an optional calling convention
285 specified for the call. The calling convention of any pair of dynamic
286 caller/callee must match, or the behavior of the program is undefined.
287 The following calling conventions are supported by LLVM, and more may be
290 "``ccc``" - The C calling convention
291 This calling convention (the default if no other calling convention
292 is specified) matches the target C calling conventions. This calling
293 convention supports varargs function calls and tolerates some
294 mismatch in the declared prototype and implemented declaration of
295 the function (as does normal C).
296 "``fastcc``" - The fast calling convention
297 This calling convention attempts to make calls as fast as possible
298 (e.g. by passing things in registers). This calling convention
299 allows the target to use whatever tricks it wants to produce fast
300 code for the target, without having to conform to an externally
301 specified ABI (Application Binary Interface). `Tail calls can only
302 be optimized when this, the GHC or the HiPE convention is
303 used. <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ This calling convention does not
304 support varargs and requires the prototype of all callees to exactly
305 match the prototype of the function definition.
306 "``coldcc``" - The cold calling convention
307 This calling convention attempts to make code in the caller as
308 efficient as possible under the assumption that the call is not
309 commonly executed. As such, these calls often preserve all registers
310 so that the call does not break any live ranges in the caller side.
311 This calling convention does not support varargs and requires the
312 prototype of all callees to exactly match the prototype of the
313 function definition. Furthermore the inliner doesn't consider such function
315 "``cc 10``" - GHC convention
316 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
317 the `Glasgow Haskell Compiler (GHC) <http://www.haskell.org/ghc>`_.
318 It passes everything in registers, going to extremes to achieve this
319 by disabling callee save registers. This calling convention should
320 not be used lightly but only for specific situations such as an
321 alternative to the *register pinning* performance technique often
322 used when implementing functional programming languages. At the
323 moment only X86 supports this convention and it has the following
326 - On *X86-32* only supports up to 4 bit type parameters. No
327 floating-point types are supported.
328 - On *X86-64* only supports up to 10 bit type parameters and 6
329 floating-point parameters.
331 This calling convention supports `tail call
332 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires both the
333 caller and callee are using it.
334 "``cc 11``" - The HiPE calling convention
335 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
336 the `High-Performance Erlang
337 (HiPE) <http://www.it.uu.se/research/group/hipe/>`_ compiler, *the*
338 native code compiler of the `Ericsson's Open Source Erlang/OTP
339 system <http://www.erlang.org/download.shtml>`_. It uses more
340 registers for argument passing than the ordinary C calling
341 convention and defines no callee-saved registers. The calling
342 convention properly supports `tail call
343 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires that both the
344 caller and the callee use it. It uses a *register pinning*
345 mechanism, similar to GHC's convention, for keeping frequently
346 accessed runtime components pinned to specific hardware registers.
347 At the moment only X86 supports this convention (both 32 and 64
349 "``webkit_jscc``" - WebKit's JavaScript calling convention
350 This calling convention has been implemented for `WebKit FTL JIT
351 <https://trac.webkit.org/wiki/FTLJIT>`_. It passes arguments on the
352 stack right to left (as cdecl does), and returns a value in the
353 platform's customary return register.
354 "``anyregcc``" - Dynamic calling convention for code patching
355 This is a special convention that supports patching an arbitrary code
356 sequence in place of a call site. This convention forces the call
357 arguments into registers but allows them to be dynamically
358 allocated. This can currently only be used with calls to
359 llvm.experimental.patchpoint because only this intrinsic records
360 the location of its arguments in a side table. See :doc:`StackMaps`.
361 "``preserve_mostcc``" - The `PreserveMost` calling convention
362 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller as
363 unintrusive as possible. This convention behaves identically to the `C`
364 calling convention on how arguments and return values are passed, but it
365 uses a different set of caller/callee-saved registers. This alleviates the
366 burden of saving and recovering a large register set before and after the
367 call in the caller. If the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers,
368 then they will be preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't
369 apply for values returned in callee-saved registers.
371 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
372 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Floating-point registers
373 (XMMs/YMMs) are not preserved and need to be saved by the caller.
375 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
376 that have a hot path and a cold path. The hot path is usually a small piece
377 of code that doesn't use many registers. The cold path might need to call out to
378 another function and therefore only needs to preserve the caller-saved
379 registers, which haven't already been saved by the caller. The
380 `PreserveMost` calling convention is very similar to the `cold` calling
381 convention in terms of caller/callee-saved registers, but they are used for
382 different types of function calls. `coldcc` is for function calls that are
383 rarely executed, whereas `preserve_mostcc` function calls are intended to be
384 on the hot path and definitely executed a lot. Furthermore `preserve_mostcc`
385 doesn't prevent the inliner from inlining the function call.
387 This calling convention will be used by a future version of the ObjectiveC
388 runtime and should therefore still be considered experimental at this time.
389 Although this convention was created to optimize certain runtime calls to
390 the ObjectiveC runtime, it is not limited to this runtime and might be used
391 by other runtimes in the future too. The current implementation only
392 supports X86-64, but the intention is to support more architectures in the
394 "``preserve_allcc``" - The `PreserveAll` calling convention
395 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller even less
396 intrusive than the `PreserveMost` calling convention. This calling
397 convention also behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on how
398 arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
399 caller/callee-saved registers. This removes the burden of saving and
400 recovering a large register set before and after the call in the caller. If
401 the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers, then they will be
402 preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't apply for values
403 returned in callee-saved registers.
405 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
406 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Furthermore it also preserves
407 all floating-point registers (XMMs/YMMs).
409 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
410 that don't need to call out to any other functions.
412 This calling convention, like the `PreserveMost` calling convention, will be
413 used by a future version of the ObjectiveC runtime and should be considered
414 experimental at this time.
415 "``cxx_fast_tlscc``" - The `CXX_FAST_TLS` calling convention for access functions
416 Clang generates an access function to access C++-style TLS. The access
417 function generally has an entry block, an exit block and an initialization
418 block that is run at the first time. The entry and exit blocks can access
419 a few TLS IR variables, each access will be lowered to a platform-specific
422 This calling convention aims to minimize overhead in the caller by
423 preserving as many registers as possible (all the registers that are
424 preserved on the fast path, composed of the entry and exit blocks).
426 This calling convention behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on
427 how arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
428 caller/callee-saved registers.
430 Given that each platform has its own lowering sequence, hence its own set
431 of preserved registers, we can't use the existing `PreserveMost`.
433 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
435 "``swiftcc``" - This calling convention is used for Swift language.
436 - On X86-64 RCX and R8 are available for additional integer returns, and
437 XMM2 and XMM3 are available for additional FP/vector returns.
438 - On iOS platforms, we use AAPCS-VFP calling convention.
439 "``cc <n>``" - Numbered convention
440 Any calling convention may be specified by number, allowing
441 target-specific calling conventions to be used. Target specific
442 calling conventions start at 64.
444 More calling conventions can be added/defined on an as-needed basis, to
445 support Pascal conventions or any other well-known target-independent
448 .. _visibilitystyles:
453 All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following visibility
456 "``default``" - Default style
457 On targets that use the ELF object file format, default visibility
458 means that the declaration is visible to other modules and, in
459 shared libraries, means that the declared entity may be overridden.
460 On Darwin, default visibility means that the declaration is visible
461 to other modules. Default visibility corresponds to "external
462 linkage" in the language.
463 "``hidden``" - Hidden style
464 Two declarations of an object with hidden visibility refer to the
465 same object if they are in the same shared object. Usually, hidden
466 visibility indicates that the symbol will not be placed into the
467 dynamic symbol table, so no other module (executable or shared
468 library) can reference it directly.
469 "``protected``" - Protected style
470 On ELF, protected visibility indicates that the symbol will be
471 placed in the dynamic symbol table, but that references within the
472 defining module will bind to the local symbol. That is, the symbol
473 cannot be overridden by another module.
475 A symbol with ``internal`` or ``private`` linkage must have ``default``
483 All Global Variables, Functions and Aliases can have one of the following
487 "``dllimport``" causes the compiler to reference a function or variable via
488 a global pointer to a pointer that is set up by the DLL exporting the
489 symbol. On Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by
490 combining ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name.
492 "``dllexport``" causes the compiler to provide a global pointer to a pointer
493 in a DLL, so that it can be referenced with the ``dllimport`` attribute. On
494 Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by combining
495 ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name. Since this storage class
496 exists for defining a dll interface, the compiler, assembler and linker know
497 it is externally referenced and must refrain from deleting the symbol.
501 Thread Local Storage Models
502 ---------------------------
504 A variable may be defined as ``thread_local``, which means that it will
505 not be shared by threads (each thread will have a separated copy of the
506 variable). Not all targets support thread-local variables. Optionally, a
507 TLS model may be specified:
510 For variables that are only used within the current shared library.
512 For variables in modules that will not be loaded dynamically.
514 For variables defined in the executable and only used within it.
516 If no explicit model is given, the "general dynamic" model is used.
518 The models correspond to the ELF TLS models; see `ELF Handling For
519 Thread-Local Storage <http://people.redhat.com/drepper/tls.pdf>`_ for
520 more information on under which circumstances the different models may
521 be used. The target may choose a different TLS model if the specified
522 model is not supported, or if a better choice of model can be made.
524 A model can also be specified in an alias, but then it only governs how
525 the alias is accessed. It will not have any effect in the aliasee.
527 For platforms without linker support of ELF TLS model, the -femulated-tls
528 flag can be used to generate GCC compatible emulated TLS code.
530 .. _runtime_preemption_model:
532 Runtime Preemption Specifiers
533 -----------------------------
535 Global variables, functions and aliases may have an optional runtime preemption
536 specifier. If a preemption specifier isn't given explicitly, then a
537 symbol is assumed to be ``dso_preemptable``.
540 Indicates that the function or variable may be replaced by a symbol from
541 outside the linkage unit at runtime.
544 The compiler may assume that a function or variable marked as ``dso_local``
545 will resolve to a symbol within the same linkage unit. Direct access will
546 be generated even if the definition is not within this compilation unit.
553 LLVM IR allows you to specify both "identified" and "literal" :ref:`structure
554 types <t_struct>`. Literal types are uniqued structurally, but identified types
555 are never uniqued. An :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>` can also be used
556 to forward declare a type that is not yet available.
558 An example of an identified structure specification is:
562 %mytype = type { %mytype*, i32 }
564 Prior to the LLVM 3.0 release, identified types were structurally uniqued. Only
565 literal types are uniqued in recent versions of LLVM.
569 Non-Integral Pointer Type
570 -------------------------
572 Note: non-integral pointer types are a work in progress, and they should be
573 considered experimental at this time.
575 LLVM IR optionally allows the frontend to denote pointers in certain address
576 spaces as "non-integral" via the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>`.
577 Non-integral pointer types represent pointers that have an *unspecified* bitwise
578 representation; that is, the integral representation may be target dependent or
579 unstable (not backed by a fixed integer).
581 ``inttoptr`` instructions converting integers to non-integral pointer types are
582 ill-typed, and so are ``ptrtoint`` instructions converting values of
583 non-integral pointer types to integers. Vector versions of said instructions
584 are ill-typed as well.
591 Global variables define regions of memory allocated at compilation time
594 Global variable definitions must be initialized.
596 Global variables in other translation units can also be declared, in which
597 case they don't have an initializer.
599 Either global variable definitions or declarations may have an explicit section
600 to be placed in and may have an optional explicit alignment specified. If there
601 is a mismatch between the explicit or inferred section information for the
602 variable declaration and its definition the resulting behavior is undefined.
604 A variable may be defined as a global ``constant``, which indicates that
605 the contents of the variable will **never** be modified (enabling better
606 optimization, allowing the global data to be placed in the read-only
607 section of an executable, etc). Note that variables that need runtime
608 initialization cannot be marked ``constant`` as there is a store to the
611 LLVM explicitly allows *declarations* of global variables to be marked
612 constant, even if the final definition of the global is not. This
613 capability can be used to enable slightly better optimization of the
614 program, but requires the language definition to guarantee that
615 optimizations based on the 'constantness' are valid for the translation
616 units that do not include the definition.
618 As SSA values, global variables define pointer values that are in scope
619 (i.e. they dominate) all basic blocks in the program. Global variables
620 always define a pointer to their "content" type because they describe a
621 region of memory, and all memory objects in LLVM are accessed through
624 Global variables can be marked with ``unnamed_addr`` which indicates
625 that the address is not significant, only the content. Constants marked
626 like this can be merged with other constants if they have the same
627 initializer. Note that a constant with significant address *can* be
628 merged with a ``unnamed_addr`` constant, the result being a constant
629 whose address is significant.
631 If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
632 not be significant within the module.
634 A global variable may be declared to reside in a target-specific
635 numbered address space. For targets that support them, address spaces
636 may affect how optimizations are performed and/or what target
637 instructions are used to access the variable. The default address space
638 is zero. The address space qualifier must precede any other attributes.
640 LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for globals. If the
641 target supports it, it will emit globals to the section specified.
642 Additionally, the global can placed in a comdat if the target has the necessary
645 External declarations may have an explicit section specified. Section
646 information is retained in LLVM IR for targets that make use of this
647 information. Attaching section information to an external declaration is an
648 assertion that its definition is located in the specified section. If the
649 definition is located in a different section, the behavior is undefined.
651 By default, global initializers are optimized by assuming that global
652 variables defined within the module are not modified from their
653 initial values before the start of the global initializer. This is
654 true even for variables potentially accessible from outside the
655 module, including those with external linkage or appearing in
656 ``@llvm.used`` or dllexported variables. This assumption may be suppressed
657 by marking the variable with ``externally_initialized``.
659 An explicit alignment may be specified for a global, which must be a
660 power of 2. If not present, or if the alignment is set to zero, the
661 alignment of the global is set by the target to whatever it feels
662 convenient. If an explicit alignment is specified, the global is forced
663 to have exactly that alignment. Targets and optimizers are not allowed
664 to over-align the global if the global has an assigned section. In this
665 case, the extra alignment could be observable: for example, code could
666 assume that the globals are densely packed in their section and try to
667 iterate over them as an array, alignment padding would break this
668 iteration. The maximum alignment is ``1 << 29``.
670 Globals can also have a :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
671 an optional :ref:`runtime preemption specifier <runtime_preemption_model>`,
672 an optional :ref:`global attributes <glattrs>` and
673 an optional list of attached :ref:`metadata <metadata>`.
675 Variables and aliases can have a
676 :ref:`Thread Local Storage Model <tls_model>`.
678 :ref:`Scalable vectors <t_vector>` cannot be global variables or members of
679 structs or arrays because their size is unknown at compile time.
683 @<GlobalVarName> = [Linkage] [PreemptionSpecifier] [Visibility]
684 [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal]
685 [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] [AddrSpace]
686 [ExternallyInitialized]
687 <global | constant> <Type> [<InitializerConstant>]
688 [, section "name"] [, comdat [($name)]]
689 [, align <Alignment>] (, !name !N)*
691 For example, the following defines a global in a numbered address space
692 with an initializer, section, and alignment:
696 @G = addrspace(5) constant float 1.0, section "foo", align 4
698 The following example just declares a global variable
702 @G = external global i32
704 The following example defines a thread-local global with the
705 ``initialexec`` TLS model:
709 @G = thread_local(initialexec) global i32 0, align 4
711 .. _functionstructure:
716 LLVM function definitions consist of the "``define``" keyword, an
717 optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`runtime preemption
718 specifier <runtime_preemption_model>`, an optional :ref:`visibility
719 style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
720 an optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`,
721 an optional ``unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional
722 :ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function
723 name, a (possibly empty) argument list (each with optional :ref:`parameter
724 attributes <paramattrs>`), optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>`,
725 an optional address space, an optional section, an optional alignment,
726 an optional :ref:`comdat <langref_comdats>`,
727 an optional :ref:`garbage collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`,
728 an optional :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`,
729 an optional :ref:`personality <personalityfn>`,
730 an optional list of attached :ref:`metadata <metadata>`,
731 an opening curly brace, a list of basic blocks, and a closing curly brace.
733 LLVM function declarations consist of the "``declare``" keyword, an
734 optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`visibility style
735 <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`, an
736 optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`, an optional ``unnamed_addr``
737 or ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute, an optional address space, a return type,
738 an optional :ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function name, a possibly
739 empty list of arguments, an optional alignment, an optional :ref:`garbage
740 collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`, and an optional
741 :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`.
743 A function definition contains a list of basic blocks, forming the CFG (Control
744 Flow Graph) for the function. Each basic block may optionally start with a label
745 (giving the basic block a symbol table entry), contains a list of instructions,
746 and ends with a :ref:`terminator <terminators>` instruction (such as a branch or
747 function return). If an explicit label name is not provided, a block is assigned
748 an implicit numbered label, using the next value from the same counter as used
749 for unnamed temporaries (:ref:`see above<identifiers>`). For example, if a
750 function entry block does not have an explicit label, it will be assigned label
751 "%0", then the first unnamed temporary in that block will be "%1", etc. If a
752 numeric label is explicitly specified, it must match the numeric label that
753 would be used implicitly.
755 The first basic block in a function is special in two ways: it is
756 immediately executed on entrance to the function, and it is not allowed
757 to have predecessor basic blocks (i.e. there can not be any branches to
758 the entry block of a function). Because the block can have no
759 predecessors, it also cannot have any :ref:`PHI nodes <i_phi>`.
761 LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for functions. If the
762 target supports it, it will emit functions to the section specified.
763 Additionally, the function can be placed in a COMDAT.
765 An explicit alignment may be specified for a function. If not present,
766 or if the alignment is set to zero, the alignment of the function is set
767 by the target to whatever it feels convenient. If an explicit alignment
768 is specified, the function is forced to have at least that much
769 alignment. All alignments must be a power of 2.
771 If the ``unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to not
772 be significant and two identical functions can be merged.
774 If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
775 not be significant within the module.
777 If an explicit address space is not given, it will default to the program
778 address space from the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>`.
782 define [linkage] [PreemptionSpecifier] [visibility] [DLLStorageClass]
784 <ResultType> @<FunctionName> ([argument list])
785 [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] [AddrSpace] [fn Attrs]
786 [section "name"] [comdat [($name)]] [align N] [gc] [prefix Constant]
787 [prologue Constant] [personality Constant] (!name !N)* { ... }
789 The argument list is a comma separated sequence of arguments where each
790 argument is of the following form:
794 <type> [parameter Attrs] [name]
802 Aliases, unlike function or variables, don't create any new data. They
803 are just a new symbol and metadata for an existing position.
805 Aliases have a name and an aliasee that is either a global value or a
808 Aliases may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional
809 :ref:`runtime preemption specifier <runtime_preemption_model>`, an optional
810 :ref:`visibility style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class
811 <dllstorageclass>` and an optional :ref:`tls model <tls_model>`.
815 @<Name> = [Linkage] [PreemptionSpecifier] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal] [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] alias <AliaseeTy>, <AliaseeTy>* @<Aliasee>
817 The linkage must be one of ``private``, ``internal``, ``linkonce``, ``weak``,
818 ``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``, ``external``. Note that some system linkers
819 might not correctly handle dropping a weak symbol that is aliased.
821 Aliases that are not ``unnamed_addr`` are guaranteed to have the same address as
822 the aliasee expression. ``unnamed_addr`` ones are only guaranteed to point
825 If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
826 not be significant within the module.
828 Since aliases are only a second name, some restrictions apply, of which
829 some can only be checked when producing an object file:
831 * The expression defining the aliasee must be computable at assembly
832 time. Since it is just a name, no relocations can be used.
834 * No alias in the expression can be weak as the possibility of the
835 intermediate alias being overridden cannot be represented in an
838 * No global value in the expression can be a declaration, since that
839 would require a relocation, which is not possible.
846 IFuncs, like as aliases, don't create any new data or func. They are just a new
847 symbol that dynamic linker resolves at runtime by calling a resolver function.
849 IFuncs have a name and a resolver that is a function called by dynamic linker
850 that returns address of another function associated with the name.
852 IFunc may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>` and an optional
853 :ref:`visibility style <visibility>`.
857 @<Name> = [Linkage] [Visibility] ifunc <IFuncTy>, <ResolverTy>* @<Resolver>
865 Comdat IR provides access to COFF and ELF object file COMDAT functionality.
867 Comdats have a name which represents the COMDAT key. All global objects that
868 specify this key will only end up in the final object file if the linker chooses
869 that key over some other key. Aliases are placed in the same COMDAT that their
870 aliasee computes to, if any.
872 Comdats have a selection kind to provide input on how the linker should
873 choose between keys in two different object files.
877 $<Name> = comdat SelectionKind
879 The selection kind must be one of the following:
882 The linker may choose any COMDAT key, the choice is arbitrary.
884 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
887 The linker will choose the section containing the largest COMDAT key.
889 The linker requires that only section with this COMDAT key exist.
891 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
894 Note that the Mach-O platform doesn't support COMDATs, and ELF and WebAssembly
895 only support ``any`` as a selection kind.
897 Here is an example of a COMDAT group where a function will only be selected if
898 the COMDAT key's section is the largest:
902 $foo = comdat largest
903 @foo = global i32 2, comdat($foo)
905 define void @bar() comdat($foo) {
909 As a syntactic sugar the ``$name`` can be omitted if the name is the same as
915 @foo = global i32 2, comdat
918 In a COFF object file, this will create a COMDAT section with selection kind
919 ``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_LARGEST`` containing the contents of the ``@foo`` symbol
920 and another COMDAT section with selection kind
921 ``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_ASSOCIATIVE`` which is associated with the first COMDAT
922 section and contains the contents of the ``@bar`` symbol.
924 There are some restrictions on the properties of the global object.
925 It, or an alias to it, must have the same name as the COMDAT group when
927 The contents and size of this object may be used during link-time to determine
928 which COMDAT groups get selected depending on the selection kind.
929 Because the name of the object must match the name of the COMDAT group, the
930 linkage of the global object must not be local; local symbols can get renamed
931 if a collision occurs in the symbol table.
933 The combined use of COMDATS and section attributes may yield surprising results.
940 @g1 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($foo)
941 @g2 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($bar)
943 From the object file perspective, this requires the creation of two sections
944 with the same name. This is necessary because both globals belong to different
945 COMDAT groups and COMDATs, at the object file level, are represented by
948 Note that certain IR constructs like global variables and functions may
949 create COMDATs in the object file in addition to any which are specified using
950 COMDAT IR. This arises when the code generator is configured to emit globals
951 in individual sections (e.g. when `-data-sections` or `-function-sections`
952 is supplied to `llc`).
954 .. _namedmetadatastructure:
959 Named metadata is a collection of metadata. :ref:`Metadata
960 nodes <metadata>` (but not metadata strings) are the only valid
961 operands for a named metadata.
963 #. Named metadata are represented as a string of characters with the
964 metadata prefix. The rules for metadata names are the same as for
965 identifiers, but quoted names are not allowed. ``"\xx"`` type escapes
966 are still valid, which allows any character to be part of a name.
970 ; Some unnamed metadata nodes, which are referenced by the named metadata.
975 !name = !{!0, !1, !2}
982 The return type and each parameter of a function type may have a set of
983 *parameter attributes* associated with them. Parameter attributes are
984 used to communicate additional information about the result or
985 parameters of a function. Parameter attributes are considered to be part
986 of the function, not of the function type, so functions with different
987 parameter attributes can have the same function type.
989 Parameter attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
990 If multiple parameter attributes are needed, they are space separated.
995 declare i32 @printf(i8* noalias nocapture, ...)
996 declare i32 @atoi(i8 zeroext)
997 declare signext i8 @returns_signed_char()
999 Note that any attributes for the function result (``nounwind``,
1000 ``readonly``) come immediately after the argument list.
1002 Currently, only the following parameter attributes are defined:
1005 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
1006 value should be zero-extended to the extent required by the target's
1007 ABI by the caller (for a parameter) or the callee (for a return value).
1009 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
1010 value should be sign-extended to the extent required by the target's
1011 ABI (which is usually 32-bits) by the caller (for a parameter) or
1012 the callee (for a return value).
1014 This indicates that this parameter or return value should be treated
1015 in a special target-dependent fashion while emitting code for
1016 a function call or return (usually, by putting it in a register as
1017 opposed to memory, though some targets use it to distinguish between
1018 two different kinds of registers). Use of this attribute is
1020 ``byval`` or ``byval(<ty>)``
1021 This indicates that the pointer parameter should really be passed by
1022 value to the function. The attribute implies that a hidden copy of
1023 the pointee is made between the caller and the callee, so the callee
1024 is unable to modify the value in the caller. This attribute is only
1025 valid on LLVM pointer arguments. It is generally used to pass
1026 structs and arrays by value, but is also valid on pointers to
1027 scalars. The copy is considered to belong to the caller not the
1028 callee (for example, ``readonly`` functions should not write to
1029 ``byval`` parameters). This is not a valid attribute for return
1032 The byval attribute also supports an optional type argument, which must be
1033 the same as the pointee type of the argument.
1035 The byval attribute also supports specifying an alignment with the
1036 align attribute. It indicates the alignment of the stack slot to
1037 form and the known alignment of the pointer specified to the call
1038 site. If the alignment is not specified, then the code generator
1039 makes a target-specific assumption.
1045 The ``inalloca`` argument attribute allows the caller to take the
1046 address of outgoing stack arguments. An ``inalloca`` argument must
1047 be a pointer to stack memory produced by an ``alloca`` instruction.
1048 The alloca, or argument allocation, must also be tagged with the
1049 inalloca keyword. Only the last argument may have the ``inalloca``
1050 attribute, and that argument is guaranteed to be passed in memory.
1052 An argument allocation may be used by a call at most once because
1053 the call may deallocate it. The ``inalloca`` attribute cannot be
1054 used in conjunction with other attributes that affect argument
1055 storage, like ``inreg``, ``nest``, ``sret``, or ``byval``. The
1056 ``inalloca`` attribute also disables LLVM's implicit lowering of
1057 large aggregate return values, which means that frontend authors
1058 must lower them with ``sret`` pointers.
1060 When the call site is reached, the argument allocation must have
1061 been the most recent stack allocation that is still live, or the
1062 behavior is undefined. It is possible to allocate additional stack
1063 space after an argument allocation and before its call site, but it
1064 must be cleared off with :ref:`llvm.stackrestore
1065 <int_stackrestore>`.
1067 See :doc:`InAlloca` for more information on how to use this
1071 This indicates that the pointer parameter specifies the address of a
1072 structure that is the return value of the function in the source
1073 program. This pointer must be guaranteed by the caller to be valid:
1074 loads and stores to the structure may be assumed by the callee not
1075 to trap and to be properly aligned. This is not a valid attribute
1081 This indicates that the pointer value may be assumed by the optimizer to
1082 have the specified alignment. If the pointer value does not have the
1083 specified alignment, behavior is undefined.
1085 Note that this attribute has additional semantics when combined with the
1086 ``byval`` attribute, which are documented there.
1091 This indicates that objects accessed via pointer values
1092 :ref:`based <pointeraliasing>` on the argument or return value are not also
1093 accessed, during the execution of the function, via pointer values not
1094 *based* on the argument or return value. The attribute on a return value
1095 also has additional semantics described below. The caller shares the
1096 responsibility with the callee for ensuring that these requirements are met.
1097 For further details, please see the discussion of the NoAlias response in
1098 :ref:`alias analysis <Must, May, or No>`.
1100 Note that this definition of ``noalias`` is intentionally similar
1101 to the definition of ``restrict`` in C99 for function arguments.
1103 For function return values, C99's ``restrict`` is not meaningful,
1104 while LLVM's ``noalias`` is. Furthermore, the semantics of the ``noalias``
1105 attribute on return values are stronger than the semantics of the attribute
1106 when used on function arguments. On function return values, the ``noalias``
1107 attribute indicates that the function acts like a system memory allocation
1108 function, returning a pointer to allocated storage disjoint from the
1109 storage for any other object accessible to the caller.
1112 This indicates that the callee does not make any copies of the
1113 pointer that outlive the callee itself. This is not a valid
1114 attribute for return values. Addresses used in volatile operations
1115 are considered to be captured.
1120 This indicates that the pointer parameter can be excised using the
1121 :ref:`trampoline intrinsics <int_trampoline>`. This is not a valid
1122 attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
1125 This indicates that the function always returns the argument as its return
1126 value. This is a hint to the optimizer and code generator used when
1127 generating the caller, allowing value propagation, tail call optimization,
1128 and omission of register saves and restores in some cases; it is not
1129 checked or enforced when generating the callee. The parameter and the
1130 function return type must be valid operands for the
1131 :ref:`bitcast instruction <i_bitcast>`. This is not a valid attribute for
1132 return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
1135 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is not null. This
1136 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. This is not
1137 checked or enforced by LLVM; if the parameter or return pointer is null,
1138 the behavior is undefined.
1140 ``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1141 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is dereferenceable. This
1142 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. A pointer that
1143 is dereferenceable can be loaded from speculatively without a risk of
1144 trapping. The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable must be provided
1145 in parentheses. It is legal for the number of bytes to be less than the
1146 size of the pointee type. The ``nonnull`` attribute does not imply
1147 dereferenceability (consider a pointer to one element past the end of an
1148 array), however ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` does imply ``nonnull`` in
1149 ``addrspace(0)`` (which is the default address space).
1151 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1152 This indicates that the parameter or return value isn't both
1153 non-null and non-dereferenceable (up to ``<n>`` bytes) at the same
1154 time. All non-null pointers tagged with
1155 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` are ``dereferenceable(<n>)``.
1156 For address space 0 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` implies that
1157 a pointer is exactly one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` or ``null``,
1158 and in other address spaces ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1159 implies that a pointer is at least one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1160 or ``null`` (i.e. it may be both ``null`` and
1161 ``dereferenceable(<n>)``). This attribute may only be applied to
1162 pointer typed parameters.
1165 This indicates that the parameter is the self/context parameter. This is not
1166 a valid attribute for return values and can only be applied to one
1170 This attribute is motivated to model and optimize Swift error handling. It
1171 can be applied to a parameter with pointer to pointer type or a
1172 pointer-sized alloca. At the call site, the actual argument that corresponds
1173 to a ``swifterror`` parameter has to come from a ``swifterror`` alloca or
1174 the ``swifterror`` parameter of the caller. A ``swifterror`` value (either
1175 the parameter or the alloca) can only be loaded and stored from, or used as
1176 a ``swifterror`` argument. This is not a valid attribute for return values
1177 and can only be applied to one parameter.
1179 These constraints allow the calling convention to optimize access to
1180 ``swifterror`` variables by associating them with a specific register at
1181 call boundaries rather than placing them in memory. Since this does change
1182 the calling convention, a function which uses the ``swifterror`` attribute
1183 on a parameter is not ABI-compatible with one which does not.
1185 These constraints also allow LLVM to assume that a ``swifterror`` argument
1186 does not alias any other memory visible within a function and that a
1187 ``swifterror`` alloca passed as an argument does not escape.
1190 This indicates the parameter is required to be an immediate
1191 value. This must be a trivial immediate integer or floating-point
1192 constant. Undef or constant expressions are not valid. This is
1193 only valid on intrinsic declarations and cannot be applied to a
1194 call site or arbitrary function.
1198 Garbage Collector Strategy Names
1199 --------------------------------
1201 Each function may specify a garbage collector strategy name, which is simply a
1204 .. code-block:: llvm
1206 define void @f() gc "name" { ... }
1208 The supported values of *name* includes those :ref:`built in to LLVM
1209 <builtin-gc-strategies>` and any provided by loaded plugins. Specifying a GC
1210 strategy will cause the compiler to alter its output in order to support the
1211 named garbage collection algorithm. Note that LLVM itself does not contain a
1212 garbage collector, this functionality is restricted to generating machine code
1213 which can interoperate with a collector provided externally.
1220 Prefix data is data associated with a function which the code
1221 generator will emit immediately before the function's entrypoint.
1222 The purpose of this feature is to allow frontends to associate
1223 language-specific runtime metadata with specific functions and make it
1224 available through the function pointer while still allowing the
1225 function pointer to be called.
1227 To access the data for a given function, a program may bitcast the
1228 function pointer to a pointer to the constant's type and dereference
1229 index -1. This implies that the IR symbol points just past the end of
1230 the prefix data. For instance, take the example of a function annotated
1231 with a single ``i32``,
1233 .. code-block:: llvm
1235 define void @f() prefix i32 123 { ... }
1237 The prefix data can be referenced as,
1239 .. code-block:: llvm
1241 %0 = bitcast void* () @f to i32*
1242 %a = getelementptr inbounds i32, i32* %0, i32 -1
1243 %b = load i32, i32* %a
1245 Prefix data is laid out as if it were an initializer for a global variable
1246 of the prefix data's type. The function will be placed such that the
1247 beginning of the prefix data is aligned. This means that if the size
1248 of the prefix data is not a multiple of the alignment size, the
1249 function's entrypoint will not be aligned. If alignment of the
1250 function's entrypoint is desired, padding must be added to the prefix
1253 A function may have prefix data but no body. This has similar semantics
1254 to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1255 optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1262 The ``prologue`` attribute allows arbitrary code (encoded as bytes) to
1263 be inserted prior to the function body. This can be used for enabling
1264 function hot-patching and instrumentation.
1266 To maintain the semantics of ordinary function calls, the prologue data must
1267 have a particular format. Specifically, it must begin with a sequence of
1268 bytes which decode to a sequence of machine instructions, valid for the
1269 module's target, which transfer control to the point immediately succeeding
1270 the prologue data, without performing any other visible action. This allows
1271 the inliner and other passes to reason about the semantics of the function
1272 definition without needing to reason about the prologue data. Obviously this
1273 makes the format of the prologue data highly target dependent.
1275 A trivial example of valid prologue data for the x86 architecture is ``i8 144``,
1276 which encodes the ``nop`` instruction:
1278 .. code-block:: text
1280 define void @f() prologue i8 144 { ... }
1282 Generally prologue data can be formed by encoding a relative branch instruction
1283 which skips the metadata, as in this example of valid prologue data for the
1284 x86_64 architecture, where the first two bytes encode ``jmp .+10``:
1286 .. code-block:: text
1288 %0 = type <{ i8, i8, i8* }>
1290 define void @f() prologue %0 <{ i8 235, i8 8, i8* @md}> { ... }
1292 A function may have prologue data but no body. This has similar semantics
1293 to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1294 optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1298 Personality Function
1299 --------------------
1301 The ``personality`` attribute permits functions to specify what function
1302 to use for exception handling.
1309 Attribute groups are groups of attributes that are referenced by objects within
1310 the IR. They are important for keeping ``.ll`` files readable, because a lot of
1311 functions will use the same set of attributes. In the degenerative case of a
1312 ``.ll`` file that corresponds to a single ``.c`` file, the single attribute
1313 group will capture the important command line flags used to build that file.
1315 An attribute group is a module-level object. To use an attribute group, an
1316 object references the attribute group's ID (e.g. ``#37``). An object may refer
1317 to more than one attribute group. In that situation, the attributes from the
1318 different groups are merged.
1320 Here is an example of attribute groups for a function that should always be
1321 inlined, has a stack alignment of 4, and which shouldn't use SSE instructions:
1323 .. code-block:: llvm
1325 ; Target-independent attributes:
1326 attributes #0 = { alwaysinline alignstack=4 }
1328 ; Target-dependent attributes:
1329 attributes #1 = { "no-sse" }
1331 ; Function @f has attributes: alwaysinline, alignstack=4, and "no-sse".
1332 define void @f() #0 #1 { ... }
1339 Function attributes are set to communicate additional information about
1340 a function. Function attributes are considered to be part of the
1341 function, not of the function type, so functions with different function
1342 attributes can have the same function type.
1344 Function attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
1345 If multiple attributes are needed, they are space separated. For
1348 .. code-block:: llvm
1350 define void @f() noinline { ... }
1351 define void @f() alwaysinline { ... }
1352 define void @f() alwaysinline optsize { ... }
1353 define void @f() optsize { ... }
1356 This attribute indicates that, when emitting the prologue and
1357 epilogue, the backend should forcibly align the stack pointer.
1358 Specify the desired alignment, which must be a power of two, in
1360 ``allocsize(<EltSizeParam>[, <NumEltsParam>])``
1361 This attribute indicates that the annotated function will always return at
1362 least a given number of bytes (or null). Its arguments are zero-indexed
1363 parameter numbers; if one argument is provided, then it's assumed that at
1364 least ``CallSite.Args[EltSizeParam]`` bytes will be available at the
1365 returned pointer. If two are provided, then it's assumed that
1366 ``CallSite.Args[EltSizeParam] * CallSite.Args[NumEltsParam]`` bytes are
1367 available. The referenced parameters must be integer types. No assumptions
1368 are made about the contents of the returned block of memory.
1370 This attribute indicates that the inliner should attempt to inline
1371 this function into callers whenever possible, ignoring any active
1372 inlining size threshold for this caller.
1374 This indicates that the callee function at a call site should be
1375 recognized as a built-in function, even though the function's declaration
1376 uses the ``nobuiltin`` attribute. This is only valid at call sites for
1377 direct calls to functions that are declared with the ``nobuiltin``
1380 This attribute indicates that this function is rarely called. When
1381 computing edge weights, basic blocks post-dominated by a cold
1382 function call are also considered to be cold; and, thus, given low
1385 In some parallel execution models, there exist operations that cannot be
1386 made control-dependent on any additional values. We call such operations
1387 ``convergent``, and mark them with this attribute.
1389 The ``convergent`` attribute may appear on functions or call/invoke
1390 instructions. When it appears on a function, it indicates that calls to
1391 this function should not be made control-dependent on additional values.
1392 For example, the intrinsic ``llvm.nvvm.barrier0`` is ``convergent``, so
1393 calls to this intrinsic cannot be made control-dependent on additional
1396 When it appears on a call/invoke, the ``convergent`` attribute indicates
1397 that we should treat the call as though we're calling a convergent
1398 function. This is particularly useful on indirect calls; without this we
1399 may treat such calls as though the target is non-convergent.
1401 The optimizer may remove the ``convergent`` attribute on functions when it
1402 can prove that the function does not execute any convergent operations.
1403 Similarly, the optimizer may remove ``convergent`` on calls/invokes when it
1404 can prove that the call/invoke cannot call a convergent function.
1405 ``inaccessiblememonly``
1406 This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that
1407 is not accessible by the module being compiled. This is a weaker form
1408 of ``readnone``. If the function reads or writes other memory, the
1409 behavior is undefined.
1410 ``inaccessiblemem_or_argmemonly``
1411 This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that is
1412 either not accessible by the module being compiled, or is pointed to
1413 by its pointer arguments. This is a weaker form of ``argmemonly``. If the
1414 function reads or writes other memory, the behavior is undefined.
1416 This attribute indicates that the source code contained a hint that
1417 inlining this function is desirable (such as the "inline" keyword in
1418 C/C++). It is just a hint; it imposes no requirements on the
1421 This attribute indicates that the function should be added to a
1422 jump-instruction table at code-generation time, and that all address-taken
1423 references to this function should be replaced with a reference to the
1424 appropriate jump-instruction-table function pointer. Note that this creates
1425 a new pointer for the original function, which means that code that depends
1426 on function-pointer identity can break. So, any function annotated with
1427 ``jumptable`` must also be ``unnamed_addr``.
1429 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1430 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function as small
1431 as possible and perform optimizations that may sacrifice runtime
1432 performance in order to minimize the size of the generated code.
1434 This attribute disables prologue / epilogue emission for the
1435 function. This can have very system-specific consequences.
1437 When this attribute is set to true, the jump tables and lookup tables that
1438 can be generated from a switch case lowering are disabled.
1440 This indicates that the callee function at a call site is not recognized as
1441 a built-in function. LLVM will retain the original call and not replace it
1442 with equivalent code based on the semantics of the built-in function, unless
1443 the call site uses the ``builtin`` attribute. This is valid at call sites
1444 and on function declarations and definitions.
1446 This attribute indicates that calls to the function cannot be
1447 duplicated. A call to a ``noduplicate`` function may be moved
1448 within its parent function, but may not be duplicated within
1449 its parent function.
1451 A function containing a ``noduplicate`` call may still
1452 be an inlining candidate, provided that the call is not
1453 duplicated by inlining. That implies that the function has
1454 internal linkage and only has one call site, so the original
1455 call is dead after inlining.
1457 This function attribute indicates that the function does not, directly or
1458 indirectly, call a memory-deallocation function (free, for example). As a
1459 result, uncaptured pointers that are known to be dereferenceable prior to a
1460 call to a function with the ``nofree`` attribute are still known to be
1461 dereferenceable after the call (the capturing condition is necessary in
1462 environments where the function might communicate the pointer to another thread
1463 which then deallocates the memory).
1465 This attributes disables implicit floating-point instructions.
1467 This attribute indicates that the inliner should never inline this
1468 function in any situation. This attribute may not be used together
1469 with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute.
1471 This attribute suppresses lazy symbol binding for the function. This
1472 may make calls to the function faster, at the cost of extra program
1473 startup time if the function is not called during program startup.
1475 This attribute indicates that the code generator should not use a
1476 red zone, even if the target-specific ABI normally permits it.
1477 ``indirect-tls-seg-refs``
1478 This attribute indicates that the code generator should not use
1479 direct TLS access through segment registers, even if the
1480 target-specific ABI normally permits it.
1482 This function attribute indicates that the function never returns
1483 normally. This produces undefined behavior at runtime if the
1484 function ever does dynamically return.
1486 This function attribute indicates that the function does not call itself
1487 either directly or indirectly down any possible call path. This produces
1488 undefined behavior at runtime if the function ever does recurse.
1490 This function attribute indicates that a call of this function will
1491 either exhibit undefined behavior or comes back and continues execution
1492 at a point in the existing call stack that includes the current invocation.
1493 Annotated functions may still raise an exception, i.a., ``nounwind`` is not implied.
1494 If an invocation of an annotated function does not return control back
1495 to a point in the call stack, the behavior is undefined.
1497 This function attribute indicates that the function does not communicate
1498 (synchronize) with another thread through memory or other well-defined means.
1499 Synchronization is considered possible in the presence of `atomic` accesses
1500 that enforce an order, thus not "unordered" and "monotonic", `volatile` accesses,
1501 as well as `convergent` function calls. Note that through `convergent` function calls
1502 non-memory communication, e.g., cross-lane operations, are possible and are also
1503 considered synchronization. However `convergent` does not contradict `nosync`.
1504 If an annotated function does ever synchronize with another thread,
1505 the behavior is undefined.
1507 This function attribute indicates that the function never raises an
1508 exception. If the function does raise an exception, its runtime
1509 behavior is undefined. However, functions marked nounwind may still
1510 trap or generate asynchronous exceptions. Exception handling schemes
1511 that are recognized by LLVM to handle asynchronous exceptions, such
1512 as SEH, will still provide their implementation defined semantics.
1513 ``"null-pointer-is-valid"``
1514 If ``"null-pointer-is-valid"`` is set to ``"true"``, then ``null`` address
1515 in address-space 0 is considered to be a valid address for memory loads and
1516 stores. Any analysis or optimization should not treat dereferencing a
1517 pointer to ``null`` as undefined behavior in this function.
1518 Note: Comparing address of a global variable to ``null`` may still
1519 evaluate to false because of a limitation in querying this attribute inside
1520 constant expressions.
1522 This attribute indicates that this function should be optimized
1523 for maximum fuzzing signal.
1525 This function attribute indicates that most optimization passes will skip
1526 this function, with the exception of interprocedural optimization passes.
1527 Code generation defaults to the "fast" instruction selector.
1528 This attribute cannot be used together with the ``alwaysinline``
1529 attribute; this attribute is also incompatible
1530 with the ``minsize`` attribute and the ``optsize`` attribute.
1532 This attribute requires the ``noinline`` attribute to be specified on
1533 the function as well, so the function is never inlined into any caller.
1534 Only functions with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute are valid
1535 candidates for inlining into the body of this function.
1537 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1538 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function low,
1539 and otherwise do optimizations specifically to reduce code size as
1540 long as they do not significantly impact runtime performance.
1541 ``"patchable-function"``
1542 This attribute tells the code generator that the code
1543 generated for this function needs to follow certain conventions that
1544 make it possible for a runtime function to patch over it later.
1545 The exact effect of this attribute depends on its string value,
1546 for which there currently is one legal possibility:
1548 * ``"prologue-short-redirect"`` - This style of patchable
1549 function is intended to support patching a function prologue to
1550 redirect control away from the function in a thread safe
1551 manner. It guarantees that the first instruction of the
1552 function will be large enough to accommodate a short jump
1553 instruction, and will be sufficiently aligned to allow being
1554 fully changed via an atomic compare-and-swap instruction.
1555 While the first requirement can be satisfied by inserting large
1556 enough NOP, LLVM can and will try to re-purpose an existing
1557 instruction (i.e. one that would have to be emitted anyway) as
1558 the patchable instruction larger than a short jump.
1560 ``"prologue-short-redirect"`` is currently only supported on
1563 This attribute by itself does not imply restrictions on
1564 inter-procedural optimizations. All of the semantic effects the
1565 patching may have to be separately conveyed via the linkage type.
1567 This attribute indicates that the function will trigger a guard region
1568 in the end of the stack. It ensures that accesses to the stack must be
1569 no further apart than the size of the guard region to a previous
1570 access of the stack. It takes one required string value, the name of
1571 the stack probing function that will be called.
1573 If a function that has a ``"probe-stack"`` attribute is inlined into
1574 a function with another ``"probe-stack"`` attribute, the resulting
1575 function has the ``"probe-stack"`` attribute of the caller. If a
1576 function that has a ``"probe-stack"`` attribute is inlined into a
1577 function that has no ``"probe-stack"`` attribute at all, the resulting
1578 function has the ``"probe-stack"`` attribute of the callee.
1580 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function computes its
1581 result (or decides to unwind an exception) based strictly on its arguments,
1582 without dereferencing any pointer arguments or otherwise accessing
1583 any mutable state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1584 caller functions. It does not write through any pointer arguments
1585 (including ``byval`` arguments) and never changes any state visible
1586 to callers. This means while it cannot unwind exceptions by calling
1587 the ``C++`` exception throwing methods (since they write to memory), there may
1588 be non-``C++`` mechanisms that throw exceptions without writing to LLVM
1591 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not
1592 dereference that pointer argument, even though it may read or write the
1593 memory that the pointer points to if accessed through other pointers.
1595 If a readnone function reads or writes memory visible to the program, or
1596 has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined. If a function reads from
1597 or writes to a readnone pointer argument, the behavior is undefined.
1599 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1600 through any pointer arguments (including ``byval`` arguments) or otherwise
1601 modify any state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1602 caller functions. It may dereference pointer arguments and read
1603 state that may be set in the caller. A readonly function always
1604 returns the same value (or unwinds an exception identically) when
1605 called with the same set of arguments and global state. This means while it
1606 cannot unwind exceptions by calling the ``C++`` exception throwing methods
1607 (since they write to memory), there may be non-``C++`` mechanisms that throw
1608 exceptions without writing to LLVM visible memory.
1610 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1611 through this pointer argument, even though it may write to the memory that
1612 the pointer points to.
1614 If a readonly function writes memory visible to the program, or
1615 has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined. If a function writes to
1616 a readonly pointer argument, the behavior is undefined.
1617 ``"stack-probe-size"``
1618 This attribute controls the behavior of stack probes: either
1619 the ``"probe-stack"`` attribute, or ABI-required stack probes, if any.
1620 It defines the size of the guard region. It ensures that if the function
1621 may use more stack space than the size of the guard region, stack probing
1622 sequence will be emitted. It takes one required integer value, which
1625 If a function that has a ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute is inlined into
1626 a function with another ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute, the resulting
1627 function has the ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute that has the lower
1628 numeric value. If a function that has a ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute is
1629 inlined into a function that has no ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute
1630 at all, the resulting function has the ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute
1632 ``"no-stack-arg-probe"``
1633 This attribute disables ABI-required stack probes, if any.
1635 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function may write to but
1636 does not read from memory.
1638 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function may write to but
1639 does not read through this pointer argument (even though it may read from
1640 the memory that the pointer points to).
1642 If a writeonly function reads memory visible to the program, or
1643 has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined. If a function reads
1644 from a writeonly pointer argument, the behavior is undefined.
1646 This attribute indicates that the only memory accesses inside function are
1647 loads and stores from objects pointed to by its pointer-typed arguments,
1648 with arbitrary offsets. Or in other words, all memory operations in the
1649 function can refer to memory only using pointers based on its function
1652 Note that ``argmemonly`` can be used together with ``readonly`` attribute
1653 in order to specify that function reads only from its arguments.
1655 If an argmemonly function reads or writes memory other than the pointer
1656 arguments, or has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined.
1658 This attribute indicates that this function can return twice. The C
1659 ``setjmp`` is an example of such a function. The compiler disables
1660 some optimizations (like tail calls) in the caller of these
1663 This attribute indicates that
1664 `SafeStack <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/SafeStack.html>`_
1665 protection is enabled for this function.
1667 If a function that has a ``safestack`` attribute is inlined into a
1668 function that doesn't have a ``safestack`` attribute or which has an
1669 ``ssp``, ``sspstrong`` or ``sspreq`` attribute, then the resulting
1670 function will have a ``safestack`` attribute.
1671 ``sanitize_address``
1672 This attribute indicates that AddressSanitizer checks
1673 (dynamic address safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
1675 This attribute indicates that MemorySanitizer checks (dynamic detection
1676 of accesses to uninitialized memory) are enabled for this function.
1678 This attribute indicates that ThreadSanitizer checks
1679 (dynamic thread safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
1680 ``sanitize_hwaddress``
1681 This attribute indicates that HWAddressSanitizer checks
1682 (dynamic address safety analysis based on tagged pointers) are enabled for
1685 This attribute indicates that MemTagSanitizer checks
1686 (dynamic address safety analysis based on Armv8 MTE) are enabled for
1688 ``speculative_load_hardening``
1689 This attribute indicates that
1690 `Speculative Load Hardening <https://llvm.org/docs/SpeculativeLoadHardening.html>`_
1691 should be enabled for the function body.
1693 Speculative Load Hardening is a best-effort mitigation against
1694 information leak attacks that make use of control flow
1695 miss-speculation - specifically miss-speculation of whether a branch
1696 is taken or not. Typically vulnerabilities enabling such attacks are
1697 classified as "Spectre variant #1". Notably, this does not attempt to
1698 mitigate against miss-speculation of branch target, classified as
1699 "Spectre variant #2" vulnerabilities.
1701 When inlining, the attribute is sticky. Inlining a function that carries
1702 this attribute will cause the caller to gain the attribute. This is intended
1703 to provide a maximally conservative model where the code in a function
1704 annotated with this attribute will always (even after inlining) end up
1707 This function attribute indicates that the function does not have any
1708 effects besides calculating its result and does not have undefined behavior.
1709 Note that ``speculatable`` is not enough to conclude that along any
1710 particular execution path the number of calls to this function will not be
1711 externally observable. This attribute is only valid on functions
1712 and declarations, not on individual call sites. If a function is
1713 incorrectly marked as speculatable and really does exhibit
1714 undefined behavior, the undefined behavior may be observed even
1715 if the call site is dead code.
1718 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack
1719 smashing protector. It is in the form of a "canary" --- a random value
1720 placed on the stack before the local variables that's checked upon
1721 return from the function to see if it has been overwritten. A
1722 heuristic is used to determine if a function needs stack protectors
1723 or not. The heuristic used will enable protectors for functions with:
1725 - Character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size`` (default 8).
1726 - Aggregates containing character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size``.
1727 - Calls to alloca() with variable sizes or constant sizes greater than
1728 ``ssp-buffer-size``.
1730 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1731 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1733 If a function that has an ``ssp`` attribute is inlined into a
1734 function that doesn't have an ``ssp`` attribute, then the resulting
1735 function will have an ``ssp`` attribute.
1737 This attribute indicates that the function should *always* emit a
1738 stack smashing protector. This overrides the ``ssp`` function
1741 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1742 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1743 The specific layout rules are:
1745 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1746 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1747 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1748 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1749 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1752 If a function that has an ``sspreq`` attribute is inlined into a
1753 function that doesn't have an ``sspreq`` attribute or which has an
1754 ``ssp`` or ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the resulting function will have
1755 an ``sspreq`` attribute.
1757 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack smashing
1758 protector. This attribute causes a strong heuristic to be used when
1759 determining if a function needs stack protectors. The strong heuristic
1760 will enable protectors for functions with:
1762 - Arrays of any size and type
1763 - Aggregates containing an array of any size and type.
1764 - Calls to alloca().
1765 - Local variables that have had their address taken.
1767 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1768 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1769 The specific layout rules are:
1771 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1772 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1773 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1774 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1775 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1778 This overrides the ``ssp`` function attribute.
1780 If a function that has an ``sspstrong`` attribute is inlined into a
1781 function that doesn't have an ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the
1782 resulting function will have an ``sspstrong`` attribute.
1784 This attribute indicates that the function was called from a scope that
1785 requires strict floating-point semantics. LLVM will not attempt any
1786 optimizations that require assumptions about the floating-point rounding
1787 mode or that might alter the state of floating-point status flags that
1788 might otherwise be set or cleared by calling this function.
1790 This attribute indicates that the function will delegate to some other
1791 function with a tail call. The prototype of a thunk should not be used for
1792 optimization purposes. The caller is expected to cast the thunk prototype to
1793 match the thunk target prototype.
1795 This attribute indicates that the ABI being targeted requires that
1796 an unwind table entry be produced for this function even if we can
1797 show that no exceptions passes by it. This is normally the case for
1798 the ELF x86-64 abi, but it can be disabled for some compilation
1801 This attribute indicates that no control-flow check will be performed on
1802 the attributed entity. It disables -fcf-protection=<> for a specific
1803 entity to fine grain the HW control flow protection mechanism. The flag
1804 is target independent and currently appertains to a function or function
1807 This attribute indicates that the ShadowCallStack checks are enabled for
1808 the function. The instrumentation checks that the return address for the
1809 function has not changed between the function prolog and eiplog. It is
1810 currently x86_64-specific.
1817 Attributes may be set to communicate additional information about a global variable.
1818 Unlike :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>`, attributes on a global variable
1819 are grouped into a single :ref:`attribute group <attrgrp>`.
1826 Operand bundles are tagged sets of SSA values that can be associated
1827 with certain LLVM instructions (currently only ``call`` s and
1828 ``invoke`` s). In a way they are like metadata, but dropping them is
1829 incorrect and will change program semantics.
1833 operand bundle set ::= '[' operand bundle (, operand bundle )* ']'
1834 operand bundle ::= tag '(' [ bundle operand ] (, bundle operand )* ')'
1835 bundle operand ::= SSA value
1836 tag ::= string constant
1838 Operand bundles are **not** part of a function's signature, and a
1839 given function may be called from multiple places with different kinds
1840 of operand bundles. This reflects the fact that the operand bundles
1841 are conceptually a part of the ``call`` (or ``invoke``), not the
1842 callee being dispatched to.
1844 Operand bundles are a generic mechanism intended to support
1845 runtime-introspection-like functionality for managed languages. While
1846 the exact semantics of an operand bundle depend on the bundle tag,
1847 there are certain limitations to how much the presence of an operand
1848 bundle can influence the semantics of a program. These restrictions
1849 are described as the semantics of an "unknown" operand bundle. As
1850 long as the behavior of an operand bundle is describable within these
1851 restrictions, LLVM does not need to have special knowledge of the
1852 operand bundle to not miscompile programs containing it.
1854 - The bundle operands for an unknown operand bundle escape in unknown
1855 ways before control is transferred to the callee or invokee.
1856 - Calls and invokes with operand bundles have unknown read / write
1857 effect on the heap on entry and exit (even if the call target is
1858 ``readnone`` or ``readonly``), unless they're overridden with
1859 callsite specific attributes.
1860 - An operand bundle at a call site cannot change the implementation
1861 of the called function. Inter-procedural optimizations work as
1862 usual as long as they take into account the first two properties.
1864 More specific types of operand bundles are described below.
1866 .. _deopt_opbundles:
1868 Deoptimization Operand Bundles
1869 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1871 Deoptimization operand bundles are characterized by the ``"deopt"``
1872 operand bundle tag. These operand bundles represent an alternate
1873 "safe" continuation for the call site they're attached to, and can be
1874 used by a suitable runtime to deoptimize the compiled frame at the
1875 specified call site. There can be at most one ``"deopt"`` operand
1876 bundle attached to a call site. Exact details of deoptimization is
1877 out of scope for the language reference, but it usually involves
1878 rewriting a compiled frame into a set of interpreted frames.
1880 From the compiler's perspective, deoptimization operand bundles make
1881 the call sites they're attached to at least ``readonly``. They read
1882 through all of their pointer typed operands (even if they're not
1883 otherwise escaped) and the entire visible heap. Deoptimization
1884 operand bundles do not capture their operands except during
1885 deoptimization, in which case control will not be returned to the
1888 The inliner knows how to inline through calls that have deoptimization
1889 operand bundles. Just like inlining through a normal call site
1890 involves composing the normal and exceptional continuations, inlining
1891 through a call site with a deoptimization operand bundle needs to
1892 appropriately compose the "safe" deoptimization continuation. The
1893 inliner does this by prepending the parent's deoptimization
1894 continuation to every deoptimization continuation in the inlined body.
1895 E.g. inlining ``@f`` into ``@g`` in the following example
1897 .. code-block:: llvm
1900 call void @x() ;; no deopt state
1901 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10) ]
1902 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
1907 call void @f() [ "deopt"(i32 20) ]
1913 .. code-block:: llvm
1916 call void @x() ;; still no deopt state
1917 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10) ]
1918 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
1922 It is the frontend's responsibility to structure or encode the
1923 deoptimization state in a way that syntactically prepending the
1924 caller's deoptimization state to the callee's deoptimization state is
1925 semantically equivalent to composing the caller's deoptimization
1926 continuation after the callee's deoptimization continuation.
1930 Funclet Operand Bundles
1931 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1933 Funclet operand bundles are characterized by the ``"funclet"``
1934 operand bundle tag. These operand bundles indicate that a call site
1935 is within a particular funclet. There can be at most one
1936 ``"funclet"`` operand bundle attached to a call site and it must have
1937 exactly one bundle operand.
1939 If any funclet EH pads have been "entered" but not "exited" (per the
1940 `description in the EH doc\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
1941 it is undefined behavior to execute a ``call`` or ``invoke`` which:
1943 * does not have a ``"funclet"`` bundle and is not a ``call`` to a nounwind
1945 * has a ``"funclet"`` bundle whose operand is not the most-recently-entered
1946 not-yet-exited funclet EH pad.
1948 Similarly, if no funclet EH pads have been entered-but-not-yet-exited,
1949 executing a ``call`` or ``invoke`` with a ``"funclet"`` bundle is undefined behavior.
1951 GC Transition Operand Bundles
1952 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1954 GC transition operand bundles are characterized by the
1955 ``"gc-transition"`` operand bundle tag. These operand bundles mark a
1956 call as a transition between a function with one GC strategy to a
1957 function with a different GC strategy. If coordinating the transition
1958 between GC strategies requires additional code generation at the call
1959 site, these bundles may contain any values that are needed by the
1960 generated code. For more details, see :ref:`GC Transitions
1961 <gc_transition_args>`.
1965 Module-Level Inline Assembly
1966 ----------------------------
1968 Modules may contain "module-level inline asm" blocks, which corresponds
1969 to the GCC "file scope inline asm" blocks. These blocks are internally
1970 concatenated by LLVM and treated as a single unit, but may be separated
1971 in the ``.ll`` file if desired. The syntax is very simple:
1973 .. code-block:: llvm
1975 module asm "inline asm code goes here"
1976 module asm "more can go here"
1978 The strings can contain any character by escaping non-printable
1979 characters. The escape sequence used is simply "\\xx" where "xx" is the
1980 two digit hex code for the number.
1982 Note that the assembly string *must* be parseable by LLVM's integrated assembler
1983 (unless it is disabled), even when emitting a ``.s`` file.
1985 .. _langref_datalayout:
1990 A module may specify a target specific data layout string that specifies
1991 how data is to be laid out in memory. The syntax for the data layout is
1994 .. code-block:: llvm
1996 target datalayout = "layout specification"
1998 The *layout specification* consists of a list of specifications
1999 separated by the minus sign character ('-'). Each specification starts
2000 with a letter and may include other information after the letter to
2001 define some aspect of the data layout. The specifications accepted are
2005 Specifies that the target lays out data in big-endian form. That is,
2006 the bits with the most significance have the lowest address
2009 Specifies that the target lays out data in little-endian form. That
2010 is, the bits with the least significance have the lowest address
2013 Specifies the natural alignment of the stack in bits. Alignment
2014 promotion of stack variables is limited to the natural stack
2015 alignment to avoid dynamic stack realignment. The stack alignment
2016 must be a multiple of 8-bits. If omitted, the natural stack
2017 alignment defaults to "unspecified", which does not prevent any
2018 alignment promotions.
2019 ``P<address space>``
2020 Specifies the address space that corresponds to program memory.
2021 Harvard architectures can use this to specify what space LLVM
2022 should place things such as functions into. If omitted, the
2023 program memory space defaults to the default address space of 0,
2024 which corresponds to a Von Neumann architecture that has code
2025 and data in the same space.
2026 ``A<address space>``
2027 Specifies the address space of objects created by '``alloca``'.
2028 Defaults to the default address space of 0.
2029 ``p[n]:<size>:<abi>:<pref>:<idx>``
2030 This specifies the *size* of a pointer and its ``<abi>`` and
2031 ``<pref>``\erred alignments for address space ``n``. The fourth parameter
2032 ``<idx>`` is a size of index that used for address calculation. If not
2033 specified, the default index size is equal to the pointer size. All sizes
2034 are in bits. The address space, ``n``, is optional, and if not specified,
2035 denotes the default address space 0. The value of ``n`` must be
2036 in the range [1,2^23).
2037 ``i<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
2038 This specifies the alignment for an integer type of a given bit
2039 ``<size>``. The value of ``<size>`` must be in the range [1,2^23).
2040 ``v<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
2041 This specifies the alignment for a vector type of a given bit
2043 ``f<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
2044 This specifies the alignment for a floating-point type of a given bit
2045 ``<size>``. Only values of ``<size>`` that are supported by the target
2046 will work. 32 (float) and 64 (double) are supported on all targets; 80
2047 or 128 (different flavors of long double) are also supported on some
2050 This specifies the alignment for an object of aggregate type.
2052 This specifies the alignment for function pointers.
2053 The options for ``<type>`` are:
2055 * ``i``: The alignment of function pointers is independent of the alignment
2056 of functions, and is a multiple of ``<abi>``.
2057 * ``n``: The alignment of function pointers is a multiple of the explicit
2058 alignment specified on the function, and is a multiple of ``<abi>``.
2060 If present, specifies that llvm names are mangled in the output. Symbols
2061 prefixed with the mangling escape character ``\01`` are passed through
2062 directly to the assembler without the escape character. The mangling style
2065 * ``e``: ELF mangling: Private symbols get a ``.L`` prefix.
2066 * ``m``: Mips mangling: Private symbols get a ``$`` prefix.
2067 * ``o``: Mach-O mangling: Private symbols get ``L`` prefix. Other
2068 symbols get a ``_`` prefix.
2069 * ``x``: Windows x86 COFF mangling: Private symbols get the usual prefix.
2070 Regular C symbols get a ``_`` prefix. Functions with ``__stdcall``,
2071 ``__fastcall``, and ``__vectorcall`` have custom mangling that appends
2072 ``@N`` where N is the number of bytes used to pass parameters. C++ symbols
2073 starting with ``?`` are not mangled in any way.
2074 * ``w``: Windows COFF mangling: Similar to ``x``, except that normal C
2075 symbols do not receive a ``_`` prefix.
2076 ``n<size1>:<size2>:<size3>...``
2077 This specifies a set of native integer widths for the target CPU in
2078 bits. For example, it might contain ``n32`` for 32-bit PowerPC,
2079 ``n32:64`` for PowerPC 64, or ``n8:16:32:64`` for X86-64. Elements of
2080 this set are considered to support most general arithmetic operations
2082 ``ni:<address space0>:<address space1>:<address space2>...``
2083 This specifies pointer types with the specified address spaces
2084 as :ref:`Non-Integral Pointer Type <nointptrtype>` s. The ``0``
2085 address space cannot be specified as non-integral.
2087 On every specification that takes a ``<abi>:<pref>``, specifying the
2088 ``<pref>`` alignment is optional. If omitted, the preceding ``:``
2089 should be omitted too and ``<pref>`` will be equal to ``<abi>``.
2091 When constructing the data layout for a given target, LLVM starts with a
2092 default set of specifications which are then (possibly) overridden by
2093 the specifications in the ``datalayout`` keyword. The default
2094 specifications are given in this list:
2096 - ``E`` - big endian
2097 - ``p:64:64:64`` - 64-bit pointers with 64-bit alignment.
2098 - ``p[n]:64:64:64`` - Other address spaces are assumed to be the
2099 same as the default address space.
2100 - ``S0`` - natural stack alignment is unspecified
2101 - ``i1:8:8`` - i1 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
2102 - ``i8:8:8`` - i8 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
2103 - ``i16:16:16`` - i16 is 16-bit aligned
2104 - ``i32:32:32`` - i32 is 32-bit aligned
2105 - ``i64:32:64`` - i64 has ABI alignment of 32-bits but preferred
2106 alignment of 64-bits
2107 - ``f16:16:16`` - half is 16-bit aligned
2108 - ``f32:32:32`` - float is 32-bit aligned
2109 - ``f64:64:64`` - double is 64-bit aligned
2110 - ``f128:128:128`` - quad is 128-bit aligned
2111 - ``v64:64:64`` - 64-bit vector is 64-bit aligned
2112 - ``v128:128:128`` - 128-bit vector is 128-bit aligned
2113 - ``a:0:64`` - aggregates are 64-bit aligned
2115 When LLVM is determining the alignment for a given type, it uses the
2118 #. If the type sought is an exact match for one of the specifications,
2119 that specification is used.
2120 #. If no match is found, and the type sought is an integer type, then
2121 the smallest integer type that is larger than the bitwidth of the
2122 sought type is used. If none of the specifications are larger than
2123 the bitwidth then the largest integer type is used. For example,
2124 given the default specifications above, the i7 type will use the
2125 alignment of i8 (next largest) while both i65 and i256 will use the
2126 alignment of i64 (largest specified).
2127 #. If no match is found, and the type sought is a vector type, then the
2128 largest vector type that is smaller than the sought vector type will
2129 be used as a fall back. This happens because <128 x double> can be
2130 implemented in terms of 64 <2 x double>, for example.
2132 The function of the data layout string may not be what you expect.
2133 Notably, this is not a specification from the frontend of what alignment
2134 the code generator should use.
2136 Instead, if specified, the target data layout is required to match what
2137 the ultimate *code generator* expects. This string is used by the
2138 mid-level optimizers to improve code, and this only works if it matches
2139 what the ultimate code generator uses. There is no way to generate IR
2140 that does not embed this target-specific detail into the IR. If you
2141 don't specify the string, the default specifications will be used to
2142 generate a Data Layout and the optimization phases will operate
2143 accordingly and introduce target specificity into the IR with respect to
2144 these default specifications.
2151 A module may specify a target triple string that describes the target
2152 host. The syntax for the target triple is simply:
2154 .. code-block:: llvm
2156 target triple = "x86_64-apple-macosx10.7.0"
2158 The *target triple* string consists of a series of identifiers delimited
2159 by the minus sign character ('-'). The canonical forms are:
2163 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM
2164 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM-ENVIRONMENT
2166 This information is passed along to the backend so that it generates
2167 code for the proper architecture. It's possible to override this on the
2168 command line with the ``-mtriple`` command line option.
2170 .. _pointeraliasing:
2172 Pointer Aliasing Rules
2173 ----------------------
2175 Any memory access must be done through a pointer value associated with
2176 an address range of the memory access, otherwise the behavior is
2177 undefined. Pointer values are associated with address ranges according
2178 to the following rules:
2180 - A pointer value is associated with the addresses associated with any
2181 value it is *based* on.
2182 - An address of a global variable is associated with the address range
2183 of the variable's storage.
2184 - The result value of an allocation instruction is associated with the
2185 address range of the allocated storage.
2186 - A null pointer in the default address-space is associated with no
2188 - An :ref:`undef value <undefvalues>` in *any* address-space is
2189 associated with no address.
2190 - An integer constant other than zero or a pointer value returned from
2191 a function not defined within LLVM may be associated with address
2192 ranges allocated through mechanisms other than those provided by
2193 LLVM. Such ranges shall not overlap with any ranges of addresses
2194 allocated by mechanisms provided by LLVM.
2196 A pointer value is *based* on another pointer value according to the
2199 - A pointer value formed from a scalar ``getelementptr`` operation is *based* on
2200 the pointer-typed operand of the ``getelementptr``.
2201 - The pointer in lane *l* of the result of a vector ``getelementptr`` operation
2202 is *based* on the pointer in lane *l* of the vector-of-pointers-typed operand
2203 of the ``getelementptr``.
2204 - The result value of a ``bitcast`` is *based* on the operand of the
2206 - A pointer value formed by an ``inttoptr`` is *based* on all pointer
2207 values that contribute (directly or indirectly) to the computation of
2208 the pointer's value.
2209 - The "*based* on" relationship is transitive.
2211 Note that this definition of *"based"* is intentionally similar to the
2212 definition of *"based"* in C99, though it is slightly weaker.
2214 LLVM IR does not associate types with memory. The result type of a
2215 ``load`` merely indicates the size and alignment of the memory from
2216 which to load, as well as the interpretation of the value. The first
2217 operand type of a ``store`` similarly only indicates the size and
2218 alignment of the store.
2220 Consequently, type-based alias analysis, aka TBAA, aka
2221 ``-fstrict-aliasing``, is not applicable to general unadorned LLVM IR.
2222 :ref:`Metadata <metadata>` may be used to encode additional information
2223 which specialized optimization passes may use to implement type-based
2228 Volatile Memory Accesses
2229 ------------------------
2231 Certain memory accesses, such as :ref:`load <i_load>`'s,
2232 :ref:`store <i_store>`'s, and :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`'s may be
2233 marked ``volatile``. The optimizers must not change the number of
2234 volatile operations or change their order of execution relative to other
2235 volatile operations. The optimizers *may* change the order of volatile
2236 operations relative to non-volatile operations. This is not Java's
2237 "volatile" and has no cross-thread synchronization behavior.
2239 A volatile load or store may have additional target-specific semantics.
2240 Any volatile operation can have side effects, and any volatile operation
2241 can read and/or modify state which is not accessible via a regular load
2242 or store in this module. Volatile operations may use addresses which do
2243 not point to memory (like MMIO registers). This means the compiler may
2244 not use a volatile operation to prove a non-volatile access to that
2245 address has defined behavior.
2247 The allowed side-effects for volatile accesses are limited. If a
2248 non-volatile store to a given address would be legal, a volatile
2249 operation may modify the memory at that address. A volatile operation
2250 may not modify any other memory accessible by the module being compiled.
2251 A volatile operation may not call any code in the current module.
2253 The compiler may assume execution will continue after a volatile operation,
2254 so operations which modify memory or may have undefined behavior can be
2255 hoisted past a volatile operation.
2257 IR-level volatile loads and stores cannot safely be optimized into
2258 llvm.memcpy or llvm.memmove intrinsics even when those intrinsics are
2259 flagged volatile. Likewise, the backend should never split or merge
2260 target-legal volatile load/store instructions.
2262 .. admonition:: Rationale
2264 Platforms may rely on volatile loads and stores of natively supported
2265 data width to be executed as single instruction. For example, in C
2266 this holds for an l-value of volatile primitive type with native
2267 hardware support, but not necessarily for aggregate types. The
2268 frontend upholds these expectations, which are intentionally
2269 unspecified in the IR. The rules above ensure that IR transformations
2270 do not violate the frontend's contract with the language.
2274 Memory Model for Concurrent Operations
2275 --------------------------------------
2277 The LLVM IR does not define any way to start parallel threads of
2278 execution or to register signal handlers. Nonetheless, there are
2279 platform-specific ways to create them, and we define LLVM IR's behavior
2280 in their presence. This model is inspired by the C++0x memory model.
2282 For a more informal introduction to this model, see the :doc:`Atomics`.
2284 We define a *happens-before* partial order as the least partial order
2287 - Is a superset of single-thread program order, and
2288 - When a *synchronizes-with* ``b``, includes an edge from ``a`` to
2289 ``b``. *Synchronizes-with* pairs are introduced by platform-specific
2290 techniques, like pthread locks, thread creation, thread joining,
2291 etc., and by atomic instructions. (See also :ref:`Atomic Memory Ordering
2292 Constraints <ordering>`).
2294 Note that program order does not introduce *happens-before* edges
2295 between a thread and signals executing inside that thread.
2297 Every (defined) read operation (load instructions, memcpy, atomic
2298 loads/read-modify-writes, etc.) R reads a series of bytes written by
2299 (defined) write operations (store instructions, atomic
2300 stores/read-modify-writes, memcpy, etc.). For the purposes of this
2301 section, initialized globals are considered to have a write of the
2302 initializer which is atomic and happens before any other read or write
2303 of the memory in question. For each byte of a read R, R\ :sub:`byte`
2304 may see any write to the same byte, except:
2306 - If write\ :sub:`1` happens before write\ :sub:`2`, and
2307 write\ :sub:`2` happens before R\ :sub:`byte`, then
2308 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`1`.
2309 - If R\ :sub:`byte` happens before write\ :sub:`3`, then
2310 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`3`.
2312 Given that definition, R\ :sub:`byte` is defined as follows:
2314 - If R is volatile, the result is target-dependent. (Volatile is
2315 supposed to give guarantees which can support ``sig_atomic_t`` in
2316 C/C++, and may be used for accesses to addresses that do not behave
2317 like normal memory. It does not generally provide cross-thread
2319 - Otherwise, if there is no write to the same byte that happens before
2320 R\ :sub:`byte`, R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef`` for that byte.
2321 - Otherwise, if R\ :sub:`byte` may see exactly one write,
2322 R\ :sub:`byte` returns the value written by that write.
2323 - Otherwise, if R is atomic, and all the writes R\ :sub:`byte` may
2324 see are atomic, it chooses one of the values written. See the :ref:`Atomic
2325 Memory Ordering Constraints <ordering>` section for additional
2326 constraints on how the choice is made.
2327 - Otherwise R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef``.
2329 R returns the value composed of the series of bytes it read. This
2330 implies that some bytes within the value may be ``undef`` **without**
2331 the entire value being ``undef``. Note that this only defines the
2332 semantics of the operation; it doesn't mean that targets will emit more
2333 than one instruction to read the series of bytes.
2335 Note that in cases where none of the atomic intrinsics are used, this
2336 model places only one restriction on IR transformations on top of what
2337 is required for single-threaded execution: introducing a store to a byte
2338 which might not otherwise be stored is not allowed in general.
2339 (Specifically, in the case where another thread might write to and read
2340 from an address, introducing a store can change a load that may see
2341 exactly one write into a load that may see multiple writes.)
2345 Atomic Memory Ordering Constraints
2346 ----------------------------------
2348 Atomic instructions (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>`,
2349 :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`, :ref:`fence <i_fence>`,
2350 :ref:`atomic load <i_load>`, and :ref:`atomic store <i_store>`) take
2351 ordering parameters that determine which other atomic instructions on
2352 the same address they *synchronize with*. These semantics are borrowed
2353 from Java and C++0x, but are somewhat more colloquial. If these
2354 descriptions aren't precise enough, check those specs (see spec
2355 references in the :doc:`atomics guide <Atomics>`).
2356 :ref:`fence <i_fence>` instructions treat these orderings somewhat
2357 differently since they don't take an address. See that instruction's
2358 documentation for details.
2360 For a simpler introduction to the ordering constraints, see the
2364 The set of values that can be read is governed by the happens-before
2365 partial order. A value cannot be read unless some operation wrote
2366 it. This is intended to provide a guarantee strong enough to model
2367 Java's non-volatile shared variables. This ordering cannot be
2368 specified for read-modify-write operations; it is not strong enough
2369 to make them atomic in any interesting way.
2371 In addition to the guarantees of ``unordered``, there is a single
2372 total order for modifications by ``monotonic`` operations on each
2373 address. All modification orders must be compatible with the
2374 happens-before order. There is no guarantee that the modification
2375 orders can be combined to a global total order for the whole program
2376 (and this often will not be possible). The read in an atomic
2377 read-modify-write operation (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>` and
2378 :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`) reads the value in the modification
2379 order immediately before the value it writes. If one atomic read
2380 happens before another atomic read of the same address, the later
2381 read must see the same value or a later value in the address's
2382 modification order. This disallows reordering of ``monotonic`` (or
2383 stronger) operations on the same address. If an address is written
2384 ``monotonic``-ally by one thread, and other threads ``monotonic``-ally
2385 read that address repeatedly, the other threads must eventually see
2386 the write. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2387 ``memory_order_relaxed``.
2389 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, a
2390 *synchronizes-with* edge may be formed with a ``release`` operation.
2391 This is intended to model C++'s ``memory_order_acquire``.
2393 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, if this operation
2394 writes a value which is subsequently read by an ``acquire``
2395 operation, it *synchronizes-with* that operation. (This isn't a
2396 complete description; see the C++0x definition of a release
2397 sequence.) This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2398 ``memory_order_release``.
2399 ``acq_rel`` (acquire+release)
2400 Acts as both an ``acquire`` and ``release`` operation on its
2401 address. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x ``memory_order_acq_rel``.
2402 ``seq_cst`` (sequentially consistent)
2403 In addition to the guarantees of ``acq_rel`` (``acquire`` for an
2404 operation that only reads, ``release`` for an operation that only
2405 writes), there is a global total order on all
2406 sequentially-consistent operations on all addresses, which is
2407 consistent with the *happens-before* partial order and with the
2408 modification orders of all the affected addresses. Each
2409 sequentially-consistent read sees the last preceding write to the
2410 same address in this global order. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2411 ``memory_order_seq_cst`` and Java volatile.
2415 If an atomic operation is marked ``syncscope("singlethread")``, it only
2416 *synchronizes with* and only participates in the seq\_cst total orderings of
2417 other operations running in the same thread (for example, in signal handlers).
2419 If an atomic operation is marked ``syncscope("<target-scope>")``, where
2420 ``<target-scope>`` is a target specific synchronization scope, then it is target
2421 dependent if it *synchronizes with* and participates in the seq\_cst total
2422 orderings of other operations.
2424 Otherwise, an atomic operation that is not marked ``syncscope("singlethread")``
2425 or ``syncscope("<target-scope>")`` *synchronizes with* and participates in the
2426 seq\_cst total orderings of other operations that are not marked
2427 ``syncscope("singlethread")`` or ``syncscope("<target-scope>")``.
2431 Floating-Point Environment
2432 --------------------------
2434 The default LLVM floating-point environment assumes that floating-point
2435 instructions do not have side effects. Results assume the round-to-nearest
2436 rounding mode. No floating-point exception state is maintained in this
2437 environment. Therefore, there is no attempt to create or preserve invalid
2438 operation (SNaN) or division-by-zero exceptions.
2440 The benefit of this exception-free assumption is that floating-point
2441 operations may be speculated freely without any other fast-math relaxations
2442 to the floating-point model.
2444 Code that requires different behavior than this should use the
2445 :ref:`Constrained Floating-Point Intrinsics <constrainedfp>`.
2452 LLVM IR floating-point operations (:ref:`fadd <i_fadd>`,
2453 :ref:`fsub <i_fsub>`, :ref:`fmul <i_fmul>`, :ref:`fdiv <i_fdiv>`,
2454 :ref:`frem <i_frem>`, :ref:`fcmp <i_fcmp>`) and :ref:`call <i_call>`
2455 may use the following flags to enable otherwise unsafe
2456 floating-point transformations.
2459 No NaNs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
2460 NaN. If an argument is a nan, or the result would be a nan, it produces
2461 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` instead.
2464 No Infs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
2465 +/-Inf. If an argument is +/-Inf, or the result would be +/-Inf, it
2466 produces a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` instead.
2469 No Signed Zeros - Allow optimizations to treat the sign of a zero
2470 argument or result as insignificant.
2473 Allow Reciprocal - Allow optimizations to use the reciprocal of an
2474 argument rather than perform division.
2477 Allow floating-point contraction (e.g. fusing a multiply followed by an
2478 addition into a fused multiply-and-add).
2481 Approximate functions - Allow substitution of approximate calculations for
2482 functions (sin, log, sqrt, etc). See floating-point intrinsic definitions
2483 for places where this can apply to LLVM's intrinsic math functions.
2486 Allow reassociation transformations for floating-point instructions.
2487 This may dramatically change results in floating-point.
2490 This flag implies all of the others.
2494 Use-list Order Directives
2495 -------------------------
2497 Use-list directives encode the in-memory order of each use-list, allowing the
2498 order to be recreated. ``<order-indexes>`` is a comma-separated list of
2499 indexes that are assigned to the referenced value's uses. The referenced
2500 value's use-list is immediately sorted by these indexes.
2502 Use-list directives may appear at function scope or global scope. They are not
2503 instructions, and have no effect on the semantics of the IR. When they're at
2504 function scope, they must appear after the terminator of the final basic block.
2506 If basic blocks have their address taken via ``blockaddress()`` expressions,
2507 ``uselistorder_bb`` can be used to reorder their use-lists from outside their
2514 uselistorder <ty> <value>, { <order-indexes> }
2515 uselistorder_bb @function, %block { <order-indexes> }
2521 define void @foo(i32 %arg1, i32 %arg2) {
2523 ; ... instructions ...
2525 ; ... instructions ...
2527 ; At function scope.
2528 uselistorder i32 %arg1, { 1, 0, 2 }
2529 uselistorder label %bb, { 1, 0 }
2533 uselistorder i32* @global, { 1, 2, 0 }
2534 uselistorder i32 7, { 1, 0 }
2535 uselistorder i32 (i32) @bar, { 1, 0 }
2536 uselistorder_bb @foo, %bb, { 5, 1, 3, 2, 0, 4 }
2538 .. _source_filename:
2543 The *source filename* string is set to the original module identifier,
2544 which will be the name of the compiled source file when compiling from
2545 source through the clang front end, for example. It is then preserved through
2548 This is currently necessary to generate a consistent unique global
2549 identifier for local functions used in profile data, which prepends the
2550 source file name to the local function name.
2552 The syntax for the source file name is simply:
2554 .. code-block:: text
2556 source_filename = "/path/to/source.c"
2563 The LLVM type system is one of the most important features of the
2564 intermediate representation. Being typed enables a number of
2565 optimizations to be performed on the intermediate representation
2566 directly, without having to do extra analyses on the side before the
2567 transformation. A strong type system makes it easier to read the
2568 generated code and enables novel analyses and transformations that are
2569 not feasible to perform on normal three address code representations.
2579 The void type does not represent any value and has no size.
2597 The function type can be thought of as a function signature. It consists of a
2598 return type and a list of formal parameter types. The return type of a function
2599 type is a void type or first class type --- except for :ref:`label <t_label>`
2600 and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>` types.
2606 <returntype> (<parameter list>)
2608 ...where '``<parameter list>``' is a comma-separated list of type
2609 specifiers. Optionally, the parameter list may include a type ``...``, which
2610 indicates that the function takes a variable number of arguments. Variable
2611 argument functions can access their arguments with the :ref:`variable argument
2612 handling intrinsic <int_varargs>` functions. '``<returntype>``' is any type
2613 except :ref:`label <t_label>` and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>`.
2617 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2618 | ``i32 (i32)`` | function taking an ``i32``, returning an ``i32`` |
2619 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2620 | ``float (i16, i32 *) *`` | :ref:`Pointer <t_pointer>` to a function that takes an ``i16`` and a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i32``, returning ``float``. |
2621 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2622 | ``i32 (i8*, ...)`` | A vararg function that takes at least one :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i8`` (char in C), which returns an integer. This is the signature for ``printf`` in LLVM. |
2623 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2624 | ``{i32, i32} (i32)`` | A function taking an ``i32``, returning a :ref:`structure <t_struct>` containing two ``i32`` values |
2625 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2632 The :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` types are perhaps the most important.
2633 Values of these types are the only ones which can be produced by
2641 These are the types that are valid in registers from CodeGen's perspective.
2650 The integer type is a very simple type that simply specifies an
2651 arbitrary bit width for the integer type desired. Any bit width from 1
2652 bit to 2\ :sup:`23`\ -1 (about 8 million) can be specified.
2660 The number of bits the integer will occupy is specified by the ``N``
2666 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2667 | ``i1`` | a single-bit integer. |
2668 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2669 | ``i32`` | a 32-bit integer. |
2670 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2671 | ``i1942652`` | a really big integer of over 1 million bits. |
2672 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2676 Floating-Point Types
2677 """"""""""""""""""""
2686 - 16-bit floating-point value
2689 - 32-bit floating-point value
2692 - 64-bit floating-point value
2695 - 128-bit floating-point value (112-bit mantissa)
2698 - 80-bit floating-point value (X87)
2701 - 128-bit floating-point value (two 64-bits)
2703 The binary format of half, float, double, and fp128 correspond to the
2704 IEEE-754-2008 specifications for binary16, binary32, binary64, and binary128
2712 The x86_mmx type represents a value held in an MMX register on an x86
2713 machine. The operations allowed on it are quite limited: parameters and
2714 return values, load and store, and bitcast. User-specified MMX
2715 instructions are represented as intrinsic or asm calls with arguments
2716 and/or results of this type. There are no arrays, vectors or constants
2733 The pointer type is used to specify memory locations. Pointers are
2734 commonly used to reference objects in memory.
2736 Pointer types may have an optional address space attribute defining the
2737 numbered address space where the pointed-to object resides. The default
2738 address space is number zero. The semantics of non-zero address spaces
2739 are target-specific.
2741 Note that LLVM does not permit pointers to void (``void*``) nor does it
2742 permit pointers to labels (``label*``). Use ``i8*`` instead.
2752 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2753 | ``[4 x i32]*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to :ref:`array <t_array>` of four ``i32`` values. |
2754 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2755 | ``i32 (i32*) *`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32*``, returning an ``i32``. |
2756 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2757 | ``i32 addrspace(5)*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to an ``i32`` value that resides in address space #5. |
2758 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2767 A vector type is a simple derived type that represents a vector of
2768 elements. Vector types are used when multiple primitive data are
2769 operated in parallel using a single instruction (SIMD). A vector type
2770 requires a size (number of elements), an underlying primitive data type,
2771 and a scalable property to represent vectors where the exact hardware
2772 vector length is unknown at compile time. Vector types are considered
2773 :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>`.
2779 < <# elements> x <elementtype> > ; Fixed-length vector
2780 < vscale x <# elements> x <elementtype> > ; Scalable vector
2782 The number of elements is a constant integer value larger than 0;
2783 elementtype may be any integer, floating-point or pointer type. Vectors
2784 of size zero are not allowed. For scalable vectors, the total number of
2785 elements is a constant multiple (called vscale) of the specified number
2786 of elements; vscale is a positive integer that is unknown at compile time
2787 and the same hardware-dependent constant for all scalable vectors at run
2788 time. The size of a specific scalable vector type is thus constant within
2789 IR, even if the exact size in bytes cannot be determined until run time.
2793 +------------------------+----------------------------------------------------+
2794 | ``<4 x i32>`` | Vector of 4 32-bit integer values. |
2795 +------------------------+----------------------------------------------------+
2796 | ``<8 x float>`` | Vector of 8 32-bit floating-point values. |
2797 +------------------------+----------------------------------------------------+
2798 | ``<2 x i64>`` | Vector of 2 64-bit integer values. |
2799 +------------------------+----------------------------------------------------+
2800 | ``<4 x i64*>`` | Vector of 4 pointers to 64-bit integer values. |
2801 +------------------------+----------------------------------------------------+
2802 | ``<vscale x 4 x i32>`` | Vector with a multiple of 4 32-bit integer values. |
2803 +------------------------+----------------------------------------------------+
2812 The label type represents code labels.
2827 The token type is used when a value is associated with an instruction
2828 but all uses of the value must not attempt to introspect or obscure it.
2829 As such, it is not appropriate to have a :ref:`phi <i_phi>` or
2830 :ref:`select <i_select>` of type token.
2847 The metadata type represents embedded metadata. No derived types may be
2848 created from metadata except for :ref:`function <t_function>` arguments.
2861 Aggregate Types are a subset of derived types that can contain multiple
2862 member types. :ref:`Arrays <t_array>` and :ref:`structs <t_struct>` are
2863 aggregate types. :ref:`Vectors <t_vector>` are not considered to be
2873 The array type is a very simple derived type that arranges elements
2874 sequentially in memory. The array type requires a size (number of
2875 elements) and an underlying data type.
2881 [<# elements> x <elementtype>]
2883 The number of elements is a constant integer value; ``elementtype`` may
2884 be any type with a size.
2888 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2889 | ``[40 x i32]`` | Array of 40 32-bit integer values. |
2890 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2891 | ``[41 x i32]`` | Array of 41 32-bit integer values. |
2892 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2893 | ``[4 x i8]`` | Array of 4 8-bit integer values. |
2894 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2896 Here are some examples of multidimensional arrays:
2898 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2899 | ``[3 x [4 x i32]]`` | 3x4 array of 32-bit integer values. |
2900 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2901 | ``[12 x [10 x float]]`` | 12x10 array of single precision floating-point values. |
2902 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2903 | ``[2 x [3 x [4 x i16]]]`` | 2x3x4 array of 16-bit integer values. |
2904 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2906 There is no restriction on indexing beyond the end of the array implied
2907 by a static type (though there are restrictions on indexing beyond the
2908 bounds of an allocated object in some cases). This means that
2909 single-dimension 'variable sized array' addressing can be implemented in
2910 LLVM with a zero length array type. An implementation of 'pascal style
2911 arrays' in LLVM could use the type "``{ i32, [0 x float]}``", for
2921 The structure type is used to represent a collection of data members
2922 together in memory. The elements of a structure may be any type that has
2925 Structures in memory are accessed using '``load``' and '``store``' by
2926 getting a pointer to a field with the '``getelementptr``' instruction.
2927 Structures in registers are accessed using the '``extractvalue``' and
2928 '``insertvalue``' instructions.
2930 Structures may optionally be "packed" structures, which indicate that
2931 the alignment of the struct is one byte, and that there is no padding
2932 between the elements. In non-packed structs, padding between field types
2933 is inserted as defined by the DataLayout string in the module, which is
2934 required to match what the underlying code generator expects.
2936 Structures can either be "literal" or "identified". A literal structure
2937 is defined inline with other types (e.g. ``{i32, i32}*``) whereas
2938 identified types are always defined at the top level with a name.
2939 Literal types are uniqued by their contents and can never be recursive
2940 or opaque since there is no way to write one. Identified types can be
2941 recursive, can be opaqued, and are never uniqued.
2947 %T1 = type { <type list> } ; Identified normal struct type
2948 %T2 = type <{ <type list> }> ; Identified packed struct type
2952 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2953 | ``{ i32, i32, i32 }`` | A triple of three ``i32`` values |
2954 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2955 | ``{ float, i32 (i32) * }`` | A pair, where the first element is a ``float`` and the second element is a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32``, returning an ``i32``. |
2956 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2957 | ``<{ i8, i32 }>`` | A packed struct known to be 5 bytes in size. |
2958 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2962 Opaque Structure Types
2963 """"""""""""""""""""""
2967 Opaque structure types are used to represent named structure types that
2968 do not have a body specified. This corresponds (for example) to the C
2969 notion of a forward declared structure.
2980 +--------------+-------------------+
2981 | ``opaque`` | An opaque type. |
2982 +--------------+-------------------+
2989 LLVM has several different basic types of constants. This section
2990 describes them all and their syntax.
2995 **Boolean constants**
2996 The two strings '``true``' and '``false``' are both valid constants
2998 **Integer constants**
2999 Standard integers (such as '4') are constants of the
3000 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. Negative numbers may be used with
3002 **Floating-point constants**
3003 Floating-point constants use standard decimal notation (e.g.
3004 123.421), exponential notation (e.g. 1.23421e+2), or a more precise
3005 hexadecimal notation (see below). The assembler requires the exact
3006 decimal value of a floating-point constant. For example, the
3007 assembler accepts 1.25 but rejects 1.3 because 1.3 is a repeating
3008 decimal in binary. Floating-point constants must have a
3009 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type.
3010 **Null pointer constants**
3011 The identifier '``null``' is recognized as a null pointer constant
3012 and must be of :ref:`pointer type <t_pointer>`.
3014 The identifier '``none``' is recognized as an empty token constant
3015 and must be of :ref:`token type <t_token>`.
3017 The one non-intuitive notation for constants is the hexadecimal form of
3018 floating-point constants. For example, the form
3019 '``double 0x432ff973cafa8000``' is equivalent to (but harder to read
3020 than) '``double 4.5e+15``'. The only time hexadecimal floating-point
3021 constants are required (and the only time that they are generated by the
3022 disassembler) is when a floating-point constant must be emitted but it
3023 cannot be represented as a decimal floating-point number in a reasonable
3024 number of digits. For example, NaN's, infinities, and other special
3025 values are represented in their IEEE hexadecimal format so that assembly
3026 and disassembly do not cause any bits to change in the constants.
3028 When using the hexadecimal form, constants of types half, float, and
3029 double are represented using the 16-digit form shown above (which
3030 matches the IEEE754 representation for double); half and float values
3031 must, however, be exactly representable as IEEE 754 half and single
3032 precision, respectively. Hexadecimal format is always used for long
3033 double, and there are three forms of long double. The 80-bit format used
3034 by x86 is represented as ``0xK`` followed by 20 hexadecimal digits. The
3035 128-bit format used by PowerPC (two adjacent doubles) is represented by
3036 ``0xM`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. The IEEE 128-bit format is
3037 represented by ``0xL`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. Long doubles
3038 will only work if they match the long double format on your target.
3039 The IEEE 16-bit format (half precision) is represented by ``0xH``
3040 followed by 4 hexadecimal digits. All hexadecimal formats are big-endian
3041 (sign bit at the left).
3043 There are no constants of type x86_mmx.
3045 .. _complexconstants:
3050 Complex constants are a (potentially recursive) combination of simple
3051 constants and smaller complex constants.
3053 **Structure constants**
3054 Structure constants are represented with notation similar to
3055 structure type definitions (a comma separated list of elements,
3056 surrounded by braces (``{}``)). For example:
3057 "``{ i32 4, float 17.0, i32* @G }``", where "``@G``" is declared as
3058 "``@G = external global i32``". Structure constants must have
3059 :ref:`structure type <t_struct>`, and the number and types of elements
3060 must match those specified by the type.
3062 Array constants are represented with notation similar to array type
3063 definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
3064 square brackets (``[]``)). For example:
3065 "``[ i32 42, i32 11, i32 74 ]``". Array constants must have
3066 :ref:`array type <t_array>`, and the number and types of elements must
3067 match those specified by the type. As a special case, character array
3068 constants may also be represented as a double-quoted string using the ``c``
3069 prefix. For example: "``c"Hello World\0A\00"``".
3070 **Vector constants**
3071 Vector constants are represented with notation similar to vector
3072 type definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
3073 less-than/greater-than's (``<>``)). For example:
3074 "``< i32 42, i32 11, i32 74, i32 100 >``". Vector constants
3075 must have :ref:`vector type <t_vector>`, and the number and types of
3076 elements must match those specified by the type.
3077 **Zero initialization**
3078 The string '``zeroinitializer``' can be used to zero initialize a
3079 value to zero of *any* type, including scalar and
3080 :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` types. This is often used to avoid
3081 having to print large zero initializers (e.g. for large arrays) and
3082 is always exactly equivalent to using explicit zero initializers.
3084 A metadata node is a constant tuple without types. For example:
3085 "``!{!0, !{!2, !0}, !"test"}``". Metadata can reference constant values,
3086 for example: "``!{!0, i32 0, i8* @global, i64 (i64)* @function, !"str"}``".
3087 Unlike other typed constants that are meant to be interpreted as part of
3088 the instruction stream, metadata is a place to attach additional
3089 information such as debug info.
3091 Global Variable and Function Addresses
3092 --------------------------------------
3094 The addresses of :ref:`global variables <globalvars>` and
3095 :ref:`functions <functionstructure>` are always implicitly valid
3096 (link-time) constants. These constants are explicitly referenced when
3097 the :ref:`identifier for the global <identifiers>` is used and always have
3098 :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` type. For example, the following is a legal LLVM
3101 .. code-block:: llvm
3105 @Z = global [2 x i32*] [ i32* @X, i32* @Y ]
3112 The string '``undef``' can be used anywhere a constant is expected, and
3113 indicates that the user of the value may receive an unspecified
3114 bit-pattern. Undefined values may be of any type (other than '``label``'
3115 or '``void``') and be used anywhere a constant is permitted.
3117 Undefined values are useful because they indicate to the compiler that
3118 the program is well defined no matter what value is used. This gives the
3119 compiler more freedom to optimize. Here are some examples of
3120 (potentially surprising) transformations that are valid (in pseudo IR):
3122 .. code-block:: llvm
3132 This is safe because all of the output bits are affected by the undef
3133 bits. Any output bit can have a zero or one depending on the input bits.
3135 .. code-block:: llvm
3143 %A = %X ;; By choosing undef as 0
3144 %B = %X ;; By choosing undef as -1
3149 These logical operations have bits that are not always affected by the
3150 input. For example, if ``%X`` has a zero bit, then the output of the
3151 '``and``' operation will always be a zero for that bit, no matter what
3152 the corresponding bit from the '``undef``' is. As such, it is unsafe to
3153 optimize or assume that the result of the '``and``' is '``undef``'.
3154 However, it is safe to assume that all bits of the '``undef``' could be
3155 0, and optimize the '``and``' to 0. Likewise, it is safe to assume that
3156 all the bits of the '``undef``' operand to the '``or``' could be set,
3157 allowing the '``or``' to be folded to -1.
3159 .. code-block:: llvm
3161 %A = select undef, %X, %Y
3162 %B = select undef, 42, %Y
3163 %C = select %X, %Y, undef
3173 This set of examples shows that undefined '``select``' (and conditional
3174 branch) conditions can go *either way*, but they have to come from one
3175 of the two operands. In the ``%A`` example, if ``%X`` and ``%Y`` were
3176 both known to have a clear low bit, then ``%A`` would have to have a
3177 cleared low bit. However, in the ``%C`` example, the optimizer is
3178 allowed to assume that the '``undef``' operand could be the same as
3179 ``%Y``, allowing the whole '``select``' to be eliminated.
3181 .. code-block:: text
3183 %A = xor undef, undef
3200 This example points out that two '``undef``' operands are not
3201 necessarily the same. This can be surprising to people (and also matches
3202 C semantics) where they assume that "``X^X``" is always zero, even if
3203 ``X`` is undefined. This isn't true for a number of reasons, but the
3204 short answer is that an '``undef``' "variable" can arbitrarily change
3205 its value over its "live range". This is true because the variable
3206 doesn't actually *have a live range*. Instead, the value is logically
3207 read from arbitrary registers that happen to be around when needed, so
3208 the value is not necessarily consistent over time. In fact, ``%A`` and
3209 ``%C`` need to have the same semantics or the core LLVM "replace all
3210 uses with" concept would not hold.
3212 .. code-block:: llvm
3220 These examples show the crucial difference between an *undefined value*
3221 and *undefined behavior*. An undefined value (like '``undef``') is
3222 allowed to have an arbitrary bit-pattern. This means that the ``%A``
3223 operation can be constant folded to '``0``', because the '``undef``'
3224 could be zero, and zero divided by any value is zero.
3225 However, in the second example, we can make a more aggressive
3226 assumption: because the ``undef`` is allowed to be an arbitrary value,
3227 we are allowed to assume that it could be zero. Since a divide by zero
3228 has *undefined behavior*, we are allowed to assume that the operation
3229 does not execute at all. This allows us to delete the divide and all
3230 code after it. Because the undefined operation "can't happen", the
3231 optimizer can assume that it occurs in dead code.
3233 .. code-block:: text
3235 a: store undef -> %X
3236 b: store %X -> undef
3241 A store *of* an undefined value can be assumed to not have any effect;
3242 we can assume that the value is overwritten with bits that happen to
3243 match what was already there. However, a store *to* an undefined
3244 location could clobber arbitrary memory, therefore, it has undefined
3252 In order to facilitate speculative execution, many instructions do not
3253 invoke immediate undefined behavior when provided with illegal operands,
3254 and return a poison value instead.
3256 There is currently no way of representing a poison value in the IR; they
3257 only exist when produced by operations such as :ref:`add <i_add>` with
3260 Poison value behavior is defined in terms of value *dependence*:
3262 - Values other than :ref:`phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on their operands.
3263 - :ref:`Phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on the operand corresponding to
3264 their dynamic predecessor basic block.
3265 - Function arguments depend on the corresponding actual argument values
3266 in the dynamic callers of their functions.
3267 - :ref:`Call <i_call>` instructions depend on the :ref:`ret <i_ret>`
3268 instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
3269 - :ref:`Invoke <i_invoke>` instructions depend on the
3270 :ref:`ret <i_ret>`, :ref:`resume <i_resume>`, or exception-throwing
3271 call instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
3272 - Non-volatile loads and stores depend on the most recent stores to all
3273 of the referenced memory addresses, following the order in the IR
3274 (including loads and stores implied by intrinsics such as
3275 :ref:`@llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`.)
3276 - An instruction with externally visible side effects depends on the
3277 most recent preceding instruction with externally visible side
3278 effects, following the order in the IR. (This includes :ref:`volatile
3279 operations <volatile>`.)
3280 - An instruction *control-depends* on a :ref:`terminator
3281 instruction <terminators>` if the terminator instruction has
3282 multiple successors and the instruction is always executed when
3283 control transfers to one of the successors, and may not be executed
3284 when control is transferred to another.
3285 - Additionally, an instruction also *control-depends* on a terminator
3286 instruction if the set of instructions it otherwise depends on would
3287 be different if the terminator had transferred control to a different
3289 - Dependence is transitive.
3291 An instruction that *depends* on a poison value, produces a poison value
3292 itself. A poison value may be relaxed into an
3293 :ref:`undef value <undefvalues>`, which takes an arbitrary bit-pattern.
3295 This means that immediate undefined behavior occurs if a poison value is
3296 used as an instruction operand that has any values that trigger undefined
3297 behavior. Notably this includes (but is not limited to):
3299 - The pointer operand of a :ref:`load <i_load>`, :ref:`store <i_store>` or
3300 any other pointer dereferencing instruction (independent of address
3302 - The divisor operand of a ``udiv``, ``sdiv``, ``urem`` or ``srem``
3305 Additionally, undefined behavior occurs if a side effect *depends* on poison.
3306 This includes side effects that are control dependent on a poisoned branch.
3308 Here are some examples:
3310 .. code-block:: llvm
3313 %poison = sub nuw i32 0, 1 ; Results in a poison value.
3314 %still_poison = and i32 %poison, 0 ; 0, but also poison.
3315 %poison_yet_again = getelementptr i32, i32* @h, i32 %still_poison
3316 store i32 0, i32* %poison_yet_again ; Undefined behavior due to
3319 store i32 %poison, i32* @g ; Poison value stored to memory.
3320 %poison2 = load i32, i32* @g ; Poison value loaded back from memory.
3322 %narrowaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i16*
3323 %wideaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i64*
3324 %poison3 = load i16, i16* %narrowaddr ; Returns a poison value.
3325 %poison4 = load i64, i64* %wideaddr ; Returns a poison value.
3327 %cmp = icmp slt i32 %poison, 0 ; Returns a poison value.
3328 br i1 %cmp, label %true, label %end ; Branch to either destination.
3331 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This is control-dependent on %cmp, so
3332 ; it has undefined behavior.
3336 %p = phi i32 [ 0, %entry ], [ 1, %true ]
3337 ; Both edges into this PHI are
3338 ; control-dependent on %cmp, so this
3339 ; always results in a poison value.
3341 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This would depend on the store in %true
3342 ; if %cmp is true, or the store in %entry
3343 ; otherwise, so this is undefined behavior.
3345 br i1 %cmp, label %second_true, label %second_end
3346 ; The same branch again, but this time the
3347 ; true block doesn't have side effects.
3354 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This time, the instruction always depends
3355 ; on the store in %end. Also, it is
3356 ; control-equivalent to %end, so this is
3357 ; well-defined (ignoring earlier undefined
3358 ; behavior in this example).
3362 Addresses of Basic Blocks
3363 -------------------------
3365 ``blockaddress(@function, %block)``
3367 The '``blockaddress``' constant computes the address of the specified
3368 basic block in the specified function, and always has an ``i8*`` type.
3369 Taking the address of the entry block is illegal.
3371 This value only has defined behavior when used as an operand to the
3372 ':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`' or ':ref:`callbr <i_callbr>`'instruction, or
3373 for comparisons against null. Pointer equality tests between labels addresses
3374 results in undefined behavior --- though, again, comparison against null is ok,
3375 and no label is equal to the null pointer. This may be passed around as an
3376 opaque pointer sized value as long as the bits are not inspected. This
3377 allows ``ptrtoint`` and arithmetic to be performed on these values so
3378 long as the original value is reconstituted before the ``indirectbr`` or
3379 ``callbr`` instruction.
3381 Finally, some targets may provide defined semantics when using the value
3382 as the operand to an inline assembly, but that is target specific.
3386 Constant Expressions
3387 --------------------
3389 Constant expressions are used to allow expressions involving other
3390 constants to be used as constants. Constant expressions may be of any
3391 :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type and may involve any LLVM operation
3392 that does not have side effects (e.g. load and call are not supported).
3393 The following is the syntax for constant expressions:
3395 ``trunc (CST to TYPE)``
3396 Perform the :ref:`trunc operation <i_trunc>` on constants.
3397 ``zext (CST to TYPE)``
3398 Perform the :ref:`zext operation <i_zext>` on constants.
3399 ``sext (CST to TYPE)``
3400 Perform the :ref:`sext operation <i_sext>` on constants.
3401 ``fptrunc (CST to TYPE)``
3402 Truncate a floating-point constant to another floating-point type.
3403 The size of CST must be larger than the size of TYPE. Both types
3404 must be floating-point.
3405 ``fpext (CST to TYPE)``
3406 Floating-point extend a constant to another type. The size of CST
3407 must be smaller or equal to the size of TYPE. Both types must be
3409 ``fptoui (CST to TYPE)``
3410 Convert a floating-point constant to the corresponding unsigned
3411 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
3412 must be of scalar or vector floating-point type. Both CST and TYPE
3413 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
3414 value won't fit in the integer type, the result is a
3415 :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
3416 ``fptosi (CST to TYPE)``
3417 Convert a floating-point constant to the corresponding signed
3418 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
3419 must be of scalar or vector floating-point type. Both CST and TYPE
3420 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
3421 value won't fit in the integer type, the result is a
3422 :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
3423 ``uitofp (CST to TYPE)``
3424 Convert an unsigned integer constant to the corresponding
3425 floating-point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating-point
3426 type. CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
3427 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements.
3428 ``sitofp (CST to TYPE)``
3429 Convert a signed integer constant to the corresponding floating-point
3430 constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating-point type.
3431 CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
3432 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements.
3433 ``ptrtoint (CST to TYPE)``
3434 Perform the :ref:`ptrtoint operation <i_ptrtoint>` on constants.
3435 ``inttoptr (CST to TYPE)``
3436 Perform the :ref:`inttoptr operation <i_inttoptr>` on constants.
3437 This one is *really* dangerous!
3438 ``bitcast (CST to TYPE)``
3439 Convert a constant, CST, to another TYPE.
3440 The constraints of the operands are the same as those for the
3441 :ref:`bitcast instruction <i_bitcast>`.
3442 ``addrspacecast (CST to TYPE)``
3443 Convert a constant pointer or constant vector of pointer, CST, to another
3444 TYPE in a different address space. The constraints of the operands are the
3445 same as those for the :ref:`addrspacecast instruction <i_addrspacecast>`.
3446 ``getelementptr (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``, ``getelementptr inbounds (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3447 Perform the :ref:`getelementptr operation <i_getelementptr>` on
3448 constants. As with the :ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`
3449 instruction, the index list may have one or more indexes, which are
3450 required to make sense for the type of "pointer to TY".
3451 ``select (COND, VAL1, VAL2)``
3452 Perform the :ref:`select operation <i_select>` on constants.
3453 ``icmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
3454 Perform the :ref:`icmp operation <i_icmp>` on constants.
3455 ``fcmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
3456 Perform the :ref:`fcmp operation <i_fcmp>` on constants.
3457 ``extractelement (VAL, IDX)``
3458 Perform the :ref:`extractelement operation <i_extractelement>` on
3460 ``insertelement (VAL, ELT, IDX)``
3461 Perform the :ref:`insertelement operation <i_insertelement>` on
3463 ``shufflevector (VEC1, VEC2, IDXMASK)``
3464 Perform the :ref:`shufflevector operation <i_shufflevector>` on
3466 ``extractvalue (VAL, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3467 Perform the :ref:`extractvalue operation <i_extractvalue>` on
3468 constants. The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as
3469 indices in a ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At
3470 least one index value must be specified.
3471 ``insertvalue (VAL, ELT, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3472 Perform the :ref:`insertvalue operation <i_insertvalue>` on constants.
3473 The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as indices in a
3474 ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At least one index
3475 value must be specified.
3476 ``OPCODE (LHS, RHS)``
3477 Perform the specified operation of the LHS and RHS constants. OPCODE
3478 may be any of the :ref:`binary <binaryops>` or :ref:`bitwise
3479 binary <bitwiseops>` operations. The constraints on operands are
3480 the same as those for the corresponding instruction (e.g. no bitwise
3481 operations on floating-point values are allowed).
3488 Inline Assembler Expressions
3489 ----------------------------
3491 LLVM supports inline assembler expressions (as opposed to :ref:`Module-Level
3492 Inline Assembly <moduleasm>`) through the use of a special value. This value
3493 represents the inline assembler as a template string (containing the
3494 instructions to emit), a list of operand constraints (stored as a string), a
3495 flag that indicates whether or not the inline asm expression has side effects,
3496 and a flag indicating whether the function containing the asm needs to align its
3497 stack conservatively.
3499 The template string supports argument substitution of the operands using "``$``"
3500 followed by a number, to indicate substitution of the given register/memory
3501 location, as specified by the constraint string. "``${NUM:MODIFIER}``" may also
3502 be used, where ``MODIFIER`` is a target-specific annotation for how to print the
3503 operand (See :ref:`inline-asm-modifiers`).
3505 A literal "``$``" may be included by using "``$$``" in the template. To include
3506 other special characters into the output, the usual "``\XX``" escapes may be
3507 used, just as in other strings. Note that after template substitution, the
3508 resulting assembly string is parsed by LLVM's integrated assembler unless it is
3509 disabled -- even when emitting a ``.s`` file -- and thus must contain assembly
3510 syntax known to LLVM.
3512 LLVM also supports a few more substitions useful for writing inline assembly:
3514 - ``${:uid}``: Expands to a decimal integer unique to this inline assembly blob.
3515 This substitution is useful when declaring a local label. Many standard
3516 compiler optimizations, such as inlining, may duplicate an inline asm blob.
3517 Adding a blob-unique identifier ensures that the two labels will not conflict
3518 during assembly. This is used to implement `GCC's %= special format
3519 string <https://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Extended-Asm.html>`_.
3520 - ``${:comment}``: Expands to the comment character of the current target's
3521 assembly dialect. This is usually ``#``, but many targets use other strings,
3522 such as ``;``, ``//``, or ``!``.
3523 - ``${:private}``: Expands to the assembler private label prefix. Labels with
3524 this prefix will not appear in the symbol table of the assembled object.
3525 Typically the prefix is ``L``, but targets may use other strings. ``.L`` is
3528 LLVM's support for inline asm is modeled closely on the requirements of Clang's
3529 GCC-compatible inline-asm support. Thus, the feature-set and the constraint and
3530 modifier codes listed here are similar or identical to those in GCC's inline asm
3531 support. However, to be clear, the syntax of the template and constraint strings
3532 described here is *not* the same as the syntax accepted by GCC and Clang, and,
3533 while most constraint letters are passed through as-is by Clang, some get
3534 translated to other codes when converting from the C source to the LLVM
3537 An example inline assembler expression is:
3539 .. code-block:: llvm
3541 i32 (i32) asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"
3543 Inline assembler expressions may **only** be used as the callee operand
3544 of a :ref:`call <i_call>` or an :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>` instruction.
3545 Thus, typically we have:
3547 .. code-block:: llvm
3549 %X = call i32 asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"(i32 %Y)
3551 Inline asms with side effects not visible in the constraint list must be
3552 marked as having side effects. This is done through the use of the
3553 '``sideeffect``' keyword, like so:
3555 .. code-block:: llvm
3557 call void asm sideeffect "eieio", ""()
3559 In some cases inline asms will contain code that will not work unless
3560 the stack is aligned in some way, such as calls or SSE instructions on
3561 x86, yet will not contain code that does that alignment within the asm.
3562 The compiler should make conservative assumptions about what the asm
3563 might contain and should generate its usual stack alignment code in the
3564 prologue if the '``alignstack``' keyword is present:
3566 .. code-block:: llvm
3568 call void asm alignstack "eieio", ""()
3570 Inline asms also support using non-standard assembly dialects. The
3571 assumed dialect is ATT. When the '``inteldialect``' keyword is present,
3572 the inline asm is using the Intel dialect. Currently, ATT and Intel are
3573 the only supported dialects. An example is:
3575 .. code-block:: llvm
3577 call void asm inteldialect "eieio", ""()
3579 If multiple keywords appear the '``sideeffect``' keyword must come
3580 first, the '``alignstack``' keyword second and the '``inteldialect``'
3583 Inline Asm Constraint String
3584 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3586 The constraint list is a comma-separated string, each element containing one or
3587 more constraint codes.
3589 For each element in the constraint list an appropriate register or memory
3590 operand will be chosen, and it will be made available to assembly template
3591 string expansion as ``$0`` for the first constraint in the list, ``$1`` for the
3594 There are three different types of constraints, which are distinguished by a
3595 prefix symbol in front of the constraint code: Output, Input, and Clobber. The
3596 constraints must always be given in that order: outputs first, then inputs, then
3597 clobbers. They cannot be intermingled.
3599 There are also three different categories of constraint codes:
3601 - Register constraint. This is either a register class, or a fixed physical
3602 register. This kind of constraint will allocate a register, and if necessary,
3603 bitcast the argument or result to the appropriate type.
3604 - Memory constraint. This kind of constraint is for use with an instruction
3605 taking a memory operand. Different constraints allow for different addressing
3606 modes used by the target.
3607 - Immediate value constraint. This kind of constraint is for an integer or other
3608 immediate value which can be rendered directly into an instruction. The
3609 various target-specific constraints allow the selection of a value in the
3610 proper range for the instruction you wish to use it with.
3615 Output constraints are specified by an "``=``" prefix (e.g. "``=r``"). This
3616 indicates that the assembly will write to this operand, and the operand will
3617 then be made available as a return value of the ``asm`` expression. Output
3618 constraints do not consume an argument from the call instruction. (Except, see
3619 below about indirect outputs).
3621 Normally, it is expected that no output locations are written to by the assembly
3622 expression until *all* of the inputs have been read. As such, LLVM may assign
3623 the same register to an output and an input. If this is not safe (e.g. if the
3624 assembly contains two instructions, where the first writes to one output, and
3625 the second reads an input and writes to a second output), then the "``&``"
3626 modifier must be used (e.g. "``=&r``") to specify that the output is an
3627 "early-clobber" output. Marking an output as "early-clobber" ensures that LLVM
3628 will not use the same register for any inputs (other than an input tied to this
3634 Input constraints do not have a prefix -- just the constraint codes. Each input
3635 constraint will consume one argument from the call instruction. It is not
3636 permitted for the asm to write to any input register or memory location (unless
3637 that input is tied to an output). Note also that multiple inputs may all be
3638 assigned to the same register, if LLVM can determine that they necessarily all
3639 contain the same value.
3641 Instead of providing a Constraint Code, input constraints may also "tie"
3642 themselves to an output constraint, by providing an integer as the constraint
3643 string. Tied inputs still consume an argument from the call instruction, and
3644 take up a position in the asm template numbering as is usual -- they will simply
3645 be constrained to always use the same register as the output they've been tied
3646 to. For example, a constraint string of "``=r,0``" says to assign a register for
3647 output, and use that register as an input as well (it being the 0'th
3650 It is permitted to tie an input to an "early-clobber" output. In that case, no
3651 *other* input may share the same register as the input tied to the early-clobber
3652 (even when the other input has the same value).
3654 You may only tie an input to an output which has a register constraint, not a
3655 memory constraint. Only a single input may be tied to an output.
3657 There is also an "interesting" feature which deserves a bit of explanation: if a
3658 register class constraint allocates a register which is too small for the value
3659 type operand provided as input, the input value will be split into multiple
3660 registers, and all of them passed to the inline asm.
3662 However, this feature is often not as useful as you might think.
3664 Firstly, the registers are *not* guaranteed to be consecutive. So, on those
3665 architectures that have instructions which operate on multiple consecutive
3666 instructions, this is not an appropriate way to support them. (e.g. the 32-bit
3667 SparcV8 has a 64-bit load, which instruction takes a single 32-bit register. The
3668 hardware then loads into both the named register, and the next register. This
3669 feature of inline asm would not be useful to support that.)
3671 A few of the targets provide a template string modifier allowing explicit access
3672 to the second register of a two-register operand (e.g. MIPS ``L``, ``M``, and
3673 ``D``). On such an architecture, you can actually access the second allocated
3674 register (yet, still, not any subsequent ones). But, in that case, you're still
3675 probably better off simply splitting the value into two separate operands, for
3676 clarity. (e.g. see the description of the ``A`` constraint on X86, which,
3677 despite existing only for use with this feature, is not really a good idea to
3680 Indirect inputs and outputs
3681 """""""""""""""""""""""""""
3683 Indirect output or input constraints can be specified by the "``*``" modifier
3684 (which goes after the "``=``" in case of an output). This indicates that the asm
3685 will write to or read from the contents of an *address* provided as an input
3686 argument. (Note that in this way, indirect outputs act more like an *input* than
3687 an output: just like an input, they consume an argument of the call expression,
3688 rather than producing a return value. An indirect output constraint is an
3689 "output" only in that the asm is expected to write to the contents of the input
3690 memory location, instead of just read from it).
3692 This is most typically used for memory constraint, e.g. "``=*m``", to pass the
3693 address of a variable as a value.
3695 It is also possible to use an indirect *register* constraint, but only on output
3696 (e.g. "``=*r``"). This will cause LLVM to allocate a register for an output
3697 value normally, and then, separately emit a store to the address provided as
3698 input, after the provided inline asm. (It's not clear what value this
3699 functionality provides, compared to writing the store explicitly after the asm
3700 statement, and it can only produce worse code, since it bypasses many
3701 optimization passes. I would recommend not using it.)
3707 A clobber constraint is indicated by a "``~``" prefix. A clobber does not
3708 consume an input operand, nor generate an output. Clobbers cannot use any of the
3709 general constraint code letters -- they may use only explicit register
3710 constraints, e.g. "``~{eax}``". The one exception is that a clobber string of
3711 "``~{memory}``" indicates that the assembly writes to arbitrary undeclared
3712 memory locations -- not only the memory pointed to by a declared indirect
3715 Note that clobbering named registers that are also present in output
3716 constraints is not legal.
3721 After a potential prefix comes constraint code, or codes.
3723 A Constraint Code is either a single letter (e.g. "``r``"), a "``^``" character
3724 followed by two letters (e.g. "``^wc``"), or "``{``" register-name "``}``"
3727 The one and two letter constraint codes are typically chosen to be the same as
3728 GCC's constraint codes.
3730 A single constraint may include one or more than constraint code in it, leaving
3731 it up to LLVM to choose which one to use. This is included mainly for
3732 compatibility with the translation of GCC inline asm coming from clang.
3734 There are two ways to specify alternatives, and either or both may be used in an
3735 inline asm constraint list:
3737 1) Append the codes to each other, making a constraint code set. E.g. "``im``"
3738 or "``{eax}m``". This means "choose any of the options in the set". The
3739 choice of constraint is made independently for each constraint in the
3742 2) Use "``|``" between constraint code sets, creating alternatives. Every
3743 constraint in the constraint list must have the same number of alternative
3744 sets. With this syntax, the same alternative in *all* of the items in the
3745 constraint list will be chosen together.
3747 Putting those together, you might have a two operand constraint string like
3748 ``"rm|r,ri|rm"``. This indicates that if operand 0 is ``r`` or ``m``, then
3749 operand 1 may be one of ``r`` or ``i``. If operand 0 is ``r``, then operand 1
3750 may be one of ``r`` or ``m``. But, operand 0 and 1 cannot both be of type m.
3752 However, the use of either of the alternatives features is *NOT* recommended, as
3753 LLVM is not able to make an intelligent choice about which one to use. (At the
3754 point it currently needs to choose, not enough information is available to do so
3755 in a smart way.) Thus, it simply tries to make a choice that's most likely to
3756 compile, not one that will be optimal performance. (e.g., given "``rm``", it'll
3757 always choose to use memory, not registers). And, if given multiple registers,
3758 or multiple register classes, it will simply choose the first one. (In fact, it
3759 doesn't currently even ensure explicitly specified physical registers are
3760 unique, so specifying multiple physical registers as alternatives, like
3761 ``{r11}{r12},{r11}{r12}``, will assign r11 to both operands, not at all what was
3764 Supported Constraint Code List
3765 """"""""""""""""""""""""""""""
3767 The constraint codes are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
3768 GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
3769 inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
3770 and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
3772 Some constraint codes are typically supported by all targets:
3774 - ``r``: A register in the target's general purpose register class.
3775 - ``m``: A memory address operand. It is target-specific what addressing modes
3776 are supported, typical examples are register, or register + register offset,
3777 or register + immediate offset (of some target-specific size).
3778 - ``i``: An integer constant (of target-specific width). Allows either a simple
3779 immediate, or a relocatable value.
3780 - ``n``: An integer constant -- *not* including relocatable values.
3781 - ``s``: An integer constant, but allowing *only* relocatable values.
3782 - ``X``: Allows an operand of any kind, no constraint whatsoever. Typically
3783 useful to pass a label for an asm branch or call.
3785 .. FIXME: but that surely isn't actually okay to jump out of an asm
3786 block without telling llvm about the control transfer???)
3788 - ``{register-name}``: Requires exactly the named physical register.
3790 Other constraints are target-specific:
3794 - ``z``: An immediate integer 0. Outputs ``WZR`` or ``XZR``, as appropriate.
3795 - ``I``: An immediate integer valid for an ``ADD`` or ``SUB`` instruction,
3796 i.e. 0 to 4095 with optional shift by 12.
3797 - ``J``: An immediate integer that, when negated, is valid for an ``ADD`` or
3798 ``SUB`` instruction, i.e. -1 to -4095 with optional left shift by 12.
3799 - ``K``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 32' of a
3800 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 32-bit register.
3801 - ``L``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 64' of a
3802 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 64-bit register.
3803 - ``M``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3804 32-bit register. This is a superset of ``K``: in addition to the bitmask
3805 immediate, also allows immediate integers which can be loaded with a single
3806 ``MOVZ`` or ``MOVL`` instruction.
3807 - ``N``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3808 64-bit register. This is a superset of ``L``.
3809 - ``Q``: Memory address operand must be in a single register (no
3810 offsets). (However, LLVM currently does this for the ``m`` constraint as
3812 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register (W* or X*).
3813 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register.
3814 - ``x``: A lower 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register (``V0`` to ``V15``).
3818 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3819 - ``[0-9]v``: The 32-bit VGPR register, number 0-9.
3820 - ``[0-9]s``: The 32-bit SGPR register, number 0-9.
3825 - ``Q``, ``Um``, ``Un``, ``Uq``, ``Us``, ``Ut``, ``Uv``, ``Uy``: Memory address
3826 operand. Treated the same as operand ``m``, at the moment.
3827 - ``Te``: An even general-purpose 32-bit integer register: ``r0,r2,...,r12,r14``
3828 - ``To``: An odd general-purpose 32-bit integer register: ``r1,r3,...,r11``
3830 ARM and ARM's Thumb2 mode:
3832 - ``j``: An immediate integer between 0 and 65535 (valid for ``MOVW``)
3833 - ``I``: An immediate integer valid for a data-processing instruction.
3834 - ``J``: An immediate integer between -4095 and 4095.
3835 - ``K``: An immediate integer whose bitwise inverse is valid for a
3836 data-processing instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``B``" to
3837 print the inverted value).
3838 - ``L``: An immediate integer whose negation is valid for a data-processing
3839 instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``n``" to print the negated
3841 - ``M``: A power of two or a integer between 0 and 32.
3842 - ``N``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3843 - ``O``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3844 - ``r``: A general-purpose 32-bit integer register (``r0-r15``).
3845 - ``l``: In Thumb2 mode, low 32-bit GPR registers (``r0-r7``). In ARM mode, same
3847 - ``h``: In Thumb2 mode, a high 32-bit GPR register (``r8-r15``). In ARM mode,
3849 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3850 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3851 - ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3852 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
3853 - ``t``: A low floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``, ``d0-d16``, or
3858 - ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255.
3859 - ``J``: An immediate integer between -255 and -1.
3860 - ``K``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255, with optional left-shift by
3862 - ``L``: An immediate integer between -7 and 7.
3863 - ``M``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between 0 and 1020.
3864 - ``N``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3865 - ``O``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between -508 and 508.
3866 - ``r``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3867 - ``l``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3868 - ``h``: A high GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3869 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3870 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3871 - ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3872 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
3873 - ``t``: A low floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``, ``d0-d16``, or
3879 - ``o``, ``v``: A memory address operand, treated the same as constraint ``m``,
3881 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit register.
3885 - ``r``: An 8 or 16-bit register.
3889 - ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3890 - ``J``: An immediate integer zero.
3891 - ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3892 - ``L``: An immediate 32-bit integer, where the lower 16 bits are 0.
3893 - ``N``: An immediate integer between -65535 and -1.
3894 - ``O``: An immediate signed 15-bit integer.
3895 - ``P``: An immediate integer between 1 and 65535.
3896 - ``m``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3897 register plus 16-bit immediate offset. In MIPS mode, just a base register.
3898 - ``R``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3899 register plus a 9-bit signed offset. In MIPS mode, the same as constraint
3901 - ``ZC``: A memory address operand, suitable for use in a ``pref``, ``ll``, or
3902 ``sc`` instruction on the given subtarget (details vary).
3903 - ``r``, ``d``, ``y``: A 32 or 64-bit GPR register.
3904 - ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit FPU register (``F0-F31``), or a 128-bit MSA register
3905 (``W0-W31``). In the case of MSA registers, it is recommended to use the ``w``
3906 argument modifier for compatibility with GCC.
3907 - ``c``: A 32-bit or 64-bit GPR register suitable for indirect jump (always
3909 - ``l``: The ``lo`` register, 32 or 64-bit.
3914 - ``b``: A 1-bit integer register.
3915 - ``c`` or ``h``: A 16-bit integer register.
3916 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3917 - ``l`` or ``N``: A 64-bit integer register.
3918 - ``f``: A 32-bit float register.
3919 - ``d``: A 64-bit float register.
3924 - ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3925 - ``J``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3926 - ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3927 - ``L``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3928 - ``M``: An immediate integer greater than 31.
3929 - ``N``: An immediate integer that is an exact power of 2.
3930 - ``O``: The immediate integer constant 0.
3931 - ``P``: An immediate integer constant whose negation is a signed 16-bit
3933 - ``es``, ``o``, ``Q``, ``Z``, ``Zy``: A memory address operand, currently
3934 treated the same as ``m``.
3935 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3936 - ``b``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register, excluding ``R0`` (that is:
3938 - ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit float register (``F0-F31``), or when QPX is enabled, a
3939 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``; aliases the ``F`` registers).
3940 - ``v``: For ``4 x f32`` or ``4 x f64`` types, when QPX is enabled, a
3941 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``), otherwise a 128-bit
3942 altivec vector register (``V0-V31``).
3944 .. FIXME: is this a bug that v accepts QPX registers? I think this
3945 is supposed to only use the altivec vector registers?
3947 - ``y``: Condition register (``CR0-CR7``).
3948 - ``wc``: An individual CR bit in a CR register.
3949 - ``wa``, ``wd``, ``wf``: Any 128-bit VSX vector register, from the full VSX
3950 register set (overlapping both the floating-point and vector register files).
3951 - ``ws``: A 32 or 64-bit floating-point register, from the full VSX register
3956 - ``I``: An immediate 13-bit signed integer.
3957 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3958 - ``f``: Any floating-point register on SparcV8, or a floating-point
3959 register in the "low" half of the registers on SparcV9.
3960 - ``e``: Any floating-point register. (Same as ``f`` on SparcV8.)
3964 - ``I``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3965 - ``J``: An immediate unsigned 12-bit integer.
3966 - ``K``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3967 - ``L``: An immediate signed 20-bit integer.
3968 - ``M``: An immediate integer 0x7fffffff.
3969 - ``Q``: A memory address operand with a base address and a 12-bit immediate
3970 unsigned displacement.
3971 - ``R``: A memory address operand with a base address, a 12-bit immediate
3972 unsigned displacement, and an index register.
3973 - ``S``: A memory address operand with a base address and a 20-bit immediate
3974 signed displacement.
3975 - ``T``: A memory address operand with a base address, a 20-bit immediate
3976 signed displacement, and an index register.
3977 - ``r`` or ``d``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer register.
3978 - ``a``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer address register (excludes R0, which in an
3979 address context evaluates as zero).
3980 - ``h``: A 32-bit value in the high part of a 64bit data register
3982 - ``f``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point register.
3986 - ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3987 - ``J``: An immediate integer between 0 and 64.
3988 - ``K``: An immediate signed 8-bit integer.
3989 - ``L``: An immediate integer, 0xff or 0xffff or (in 64-bit mode only)
3991 - ``M``: An immediate integer between 0 and 3.
3992 - ``N``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3993 - ``O``: An immediate integer between 0 and 127.
3994 - ``e``: An immediate 32-bit signed integer.
3995 - ``Z``: An immediate 32-bit unsigned integer.
3996 - ``o``, ``v``: Treated the same as ``m``, at the moment.
3997 - ``q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
3998 ``l`` integer register. On X86-32, this is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d``
3999 registers, and on X86-64, it is all of the integer registers.
4000 - ``Q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
4001 ``h`` integer register. This is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d`` registers.
4002 - ``r`` or ``l``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit integer register.
4003 - ``R``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit "legacy" integer register -- one which has
4004 existed since i386, and can be accessed without the REX prefix.
4005 - ``f``: A 32, 64, or 80-bit '387 FPU stack pseudo-register.
4006 - ``y``: A 64-bit MMX register, if MMX is enabled.
4007 - ``x``: If SSE is enabled: a 32 or 64-bit scalar operand, or 128-bit vector
4008 operand in a SSE register. If AVX is also enabled, can also be a 256-bit
4009 vector operand in an AVX register. If AVX-512 is also enabled, can also be a
4010 512-bit vector operand in an AVX512 register, Otherwise, an error.
4011 - ``Y``: The same as ``x``, if *SSE2* is enabled, otherwise an error.
4012 - ``A``: Special case: allocates EAX first, then EDX, for a single operand (in
4013 32-bit mode, a 64-bit integer operand will get split into two registers). It
4014 is not recommended to use this constraint, as in 64-bit mode, the 64-bit
4015 operand will get allocated only to RAX -- if two 32-bit operands are needed,
4016 you're better off splitting it yourself, before passing it to the asm
4021 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
4024 .. _inline-asm-modifiers:
4026 Asm template argument modifiers
4027 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4029 In the asm template string, modifiers can be used on the operand reference, like
4032 The modifiers are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
4033 GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
4034 inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
4035 and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
4039 - ``c``: Print an immediate integer constant unadorned, without
4040 the target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
4041 - ``n``: Negate and print immediate integer constant unadorned, without the
4042 target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
4043 - ``l``: Print as an unadorned label, without the target-specific label
4044 punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
4048 - ``w``: Print a GPR register with a ``w*`` name instead of ``x*`` name. E.g.,
4049 instead of ``x30``, print ``w30``.
4050 - ``x``: Print a GPR register with a ``x*`` name. (this is the default, anyhow).
4051 - ``b``, ``h``, ``s``, ``d``, ``q``: Print a floating-point/SIMD register with a
4052 ``b*``, ``h*``, ``s*``, ``d*``, or ``q*`` name, rather than the default of
4061 - ``a``: Print an operand as an address (with ``[`` and ``]`` surrounding a
4065 - ``y``: Print a VFP single-precision register as an indexed double (e.g. print
4066 as ``d4[1]`` instead of ``s9``)
4067 - ``B``: Bitwise invert and print an immediate integer constant without ``#``
4069 - ``L``: Print the low 16-bits of an immediate integer constant.
4070 - ``M``: Print as a register set suitable for ldm/stm. Also prints *all*
4071 register operands subsequent to the specified one (!), so use carefully.
4072 - ``Q``: Print the low-order register of a register-pair, or the low-order
4073 register of a two-register operand.
4074 - ``R``: Print the high-order register of a register-pair, or the high-order
4075 register of a two-register operand.
4076 - ``H``: Print the second register of a register-pair. (On a big-endian system,
4077 ``H`` is equivalent to ``Q``, and on little-endian system, ``H`` is equivalent
4080 .. FIXME: H doesn't currently support printing the second register
4081 of a two-register operand.
4083 - ``e``: Print the low doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
4084 - ``f``: Print the high doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
4085 - ``m``: Print the base register of a memory operand without the ``[`` and ``]``
4090 - ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
4091 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
4093 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
4094 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
4096 - ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
4097 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
4101 No additional modifiers.
4105 - ``X``: Print an immediate integer as hexadecimal
4106 - ``x``: Print the low 16 bits of an immediate integer as hexadecimal.
4107 - ``d``: Print an immediate integer as decimal.
4108 - ``m``: Subtract one and print an immediate integer as decimal.
4109 - ``z``: Print $0 if an immediate zero, otherwise print normally.
4110 - ``L``: Print the low-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
4111 address of the low-order word of a double-word memory operand.
4113 .. FIXME: L seems to be missing memory operand support.
4115 - ``M``: Print the high-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
4116 address of the high-order word of a double-word memory operand.
4118 .. FIXME: M seems to be missing memory operand support.
4120 - ``D``: Print the second register of a two-register operand, or prints the
4121 second word of a double-word memory operand. (On a big-endian system, ``D`` is
4122 equivalent to ``L``, and on little-endian system, ``D`` is equivalent to
4124 - ``w``: No effect. Provided for compatibility with GCC which requires this
4125 modifier in order to print MSA registers (``W0-W31``) with the ``f``
4134 - ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
4135 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
4137 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
4138 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
4140 - ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
4141 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
4142 - ``y``: For a memory operand, prints formatter for a two-register X-form
4143 instruction. (Currently always prints ``r0,OPERAND``).
4144 - ``U``: Prints 'u' if the memory operand is an update form, and nothing
4145 otherwise. (NOTE: LLVM does not support update form, so this will currently
4146 always print nothing)
4147 - ``X``: Prints 'x' if the memory operand is an indexed form. (NOTE: LLVM does
4148 not support indexed form, so this will currently always print nothing)
4156 SystemZ implements only ``n``, and does *not* support any of the other
4157 target-independent modifiers.
4161 - ``c``: Print an unadorned integer or symbol name. (The latter is
4162 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier).
4163 - ``A``: Print a register name with a '``*``' before it.
4164 - ``b``: Print an 8-bit register name (e.g. ``al``); do nothing on a memory
4166 - ``h``: Print the upper 8-bit register name (e.g. ``ah``); do nothing on a
4168 - ``w``: Print the 16-bit register name (e.g. ``ax``); do nothing on a memory
4170 - ``k``: Print the 32-bit register name (e.g. ``eax``); do nothing on a memory
4172 - ``q``: Print the 64-bit register name (e.g. ``rax``), if 64-bit registers are
4173 available, otherwise the 32-bit register name; do nothing on a memory operand.
4174 - ``n``: Negate and print an unadorned integer, or, for operands other than an
4175 immediate integer (e.g. a relocatable symbol expression), print a '-' before
4176 the operand. (The behavior for relocatable symbol expressions is a
4177 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier)
4178 - ``H``: Print a memory reference with additional offset +8.
4179 - ``P``: Print a memory reference or operand for use as the argument of a call
4180 instruction. (E.g. omit ``(rip)``, even though it's PC-relative.)
4184 No additional modifiers.
4190 The call instructions that wrap inline asm nodes may have a
4191 "``!srcloc``" MDNode attached to it that contains a list of constant
4192 integers. If present, the code generator will use the integer as the
4193 location cookie value when report errors through the ``LLVMContext``
4194 error reporting mechanisms. This allows a front-end to correlate backend
4195 errors that occur with inline asm back to the source code that produced
4198 .. code-block:: llvm
4200 call void asm sideeffect "something bad", ""(), !srcloc !42
4202 !42 = !{ i32 1234567 }
4204 It is up to the front-end to make sense of the magic numbers it places
4205 in the IR. If the MDNode contains multiple constants, the code generator
4206 will use the one that corresponds to the line of the asm that the error
4214 LLVM IR allows metadata to be attached to instructions in the program
4215 that can convey extra information about the code to the optimizers and
4216 code generator. One example application of metadata is source-level
4217 debug information. There are two metadata primitives: strings and nodes.
4219 Metadata does not have a type, and is not a value. If referenced from a
4220 ``call`` instruction, it uses the ``metadata`` type.
4222 All metadata are identified in syntax by a exclamation point ('``!``').
4224 .. _metadata-string:
4226 Metadata Nodes and Metadata Strings
4227 -----------------------------------
4229 A metadata string is a string surrounded by double quotes. It can
4230 contain any character by escaping non-printable characters with
4231 "``\xx``" where "``xx``" is the two digit hex code. For example:
4234 Metadata nodes are represented with notation similar to structure
4235 constants (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by braces and
4236 preceded by an exclamation point). Metadata nodes can have any values as
4237 their operand. For example:
4239 .. code-block:: llvm
4241 !{ !"test\00", i32 10}
4243 Metadata nodes that aren't uniqued use the ``distinct`` keyword. For example:
4245 .. code-block:: text
4247 !0 = distinct !{!"test\00", i32 10}
4249 ``distinct`` nodes are useful when nodes shouldn't be merged based on their
4250 content. They can also occur when transformations cause uniquing collisions
4251 when metadata operands change.
4253 A :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` is a collection of
4254 metadata nodes, which can be looked up in the module symbol table. For
4257 .. code-block:: llvm
4261 Metadata can be used as function arguments. Here the ``llvm.dbg.value``
4262 intrinsic is using three metadata arguments:
4264 .. code-block:: llvm
4266 call void @llvm.dbg.value(metadata !24, metadata !25, metadata !26)
4268 Metadata can be attached to an instruction. Here metadata ``!21`` is attached
4269 to the ``add`` instruction using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
4271 .. code-block:: llvm
4273 %indvar.next = add i64 %indvar, 1, !dbg !21
4275 Metadata can also be attached to a function or a global variable. Here metadata
4276 ``!22`` is attached to the ``f1`` and ``f2 functions, and the globals ``g1``
4277 and ``g2`` using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
4279 .. code-block:: llvm
4281 declare !dbg !22 void @f1()
4282 define void @f2() !dbg !22 {
4286 @g1 = global i32 0, !dbg !22
4287 @g2 = external global i32, !dbg !22
4289 A transformation is required to drop any metadata attachment that it does not
4290 know or know it can't preserve. Currently there is an exception for metadata
4291 attachment to globals for ``!type`` and ``!absolute_symbol`` which can't be
4292 unconditionally dropped unless the global is itself deleted.
4294 Metadata attached to a module using named metadata may not be dropped, with
4295 the exception of debug metadata (named metadata with the name ``!llvm.dbg.*``).
4297 More information about specific metadata nodes recognized by the
4298 optimizers and code generator is found below.
4300 .. _specialized-metadata:
4302 Specialized Metadata Nodes
4303 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4305 Specialized metadata nodes are custom data structures in metadata (as opposed
4306 to generic tuples). Their fields are labelled, and can be specified in any
4309 These aren't inherently debug info centric, but currently all the specialized
4310 metadata nodes are related to debug info.
4317 ``DICompileUnit`` nodes represent a compile unit. The ``enums:``,
4318 ``retainedTypes:``, ``globals:``, ``imports:`` and ``macros:`` fields are tuples
4319 containing the debug info to be emitted along with the compile unit, regardless
4320 of code optimizations (some nodes are only emitted if there are references to
4321 them from instructions). The ``debugInfoForProfiling:`` field is a boolean
4322 indicating whether or not line-table discriminators are updated to provide
4323 more-accurate debug info for profiling results.
4325 .. code-block:: text
4327 !0 = !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, file: !1, producer: "clang",
4328 isOptimized: true, flags: "-O2", runtimeVersion: 2,
4329 splitDebugFilename: "abc.debug", emissionKind: FullDebug,
4330 enums: !2, retainedTypes: !3, globals: !4, imports: !5,
4331 macros: !6, dwoId: 0x0abcd)
4333 Compile unit descriptors provide the root scope for objects declared in a
4334 specific compilation unit. File descriptors are defined using this scope. These
4335 descriptors are collected by a named metadata node ``!llvm.dbg.cu``. They keep
4336 track of global variables, type information, and imported entities (declarations
4344 ``DIFile`` nodes represent files. The ``filename:`` can include slashes.
4346 .. code-block:: none
4348 !0 = !DIFile(filename: "path/to/file", directory: "/path/to/dir",
4349 checksumkind: CSK_MD5,
4350 checksum: "000102030405060708090a0b0c0d0e0f")
4352 Files are sometimes used in ``scope:`` fields, and are the only valid target
4353 for ``file:`` fields.
4354 Valid values for ``checksumkind:`` field are: {CSK_None, CSK_MD5, CSK_SHA1}
4361 ``DIBasicType`` nodes represent primitive types, such as ``int``, ``bool`` and
4362 ``float``. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_base_type``.
4364 .. code-block:: text
4366 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
4367 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
4368 !1 = !DIBasicType(tag: DW_TAG_unspecified_type, name: "decltype(nullptr)")
4370 The ``encoding:`` describes the details of the type. Usually it's one of the
4373 .. code-block:: text
4379 DW_ATE_signed_char = 6
4381 DW_ATE_unsigned_char = 8
4383 .. _DISubroutineType:
4388 ``DISubroutineType`` nodes represent subroutine types. Their ``types:`` field
4389 refers to a tuple; the first operand is the return type, while the rest are the
4390 types of the formal arguments in order. If the first operand is ``null``, that
4391 represents a function with no return value (such as ``void foo() {}`` in C++).
4393 .. code-block:: text
4395 !0 = !BasicType(name: "int", size: 32, align: 32, DW_ATE_signed)
4396 !1 = !BasicType(name: "char", size: 8, align: 8, DW_ATE_signed_char)
4397 !2 = !DISubroutineType(types: !{null, !0, !1}) ; void (int, char)
4404 ``DIDerivedType`` nodes represent types derived from other types, such as
4407 .. code-block:: text
4409 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
4410 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
4411 !1 = !DIDerivedType(tag: DW_TAG_pointer_type, baseType: !0, size: 32,
4414 The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
4416 .. code-block:: text
4419 DW_TAG_pointer_type = 15
4420 DW_TAG_reference_type = 16
4422 DW_TAG_inheritance = 28
4423 DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type = 31
4424 DW_TAG_const_type = 38
4426 DW_TAG_volatile_type = 53
4427 DW_TAG_restrict_type = 55
4428 DW_TAG_atomic_type = 71
4430 .. _DIDerivedTypeMember:
4432 ``DW_TAG_member`` is used to define a member of a :ref:`composite type
4433 <DICompositeType>`. The type of the member is the ``baseType:``. The
4434 ``offset:`` is the member's bit offset. If the composite type has an ODR
4435 ``identifier:`` and does not set ``flags: DIFwdDecl``, then the member is
4436 uniqued based only on its ``name:`` and ``scope:``.
4438 ``DW_TAG_inheritance`` and ``DW_TAG_friend`` are used in the ``elements:``
4439 field of :ref:`composite types <DICompositeType>` to describe parents and
4442 ``DW_TAG_typedef`` is used to provide a name for the ``baseType:``.
4444 ``DW_TAG_pointer_type``, ``DW_TAG_reference_type``, ``DW_TAG_const_type``,
4445 ``DW_TAG_volatile_type``, ``DW_TAG_restrict_type`` and ``DW_TAG_atomic_type``
4446 are used to qualify the ``baseType:``.
4448 Note that the ``void *`` type is expressed as a type derived from NULL.
4450 .. _DICompositeType:
4455 ``DICompositeType`` nodes represent types composed of other types, like
4456 structures and unions. ``elements:`` points to a tuple of the composed types.
4458 If the source language supports ODR, the ``identifier:`` field gives the unique
4459 identifier used for type merging between modules. When specified,
4460 :ref:`subprogram declarations <DISubprogramDeclaration>` and :ref:`member
4461 derived types <DIDerivedTypeMember>` that reference the ODR-type in their
4462 ``scope:`` change uniquing rules.
4464 For a given ``identifier:``, there should only be a single composite type that
4465 does not have ``flags: DIFlagFwdDecl`` set. LLVM tools that link modules
4466 together will unique such definitions at parse time via the ``identifier:``
4467 field, even if the nodes are ``distinct``.
4469 .. code-block:: text
4471 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
4472 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
4473 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
4474 !3 = !DICompositeType(tag: DW_TAG_enumeration_type, name: "Enum", file: !12,
4475 line: 2, size: 32, align: 32, identifier: "_M4Enum",
4476 elements: !{!0, !1, !2})
4478 The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
4480 .. code-block:: text
4482 DW_TAG_array_type = 1
4483 DW_TAG_class_type = 2
4484 DW_TAG_enumeration_type = 4
4485 DW_TAG_structure_type = 19
4486 DW_TAG_union_type = 23
4488 For ``DW_TAG_array_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`subrange
4489 descriptors <DISubrange>`, each representing the range of subscripts at that
4490 level of indexing. The ``DIFlagVector`` flag to ``flags:`` indicates that an
4491 array type is a native packed vector.
4493 For ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`enumerator
4494 descriptors <DIEnumerator>`, each representing the definition of an enumeration
4495 value for the set. All enumeration type descriptors are collected in the
4496 ``enums:`` field of the :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
4498 For ``DW_TAG_structure_type``, ``DW_TAG_class_type``, and
4499 ``DW_TAG_union_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`derived types
4500 <DIDerivedType>` with ``tag: DW_TAG_member``, ``tag: DW_TAG_inheritance``, or
4501 ``tag: DW_TAG_friend``; or :ref:`subprograms <DISubprogram>` with
4502 ``isDefinition: false``.
4509 ``DISubrange`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_array_type`` variants of
4510 :ref:`DICompositeType`.
4512 - ``count: -1`` indicates an empty array.
4513 - ``count: !9`` describes the count with a :ref:`DILocalVariable`.
4514 - ``count: !11`` describes the count with a :ref:`DIGlobalVariable`.
4516 .. code-block:: text
4518 !0 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 0) ; array counting from 0
4519 !1 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 1) ; array counting from 1
4520 !2 = !DISubrange(count: -1) ; empty array.
4522 ; Scopes used in rest of example
4523 !6 = !DIFile(filename: "vla.c", directory: "/path/to/file")
4524 !7 = distinct !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, file: !6)
4525 !8 = distinct !DISubprogram(name: "foo", scope: !7, file: !6, line: 5)
4527 ; Use of local variable as count value
4528 !9 = !DIBasicType(name: "int", size: 32, encoding: DW_ATE_signed)
4529 !10 = !DILocalVariable(name: "count", scope: !8, file: !6, line: 42, type: !9)
4530 !11 = !DISubrange(count: !10, lowerBound: 0)
4532 ; Use of global variable as count value
4533 !12 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "count", scope: !8, file: !6, line: 22, type: !9)
4534 !13 = !DISubrange(count: !12, lowerBound: 0)
4541 ``DIEnumerator`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``
4542 variants of :ref:`DICompositeType`.
4544 .. code-block:: text
4546 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
4547 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
4548 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
4550 DITemplateTypeParameter
4551 """""""""""""""""""""""
4553 ``DITemplateTypeParameter`` nodes represent type parameters to generic source
4554 language constructs. They are used (optionally) in :ref:`DICompositeType` and
4555 :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
4557 .. code-block:: text
4559 !0 = !DITemplateTypeParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1)
4561 DITemplateValueParameter
4562 """"""""""""""""""""""""
4564 ``DITemplateValueParameter`` nodes represent value parameters to generic source
4565 language constructs. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_template_value_parameter``,
4566 but if specified can also be set to ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param`` or
4567 ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_param_pack``. They are used (optionally) in
4568 :ref:`DICompositeType` and :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
4570 .. code-block:: text
4572 !0 = !DITemplateValueParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1, value: i32 7)
4577 ``DINamespace`` nodes represent namespaces in the source language.
4579 .. code-block:: text
4581 !0 = !DINamespace(name: "myawesomeproject", scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7)
4583 .. _DIGlobalVariable:
4588 ``DIGlobalVariable`` nodes represent global variables in the source language.
4590 .. code-block:: text
4592 @foo = global i32, !dbg !0
4593 !0 = !DIGlobalVariableExpression(var: !1, expr: !DIExpression())
4594 !1 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "foo", linkageName: "foo", scope: !2,
4595 file: !3, line: 7, type: !4, isLocal: true,
4596 isDefinition: false, declaration: !5)
4599 DIGlobalVariableExpression
4600 """"""""""""""""""""""""""
4602 ``DIGlobalVariableExpression`` nodes tie a :ref:`DIGlobalVariable` together
4603 with a :ref:`DIExpression`.
4605 .. code-block:: text
4607 @lower = global i32, !dbg !0
4608 @upper = global i32, !dbg !1
4609 !0 = !DIGlobalVariableExpression(
4611 expr: !DIExpression(DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 0, 32)
4613 !1 = !DIGlobalVariableExpression(
4615 expr: !DIExpression(DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 32, 32)
4617 !2 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "split64", linkageName: "split64", scope: !3,
4618 file: !4, line: 8, type: !5, declaration: !6)
4620 All global variable expressions should be referenced by the `globals:` field of
4621 a :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
4628 ``DISubprogram`` nodes represent functions from the source language. A
4629 distinct ``DISubprogram`` may be attached to a function definition using
4630 ``!dbg`` metadata. A unique ``DISubprogram`` may be attached to a function
4631 declaration used for call site debug info. The ``variables:`` field points at
4632 :ref:`variables <DILocalVariable>` that must be retained, even if their IR
4633 counterparts are optimized out of the IR. The ``type:`` field must point at an
4634 :ref:`DISubroutineType`.
4636 .. _DISubprogramDeclaration:
4638 When ``isDefinition: false``, subprograms describe a declaration in the type
4639 tree as opposed to a definition of a function. If the scope is a composite
4640 type with an ODR ``identifier:`` and that does not set ``flags: DIFwdDecl``,
4641 then the subprogram declaration is uniqued based only on its ``linkageName:``
4644 .. code-block:: text
4646 define void @_Z3foov() !dbg !0 {
4650 !0 = distinct !DISubprogram(name: "foo", linkageName: "_Zfoov", scope: !1,
4651 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
4652 isDefinition: true, scopeLine: 8,
4654 virtuality: DW_VIRTUALITY_pure_virtual,
4655 virtualIndex: 10, flags: DIFlagPrototyped,
4656 isOptimized: true, unit: !5, templateParams: !6,
4657 declaration: !7, variables: !8, thrownTypes: !9)
4664 ``DILexicalBlock`` nodes describe nested blocks within a :ref:`subprogram
4665 <DISubprogram>`. The line number and column numbers are used to distinguish
4666 two lexical blocks at same depth. They are valid targets for ``scope:``
4669 .. code-block:: text
4671 !0 = distinct !DILexicalBlock(scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7, column: 35)
4673 Usually lexical blocks are ``distinct`` to prevent node merging based on
4676 .. _DILexicalBlockFile:
4681 ``DILexicalBlockFile`` nodes are used to discriminate between sections of a
4682 :ref:`lexical block <DILexicalBlock>`. The ``file:`` field can be changed to
4683 indicate textual inclusion, or the ``discriminator:`` field can be used to
4684 discriminate between control flow within a single block in the source language.
4686 .. code-block:: text
4688 !0 = !DILexicalBlock(scope: !3, file: !4, line: 7, column: 35)
4689 !1 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 0)
4690 !2 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 1)
4697 ``DILocation`` nodes represent source debug locations. The ``scope:`` field is
4698 mandatory, and points at an :ref:`DILexicalBlockFile`, an
4699 :ref:`DILexicalBlock`, or an :ref:`DISubprogram`.
4701 .. code-block:: text
4703 !0 = !DILocation(line: 2900, column: 42, scope: !1, inlinedAt: !2)
4705 .. _DILocalVariable:
4710 ``DILocalVariable`` nodes represent local variables in the source language. If
4711 the ``arg:`` field is set to non-zero, then this variable is a subprogram
4712 parameter, and it will be included in the ``variables:`` field of its
4713 :ref:`DISubprogram`.
4715 .. code-block:: text
4717 !0 = !DILocalVariable(name: "this", arg: 1, scope: !3, file: !2, line: 7,
4718 type: !3, flags: DIFlagArtificial)
4719 !1 = !DILocalVariable(name: "x", arg: 2, scope: !4, file: !2, line: 7,
4721 !2 = !DILocalVariable(name: "y", scope: !5, file: !2, line: 7, type: !3)
4728 ``DIExpression`` nodes represent expressions that are inspired by the DWARF
4729 expression language. They are used in :ref:`debug intrinsics<dbg_intrinsics>`
4730 (such as ``llvm.dbg.declare`` and ``llvm.dbg.value``) to describe how the
4731 referenced LLVM variable relates to the source language variable. Debug
4732 intrinsics are interpreted left-to-right: start by pushing the value/address
4733 operand of the intrinsic onto a stack, then repeatedly push and evaluate
4734 opcodes from the DIExpression until the final variable description is produced.
4736 The current supported opcode vocabulary is limited:
4738 - ``DW_OP_deref`` dereferences the top of the expression stack.
4739 - ``DW_OP_plus`` pops the last two entries from the expression stack, adds
4740 them together and appends the result to the expression stack.
4741 - ``DW_OP_minus`` pops the last two entries from the expression stack, subtracts
4742 the last entry from the second last entry and appends the result to the
4744 - ``DW_OP_plus_uconst, 93`` adds ``93`` to the working expression.
4745 - ``DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 16, 8`` specifies the offset and size (``16`` and ``8``
4746 here, respectively) of the variable fragment from the working expression. Note
4747 that contrary to DW_OP_bit_piece, the offset is describing the location
4748 within the described source variable.
4749 - ``DW_OP_LLVM_convert, 16, DW_ATE_signed`` specifies a bit size and encoding
4750 (``16`` and ``DW_ATE_signed`` here, respectively) to which the top of the
4751 expression stack is to be converted. Maps into a ``DW_OP_convert`` operation
4752 that references a base type constructed from the supplied values.
4753 - ``DW_OP_LLVM_tag_offset, tag_offset`` specifies that a memory tag should be
4754 optionally applied to the pointer. The memory tag is derived from the
4755 given tag offset in an implementation-defined manner.
4756 - ``DW_OP_swap`` swaps top two stack entries.
4757 - ``DW_OP_xderef`` provides extended dereference mechanism. The entry at the top
4758 of the stack is treated as an address. The second stack entry is treated as an
4759 address space identifier.
4760 - ``DW_OP_stack_value`` marks a constant value.
4761 - If an expression is marked with ``DW_OP_entry_value`` all register and
4762 memory read operations refer to the respective value at the function entry.
4763 The first operand of ``DW_OP_entry_value`` is the size of following
4765 ``DW_OP_entry_value`` may appear after the ``LiveDebugValues`` pass.
4766 LLVM only supports entry values for function parameters
4767 that are unmodified throughout a function and that are described as
4768 simple register location descriptions.
4769 ``DW_OP_entry_value`` may also appear after the ``AsmPrinter`` pass when
4770 a call site parameter value (``DW_AT_call_site_parameter_value``)
4771 is represented as entry value of the parameter.
4773 DWARF specifies three kinds of simple location descriptions: Register, memory,
4774 and implicit location descriptions. Note that a location description is
4775 defined over certain ranges of a program, i.e the location of a variable may
4776 change over the course of the program. Register and memory location
4777 descriptions describe the *concrete location* of a source variable (in the
4778 sense that a debugger might modify its value), whereas *implicit locations*
4779 describe merely the actual *value* of a source variable which might not exist
4780 in registers or in memory (see ``DW_OP_stack_value``).
4782 A ``llvm.dbg.addr`` or ``llvm.dbg.declare`` intrinsic describes an indirect
4783 value (the address) of a source variable. The first operand of the intrinsic
4784 must be an address of some kind. A DIExpression attached to the intrinsic
4785 refines this address to produce a concrete location for the source variable.
4787 A ``llvm.dbg.value`` intrinsic describes the direct value of a source variable.
4788 The first operand of the intrinsic may be a direct or indirect value. A
4789 DIExpresion attached to the intrinsic refines the first operand to produce a
4790 direct value. For example, if the first operand is an indirect value, it may be
4791 necessary to insert ``DW_OP_deref`` into the DIExpresion in order to produce a
4792 valid debug intrinsic.
4796 A DIExpression is interpreted in the same way regardless of which kind of
4797 debug intrinsic it's attached to.
4799 .. code-block:: text
4801 !0 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref)
4802 !1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_plus_uconst, 3)
4803 !1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_constu, 3, DW_OP_plus)
4804 !2 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7)
4805 !3 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref, DW_OP_constu, 3, DW_OP_plus, DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 3, 7)
4806 !4 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_constu, 2, DW_OP_swap, DW_OP_xderef)
4807 !5 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_constu, 42, DW_OP_stack_value)
4812 These flags encode various properties of DINodes.
4814 The `ArgumentNotModified` flag marks a function argument whose value
4815 is not modified throughout of a function. This flag is used to decide
4816 whether a DW_OP_entry_value can be used in a location description
4817 after the function prologue. The language frontend is expected to compute
4818 this property for each DILocalVariable. The flag should be used
4819 only in optimized code.
4824 ``DIObjCProperty`` nodes represent Objective-C property nodes.
4826 .. code-block:: text
4828 !3 = !DIObjCProperty(name: "foo", file: !1, line: 7, setter: "setFoo",
4829 getter: "getFoo", attributes: 7, type: !2)
4834 ``DIImportedEntity`` nodes represent entities (such as modules) imported into a
4837 .. code-block:: text
4839 !2 = !DIImportedEntity(tag: DW_TAG_imported_module, name: "foo", scope: !0,
4840 entity: !1, line: 7)
4845 ``DIMacro`` nodes represent definition or undefinition of a macro identifiers.
4846 The ``name:`` field is the macro identifier, followed by macro parameters when
4847 defining a function-like macro, and the ``value`` field is the token-string
4848 used to expand the macro identifier.
4850 .. code-block:: text
4852 !2 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_define, line: 7, name: "foo(x)",
4854 !3 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_undef, line: 30, name: "foo")
4859 ``DIMacroFile`` nodes represent inclusion of source files.
4860 The ``nodes:`` field is a list of ``DIMacro`` and ``DIMacroFile`` nodes that
4861 appear in the included source file.
4863 .. code-block:: text
4865 !2 = !DIMacroFile(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_start_file, line: 7, file: !2,
4871 In LLVM IR, memory does not have types, so LLVM's own type system is not
4872 suitable for doing type based alias analysis (TBAA). Instead, metadata is
4873 added to the IR to describe a type system of a higher level language. This
4874 can be used to implement C/C++ strict type aliasing rules, but it can also
4875 be used to implement custom alias analysis behavior for other languages.
4877 This description of LLVM's TBAA system is broken into two parts:
4878 :ref:`Semantics<tbaa_node_semantics>` talks about high level issues, and
4879 :ref:`Representation<tbaa_node_representation>` talks about the metadata
4880 encoding of various entities.
4882 It is always possible to trace any TBAA node to a "root" TBAA node (details
4883 in the :ref:`Representation<tbaa_node_representation>` section). TBAA
4884 nodes with different roots have an unknown aliasing relationship, and LLVM
4885 conservatively infers ``MayAlias`` between them. The rules mentioned in
4886 this section only pertain to TBAA nodes living under the same root.
4888 .. _tbaa_node_semantics:
4893 The TBAA metadata system, referred to as "struct path TBAA" (not to be
4894 confused with ``tbaa.struct``), consists of the following high level
4895 concepts: *Type Descriptors*, further subdivided into scalar type
4896 descriptors and struct type descriptors; and *Access Tags*.
4898 **Type descriptors** describe the type system of the higher level language
4899 being compiled. **Scalar type descriptors** describe types that do not
4900 contain other types. Each scalar type has a parent type, which must also
4901 be a scalar type or the TBAA root. Via this parent relation, scalar types
4902 within a TBAA root form a tree. **Struct type descriptors** denote types
4903 that contain a sequence of other type descriptors, at known offsets. These
4904 contained type descriptors can either be struct type descriptors themselves
4905 or scalar type descriptors.
4907 **Access tags** are metadata nodes attached to load and store instructions.
4908 Access tags use type descriptors to describe the *location* being accessed
4909 in terms of the type system of the higher level language. Access tags are
4910 tuples consisting of a base type, an access type and an offset. The base
4911 type is a scalar type descriptor or a struct type descriptor, the access
4912 type is a scalar type descriptor, and the offset is a constant integer.
4914 The access tag ``(BaseTy, AccessTy, Offset)`` can describe one of two
4917 * If ``BaseTy`` is a struct type, the tag describes a memory access (load
4918 or store) of a value of type ``AccessTy`` contained in the struct type
4919 ``BaseTy`` at offset ``Offset``.
4921 * If ``BaseTy`` is a scalar type, ``Offset`` must be 0 and ``BaseTy`` and
4922 ``AccessTy`` must be the same; and the access tag describes a scalar
4923 access with scalar type ``AccessTy``.
4925 We first define an ``ImmediateParent`` relation on ``(BaseTy, Offset)``
4928 * If ``BaseTy`` is a scalar type then ``ImmediateParent(BaseTy, 0)`` is
4929 ``(ParentTy, 0)`` where ``ParentTy`` is the parent of the scalar type as
4930 described in the TBAA metadata. ``ImmediateParent(BaseTy, Offset)`` is
4931 undefined if ``Offset`` is non-zero.
4933 * If ``BaseTy`` is a struct type then ``ImmediateParent(BaseTy, Offset)``
4934 is ``(NewTy, NewOffset)`` where ``NewTy`` is the type contained in
4935 ``BaseTy`` at offset ``Offset`` and ``NewOffset`` is ``Offset`` adjusted
4936 to be relative within that inner type.
4938 A memory access with an access tag ``(BaseTy1, AccessTy1, Offset1)``
4939 aliases a memory access with an access tag ``(BaseTy2, AccessTy2,
4940 Offset2)`` if either ``(BaseTy1, Offset1)`` is reachable from ``(Base2,
4941 Offset2)`` via the ``Parent`` relation or vice versa.
4943 As a concrete example, the type descriptor graph for the following program
4949 float f; // offset 4
4953 float f; // offset 0
4954 double d; // offset 4
4955 struct Inner inner_a; // offset 12
4958 void f(struct Outer* outer, struct Inner* inner, float* f, int* i, char* c) {
4959 outer->f = 0; // tag0: (OuterStructTy, FloatScalarTy, 0)
4960 outer->inner_a.i = 0; // tag1: (OuterStructTy, IntScalarTy, 12)
4961 outer->inner_a.f = 0.0; // tag2: (OuterStructTy, FloatScalarTy, 16)
4962 *f = 0.0; // tag3: (FloatScalarTy, FloatScalarTy, 0)
4965 is (note that in C and C++, ``char`` can be used to access any arbitrary
4968 .. code-block:: text
4971 CharScalarTy = ("char", Root, 0)
4972 FloatScalarTy = ("float", CharScalarTy, 0)
4973 DoubleScalarTy = ("double", CharScalarTy, 0)
4974 IntScalarTy = ("int", CharScalarTy, 0)
4975 InnerStructTy = {"Inner" (IntScalarTy, 0), (FloatScalarTy, 4)}
4976 OuterStructTy = {"Outer", (FloatScalarTy, 0), (DoubleScalarTy, 4),
4977 (InnerStructTy, 12)}
4980 with (e.g.) ``ImmediateParent(OuterStructTy, 12)`` = ``(InnerStructTy,
4981 0)``, ``ImmediateParent(InnerStructTy, 0)`` = ``(IntScalarTy, 0)``, and
4982 ``ImmediateParent(IntScalarTy, 0)`` = ``(CharScalarTy, 0)``.
4984 .. _tbaa_node_representation:
4989 The root node of a TBAA type hierarchy is an ``MDNode`` with 0 operands or
4990 with exactly one ``MDString`` operand.
4992 Scalar type descriptors are represented as an ``MDNode`` s with two
4993 operands. The first operand is an ``MDString`` denoting the name of the
4994 struct type. LLVM does not assign meaning to the value of this operand, it
4995 only cares about it being an ``MDString``. The second operand is an
4996 ``MDNode`` which points to the parent for said scalar type descriptor,
4997 which is either another scalar type descriptor or the TBAA root. Scalar
4998 type descriptors can have an optional third argument, but that must be the
4999 constant integer zero.
5001 Struct type descriptors are represented as ``MDNode`` s with an odd number
5002 of operands greater than 1. The first operand is an ``MDString`` denoting
5003 the name of the struct type. Like in scalar type descriptors the actual
5004 value of this name operand is irrelevant to LLVM. After the name operand,
5005 the struct type descriptors have a sequence of alternating ``MDNode`` and
5006 ``ConstantInt`` operands. With N starting from 1, the 2N - 1 th operand,
5007 an ``MDNode``, denotes a contained field, and the 2N th operand, a
5008 ``ConstantInt``, is the offset of the said contained field. The offsets
5009 must be in non-decreasing order.
5011 Access tags are represented as ``MDNode`` s with either 3 or 4 operands.
5012 The first operand is an ``MDNode`` pointing to the node representing the
5013 base type. The second operand is an ``MDNode`` pointing to the node
5014 representing the access type. The third operand is a ``ConstantInt`` that
5015 states the offset of the access. If a fourth field is present, it must be
5016 a ``ConstantInt`` valued at 0 or 1. If it is 1 then the access tag states
5017 that the location being accessed is "constant" (meaning
5018 ``pointsToConstantMemory`` should return true; see `other useful
5019 AliasAnalysis methods <AliasAnalysis.html#OtherItfs>`_). The TBAA root of
5020 the access type and the base type of an access tag must be the same, and
5021 that is the TBAA root of the access tag.
5023 '``tbaa.struct``' Metadata
5024 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5026 The :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>` is often used to implement
5027 aggregate assignment operations in C and similar languages, however it
5028 is defined to copy a contiguous region of memory, which is more than
5029 strictly necessary for aggregate types which contain holes due to
5030 padding. Also, it doesn't contain any TBAA information about the fields
5033 ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata can describe which memory subregions in a
5034 memcpy are padding and what the TBAA tags of the struct are.
5036 The current metadata format is very simple. ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata
5037 nodes are a list of operands which are in conceptual groups of three.
5038 For each group of three, the first operand gives the byte offset of a
5039 field in bytes, the second gives its size in bytes, and the third gives
5042 .. code-block:: llvm
5044 !4 = !{ i64 0, i64 4, !1, i64 8, i64 4, !2 }
5046 This describes a struct with two fields. The first is at offset 0 bytes
5047 with size 4 bytes, and has tbaa tag !1. The second is at offset 8 bytes
5048 and has size 4 bytes and has tbaa tag !2.
5050 Note that the fields need not be contiguous. In this example, there is a
5051 4 byte gap between the two fields. This gap represents padding which
5052 does not carry useful data and need not be preserved.
5054 '``noalias``' and '``alias.scope``' Metadata
5055 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5057 ``noalias`` and ``alias.scope`` metadata provide the ability to specify generic
5058 noalias memory-access sets. This means that some collection of memory access
5059 instructions (loads, stores, memory-accessing calls, etc.) that carry
5060 ``noalias`` metadata can specifically be specified not to alias with some other
5061 collection of memory access instructions that carry ``alias.scope`` metadata.
5062 Each type of metadata specifies a list of scopes where each scope has an id and
5065 When evaluating an aliasing query, if for some domain, the set
5066 of scopes with that domain in one instruction's ``alias.scope`` list is a
5067 subset of (or equal to) the set of scopes for that domain in another
5068 instruction's ``noalias`` list, then the two memory accesses are assumed not to
5071 Because scopes in one domain don't affect scopes in other domains, separate
5072 domains can be used to compose multiple independent noalias sets. This is
5073 used for example during inlining. As the noalias function parameters are
5074 turned into noalias scope metadata, a new domain is used every time the
5075 function is inlined.
5077 The metadata identifying each domain is itself a list containing one or two
5078 entries. The first entry is the name of the domain. Note that if the name is a
5079 string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
5080 self-reference can be used to create globally unique domain names. A
5081 descriptive string may optionally be provided as a second list entry.
5083 The metadata identifying each scope is also itself a list containing two or
5084 three entries. The first entry is the name of the scope. Note that if the name
5085 is a string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
5086 self-reference can be used to create globally unique scope names. A metadata
5087 reference to the scope's domain is the second entry. A descriptive string may
5088 optionally be provided as a third list entry.
5092 .. code-block:: llvm
5094 ; Two scope domains:
5098 ; Some scopes in these domains:
5104 !5 = !{!4} ; A list containing only scope !4
5108 ; These two instructions don't alias:
5109 %0 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
5110 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !5
5112 ; These two instructions also don't alias (for domain !1, the set of scopes
5113 ; in the !alias.scope equals that in the !noalias list):
5114 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
5115 store float %2, float* %arrayidx.i2, align 4, !noalias !6
5117 ; These two instructions may alias (for domain !0, the set of scopes in
5118 ; the !noalias list is not a superset of, or equal to, the scopes in the
5119 ; !alias.scope list):
5120 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !6
5121 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !7
5123 '``fpmath``' Metadata
5124 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5126 ``fpmath`` metadata may be attached to any instruction of floating-point
5127 type. It can be used to express the maximum acceptable error in the
5128 result of that instruction, in ULPs, thus potentially allowing the
5129 compiler to use a more efficient but less accurate method of computing
5130 it. ULP is defined as follows:
5132 If ``x`` is a real number that lies between two finite consecutive
5133 floating-point numbers ``a`` and ``b``, without being equal to one
5134 of them, then ``ulp(x) = |b - a|``, otherwise ``ulp(x)`` is the
5135 distance between the two non-equal finite floating-point numbers
5136 nearest ``x``. Moreover, ``ulp(NaN)`` is ``NaN``.
5138 The metadata node shall consist of a single positive float type number
5139 representing the maximum relative error, for example:
5141 .. code-block:: llvm
5143 !0 = !{ float 2.5 } ; maximum acceptable inaccuracy is 2.5 ULPs
5147 '``range``' Metadata
5148 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5150 ``range`` metadata may be attached only to ``load``, ``call`` and ``invoke`` of
5151 integer types. It expresses the possible ranges the loaded value or the value
5152 returned by the called function at this call site is in. If the loaded or
5153 returned value is not in the specified range, the behavior is undefined. The
5154 ranges are represented with a flattened list of integers. The loaded value or
5155 the value returned is known to be in the union of the ranges defined by each
5156 consecutive pair. Each pair has the following properties:
5158 - The type must match the type loaded by the instruction.
5159 - The pair ``a,b`` represents the range ``[a,b)``.
5160 - Both ``a`` and ``b`` are constants.
5161 - The range is allowed to wrap.
5162 - The range should not represent the full or empty set. That is,
5165 In addition, the pairs must be in signed order of the lower bound and
5166 they must be non-contiguous.
5170 .. code-block:: llvm
5172 %a = load i8, i8* %x, align 1, !range !0 ; Can only be 0 or 1
5173 %b = load i8, i8* %y, align 1, !range !1 ; Can only be 255 (-1), 0 or 1
5174 %c = call i8 @foo(), !range !2 ; Can only be 0, 1, 3, 4 or 5
5175 %d = invoke i8 @bar() to label %cont
5176 unwind label %lpad, !range !3 ; Can only be -2, -1, 3, 4 or 5
5178 !0 = !{ i8 0, i8 2 }
5179 !1 = !{ i8 255, i8 2 }
5180 !2 = !{ i8 0, i8 2, i8 3, i8 6 }
5181 !3 = !{ i8 -2, i8 0, i8 3, i8 6 }
5183 '``absolute_symbol``' Metadata
5184 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5186 ``absolute_symbol`` metadata may be attached to a global variable
5187 declaration. It marks the declaration as a reference to an absolute symbol,
5188 which causes the backend to use absolute relocations for the symbol even
5189 in position independent code, and expresses the possible ranges that the
5190 global variable's *address* (not its value) is in, in the same format as
5191 ``range`` metadata, with the extension that the pair ``all-ones,all-ones``
5192 may be used to represent the full set.
5194 Example (assuming 64-bit pointers):
5196 .. code-block:: llvm
5198 @a = external global i8, !absolute_symbol !0 ; Absolute symbol in range [0,256)
5199 @b = external global i8, !absolute_symbol !1 ; Absolute symbol in range [0,2^64)
5202 !0 = !{ i64 0, i64 256 }
5203 !1 = !{ i64 -1, i64 -1 }
5205 '``callees``' Metadata
5206 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5208 ``callees`` metadata may be attached to indirect call sites. If ``callees``
5209 metadata is attached to a call site, and any callee is not among the set of
5210 functions provided by the metadata, the behavior is undefined. The intent of
5211 this metadata is to facilitate optimizations such as indirect-call promotion.
5212 For example, in the code below, the call instruction may only target the
5213 ``add`` or ``sub`` functions:
5215 .. code-block:: llvm
5217 %result = call i64 %binop(i64 %x, i64 %y), !callees !0
5220 !0 = !{i64 (i64, i64)* @add, i64 (i64, i64)* @sub}
5222 '``callback``' Metadata
5223 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5225 ``callback`` metadata may be attached to a function declaration, or definition.
5226 (Call sites are excluded only due to the lack of a use case.) For ease of
5227 exposition, we'll refer to the function annotated w/ metadata as a broker
5228 function. The metadata describes how the arguments of a call to the broker are
5229 in turn passed to the callback function specified by the metadata. Thus, the
5230 ``callback`` metadata provides a partial description of a call site inside the
5231 broker function with regards to the arguments of a call to the broker. The only
5232 semantic restriction on the broker function itself is that it is not allowed to
5233 inspect or modify arguments referenced in the ``callback`` metadata as
5234 pass-through to the callback function.
5236 The broker is not required to actually invoke the callback function at runtime.
5237 However, the assumptions about not inspecting or modifying arguments that would
5238 be passed to the specified callback function still hold, even if the callback
5239 function is not dynamically invoked. The broker is allowed to invoke the
5240 callback function more than once per invocation of the broker. The broker is
5241 also allowed to invoke (directly or indirectly) the function passed as a
5242 callback through another use. Finally, the broker is also allowed to relay the
5243 callback callee invocation to a different thread.
5245 The metadata is structured as follows: At the outer level, ``callback``
5246 metadata is a list of ``callback`` encodings. Each encoding starts with a
5247 constant ``i64`` which describes the argument position of the callback function
5248 in the call to the broker. The following elements, except the last, describe
5249 what arguments are passed to the callback function. Each element is again an
5250 ``i64`` constant identifying the argument of the broker that is passed through,
5251 or ``i64 -1`` to indicate an unknown or inspected argument. The order in which
5252 they are listed has to be the same in which they are passed to the callback
5253 callee. The last element of the encoding is a boolean which specifies how
5254 variadic arguments of the broker are handled. If it is true, all variadic
5255 arguments of the broker are passed through to the callback function *after* the
5256 arguments encoded explicitly before.
5258 In the code below, the ``pthread_create`` function is marked as a broker
5259 through the ``!callback !1`` metadata. In the example, there is only one
5260 callback encoding, namely ``!2``, associated with the broker. This encoding
5261 identifies the callback function as the second argument of the broker (``i64
5262 2``) and the sole argument of the callback function as the third one of the
5263 broker function (``i64 3``).
5265 .. FIXME why does the llvm-sphinx-docs builder give a highlighting
5266 error if the below is set to highlight as 'llvm', despite that we
5267 have misc.highlighting_failure set?
5269 .. code-block:: text
5271 declare !callback !1 dso_local i32 @pthread_create(i64*, %union.pthread_attr_t*, i8* (i8*)*, i8*)
5274 !2 = !{i64 2, i64 3, i1 false}
5277 Another example is shown below. The callback callee is the second argument of
5278 the ``__kmpc_fork_call`` function (``i64 2``). The callee is given two unknown
5279 values (each identified by a ``i64 -1``) and afterwards all
5280 variadic arguments that are passed to the ``__kmpc_fork_call`` call (due to the
5283 .. FIXME why does the llvm-sphinx-docs builder give a highlighting
5284 error if the below is set to highlight as 'llvm', despite that we
5285 have misc.highlighting_failure set?
5287 .. code-block:: text
5289 declare !callback !0 dso_local void @__kmpc_fork_call(%struct.ident_t*, i32, void (i32*, i32*, ...)*, ...)
5292 !1 = !{i64 2, i64 -1, i64 -1, i1 true}
5296 '``unpredictable``' Metadata
5297 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5299 ``unpredictable`` metadata may be attached to any branch or switch
5300 instruction. It can be used to express the unpredictability of control
5301 flow. Similar to the llvm.expect intrinsic, it may be used to alter
5302 optimizations related to compare and branch instructions. The metadata
5303 is treated as a boolean value; if it exists, it signals that the branch
5304 or switch that it is attached to is completely unpredictable.
5306 .. _md_dereferenceable:
5308 '``dereferenceable``' Metadata
5309 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5311 The existence of the ``!dereferenceable`` metadata on the instruction
5312 tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be dereferenceable.
5313 The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
5314 value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable''
5315 attribute on parameters and return values.
5317 .. _md_dereferenceable_or_null:
5319 '``dereferenceable_or_null``' Metadata
5320 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5322 The existence of the ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata on the
5323 instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be either
5324 dereferenceable or null.
5325 The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
5326 value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable_or_null''
5327 attribute on parameters and return values.
5334 It is sometimes useful to attach information to loop constructs. Currently,
5335 loop metadata is implemented as metadata attached to the branch instruction
5336 in the loop latch block. This type of metadata refer to a metadata node that is
5337 guaranteed to be separate for each loop. The loop identifier metadata is
5338 specified with the name ``llvm.loop``.
5340 The loop identifier metadata is implemented using a metadata that refers to
5341 itself to avoid merging it with any other identifier metadata, e.g.,
5342 during module linkage or function inlining. That is, each loop should refer
5343 to their own identification metadata even if they reside in separate functions.
5344 The following example contains loop identifier metadata for two separate loop
5347 .. code-block:: llvm
5352 The loop identifier metadata can be used to specify additional
5353 per-loop metadata. Any operands after the first operand can be treated
5354 as user-defined metadata. For example the ``llvm.loop.unroll.count``
5355 suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller:
5357 .. code-block:: llvm
5359 br i1 %exitcond, label %._crit_edge, label %.lr.ph, !llvm.loop !0
5362 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
5364 '``llvm.loop.disable_nonforced``'
5365 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5367 This metadata disables all optional loop transformations unless
5368 explicitly instructed using other transformation metdata such as
5369 ``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``. That is, no heuristic will try to determine
5370 whether a transformation is profitable. The purpose is to avoid that the
5371 loop is transformed to a different loop before an explicitly requested
5372 (forced) transformation is applied. For instance, loop fusion can make
5373 other transformations impossible. Mandatory loop canonicalizations such
5374 as loop rotation are still applied.
5376 It is recommended to use this metadata in addition to any llvm.loop.*
5377 transformation directive. Also, any loop should have at most one
5378 directive applied to it (and a sequence of transformations built using
5379 followup-attributes). Otherwise, which transformation will be applied
5380 depends on implementation details such as the pass pipeline order.
5382 See :ref:`transformation-metadata` for details.
5384 '``llvm.loop.vectorize``' and '``llvm.loop.interleave``'
5385 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5387 Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` or ``llvm.loop.interleave`` are
5388 used to control per-loop vectorization and interleaving parameters such as
5389 vectorization width and interleave count. These metadata should be used in
5390 conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop identification metadata. The
5391 ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` and ``llvm.loop.interleave`` metadata are only
5392 optimization hints and the optimizer will only interleave and vectorize loops if
5393 it believes it is safe to do so. The ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses`` metadata
5394 which contains information about loop-carried memory dependencies can be helpful
5395 in determining the safety of these transformations.
5397 '``llvm.loop.interleave.count``' Metadata
5398 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5400 This metadata suggests an interleave count to the loop interleaver.
5401 The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` and the
5402 second operand is an integer specifying the interleave count. For
5405 .. code-block:: llvm
5407 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.interleave.count", i32 4}
5409 Note that setting ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` to 1 disables interleaving
5410 multiple iterations of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` is set to 0
5411 then the interleave count will be determined automatically.
5413 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable``' Metadata
5414 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5416 This metadata selectively enables or disables vectorization for the loop. The
5417 first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable`` and the second operand
5418 is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 vectorization is enabled. A value of
5419 0 disables vectorization:
5421 .. code-block:: llvm
5423 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 0}
5424 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 1}
5426 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.width``' Metadata
5427 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5429 This metadata sets the target width of the vectorizer. The first
5430 operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` and the second
5431 operand is an integer specifying the width. For example:
5433 .. code-block:: llvm
5435 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.width", i32 4}
5437 Note that setting ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` to 1 disables
5438 vectorization of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` is set to
5439 0 or if the loop does not have this metadata the width will be
5440 determined automatically.
5442 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.followup_vectorized``' Metadata
5443 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5445 This metadata defines which loop attributes the vectorized loop will
5446 have. See :ref:`transformation-metadata` for details.
5448 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.followup_epilogue``' Metadata
5449 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5451 This metadata defines which loop attributes the epilogue will have. The
5452 epilogue is not vectorized and is executed when either the vectorized
5453 loop is not known to preserve semantics (because e.g., it processes two
5454 arrays that are found to alias by a runtime check) or for the last
5455 iterations that do not fill a complete set of vector lanes. See
5456 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5458 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.followup_all``' Metadata
5459 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5461 Attributes in the metadata will be added to both the vectorized and
5463 See :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5465 '``llvm.loop.unroll``'
5466 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5468 Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.unroll`` are loop unrolling
5469 optimization hints such as the unroll factor. ``llvm.loop.unroll``
5470 metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop
5471 identification metadata. The ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata are only
5472 optimization hints and the unrolling will only be performed if the
5473 optimizer believes it is safe to do so.
5475 '``llvm.loop.unroll.count``' Metadata
5476 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5478 This metadata suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller. The
5479 first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.count`` and the second
5480 operand is a positive integer specifying the unroll factor. For
5483 .. code-block:: llvm
5485 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
5487 If the trip count of the loop is less than the unroll count the loop
5488 will be partially unrolled.
5490 '``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``' Metadata
5491 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5493 This metadata disables loop unrolling. The metadata has a single operand
5494 which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``. For example:
5496 .. code-block:: llvm
5498 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.disable"}
5500 '``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``' Metadata
5501 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5503 This metadata disables runtime loop unrolling. The metadata has a single
5504 operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``. For example:
5506 .. code-block:: llvm
5508 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable"}
5510 '``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``' Metadata
5511 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5513 This metadata suggests that the loop should be fully unrolled if the trip count
5514 is known at compile time and partially unrolled if the trip count is not known
5515 at compile time. The metadata has a single operand which is the string
5516 ``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``. For example:
5518 .. code-block:: llvm
5520 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.enable"}
5522 '``llvm.loop.unroll.full``' Metadata
5523 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5525 This metadata suggests that the loop should be unrolled fully. The
5526 metadata has a single operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.full``.
5529 .. code-block:: llvm
5531 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.full"}
5533 '``llvm.loop.unroll.followup``' Metadata
5534 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5536 This metadata defines which loop attributes the unrolled loop will have.
5537 See :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5539 '``llvm.loop.unroll.followup_remainder``' Metadata
5540 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5542 This metadata defines which loop attributes the remainder loop after
5543 partial/runtime unrolling will have. See
5544 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5546 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam``'
5547 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5549 This metadata is treated very similarly to the ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata
5550 above, but affect the unroll and jam pass. In addition any loop with
5551 ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata but no ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam`` metadata will
5552 disable unroll and jam (so ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata will be left to the
5553 unroller, plus ``llvm.loop.unroll.disable`` metadata will disable unroll and jam
5556 The metadata for unroll and jam otherwise is the same as for ``unroll``.
5557 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable``, ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable`` and
5558 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count`` do the same as for unroll.
5559 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.full`` is not supported. Again these are only hints
5560 and the normal safety checks will still be performed.
5562 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count``' Metadata
5563 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5565 This metadata suggests an unroll and jam factor to use, similarly to
5566 ``llvm.loop.unroll.count``. The first operand is the string
5567 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count`` and the second operand is a positive integer
5568 specifying the unroll factor. For example:
5570 .. code-block:: llvm
5572 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count", i32 4}
5574 If the trip count of the loop is less than the unroll count the loop
5575 will be partially unroll and jammed.
5577 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable``' Metadata
5578 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5580 This metadata disables loop unroll and jamming. The metadata has a single
5581 operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable``. For example:
5583 .. code-block:: llvm
5585 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable"}
5587 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable``' Metadata
5588 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5590 This metadata suggests that the loop should be fully unroll and jammed if the
5591 trip count is known at compile time and partially unrolled if the trip count is
5592 not known at compile time. The metadata has a single operand which is the
5593 string ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable``. For example:
5595 .. code-block:: llvm
5597 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable"}
5599 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.followup_outer``' Metadata
5600 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5602 This metadata defines which loop attributes the outer unrolled loop will
5603 have. See :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for
5606 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.followup_inner``' Metadata
5607 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5609 This metadata defines which loop attributes the inner jammed loop will
5610 have. See :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for
5613 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.followup_remainder_outer``' Metadata
5614 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5616 This metadata defines which attributes the epilogue of the outer loop
5617 will have. This loop is usually unrolled, meaning there is no such
5618 loop. This attribute will be ignored in this case. See
5619 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5621 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.followup_remainder_inner``' Metadata
5622 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5624 This metadata defines which attributes the inner loop of the epilogue
5625 will have. The outer epilogue will usually be unrolled, meaning there
5626 can be multiple inner remainder loops. See
5627 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5629 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.followup_all``' Metadata
5630 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5632 Attributes specified in the metadata is added to all
5633 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.*`` loops. See
5634 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5636 '``llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable``' Metadata
5637 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5639 This metadata indicates that the loop should not be versioned for the purpose
5640 of enabling loop-invariant code motion (LICM). The metadata has a single operand
5641 which is the string ``llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable``. For example:
5643 .. code-block:: llvm
5645 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable"}
5647 '``llvm.loop.distribute.enable``' Metadata
5648 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5650 Loop distribution allows splitting a loop into multiple loops. Currently,
5651 this is only performed if the entire loop cannot be vectorized due to unsafe
5652 memory dependencies. The transformation will attempt to isolate the unsafe
5653 dependencies into their own loop.
5655 This metadata can be used to selectively enable or disable distribution of the
5656 loop. The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.distribute.enable`` and the
5657 second operand is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 distribution is
5658 enabled. A value of 0 disables distribution:
5660 .. code-block:: llvm
5662 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.distribute.enable", i1 0}
5663 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.distribute.enable", i1 1}
5665 This metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop
5666 identification metadata.
5668 '``llvm.loop.distribute.followup_coincident``' Metadata
5669 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5671 This metadata defines which attributes extracted loops with no cyclic
5672 dependencies will have (i.e. can be vectorized). See
5673 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5675 '``llvm.loop.distribute.followup_sequential``' Metadata
5676 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5678 This metadata defines which attributes the isolated loops with unsafe
5679 memory dependencies will have. See
5680 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5682 '``llvm.loop.distribute.followup_fallback``' Metadata
5683 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5685 If loop versioning is necessary, this metadata defined the attributes
5686 the non-distributed fallback version will have. See
5687 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5689 '``llvm.loop.distribute.followup_all``' Metadata
5690 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5692 Thes attributes in this metdata is added to all followup loops of the
5693 loop distribution pass. See
5694 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5696 '``llvm.access.group``' Metadata
5697 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5699 ``llvm.access.group`` metadata can be attached to any instruction that
5700 potentially accesses memory. It can point to a single distinct metadata
5701 node, which we call access group. This node represents all memory access
5702 instructions referring to it via ``llvm.access.group``. When an
5703 instruction belongs to multiple access groups, it can also point to a
5704 list of accesses groups, illustrated by the following example.
5706 .. code-block:: llvm
5708 %val = load i32, i32* %arrayidx, !llvm.access.group !0
5714 It is illegal for the list node to be empty since it might be confused
5715 with an access group.
5717 The access group metadata node must be 'distinct' to avoid collapsing
5718 multiple access groups by content. A access group metadata node must
5719 always be empty which can be used to distinguish an access group
5720 metadata node from a list of access groups. Being empty avoids the
5721 situation that the content must be updated which, because metadata is
5722 immutable by design, would required finding and updating all references
5723 to the access group node.
5725 The access group can be used to refer to a memory access instruction
5726 without pointing to it directly (which is not possible in global
5727 metadata). Currently, the only metadata making use of it is
5728 ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses``.
5730 '``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses``' Metadata
5731 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5733 The ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses`` metadata refers to one or more
5734 access group metadata nodes (see ``llvm.access.group``). It denotes that
5735 no loop-carried memory dependence exist between it and other instructions
5736 in the loop with this metadata.
5738 Let ``m1`` and ``m2`` be two instructions that both have the
5739 ``llvm.access.group`` metadata to the access group ``g1``, respectively
5740 ``g2`` (which might be identical). If a loop contains both access groups
5741 in its ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses`` metadata, then the compiler can
5742 assume that there is no dependency between ``m1`` and ``m2`` carried by
5743 this loop. Instructions that belong to multiple access groups are
5744 considered having this property if at least one of the access groups
5745 matches the ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses`` list.
5747 If all memory-accessing instructions in a loop have
5748 ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses`` metadata that refers to that loop, then the
5749 loop has no loop carried memory dependences and is considered to be a
5752 Note that if not all memory access instructions belong to an access
5753 group referred to by ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses``, then the loop must
5754 not be considered trivially parallel. Additional
5755 memory dependence analysis is required to make that determination. As a fail
5756 safe mechanism, this causes loops that were originally parallel to be considered
5757 sequential (if optimization passes that are unaware of the parallel semantics
5758 insert new memory instructions into the loop body).
5760 Example of a loop that is considered parallel due to its correct use of
5761 both ``llvm.access.group`` and ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses``
5764 .. code-block:: llvm
5768 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx, !llvm.access.group !1
5770 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.access.group !1
5772 br i1 %exitcond, label %for.end, label %for.body, !llvm.loop !0
5776 !0 = distinct !{!0, !{!"llvm.loop.parallel_accesses", !1}}
5779 It is also possible to have nested parallel loops:
5781 .. code-block:: llvm
5785 %val1 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx3, !llvm.access.group !4
5787 br label %inner.for.body
5791 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.access.group !3
5793 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx2, !llvm.access.group !3
5795 br i1 %exitcond, label %inner.for.end, label %inner.for.body, !llvm.loop !1
5799 store i32 %val1, i32* %arrayidx4, !llvm.access.group !4
5801 br i1 %exitcond, label %outer.for.end, label %outer.for.body, !llvm.loop !2
5803 outer.for.end: ; preds = %for.body
5805 !1 = distinct !{!1, !{!"llvm.loop.parallel_accesses", !3}} ; metadata for the inner loop
5806 !2 = distinct !{!2, !{!"llvm.loop.parallel_accesses", !3, !4}} ; metadata for the outer loop
5807 !3 = distinct !{} ; access group for instructions in the inner loop (which are implicitly contained in outer loop as well)
5808 !4 = distinct !{} ; access group for instructions in the outer, but not the inner loop
5810 '``irr_loop``' Metadata
5811 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5813 ``irr_loop`` metadata may be attached to the terminator instruction of a basic
5814 block that's an irreducible loop header (note that an irreducible loop has more
5815 than once header basic blocks.) If ``irr_loop`` metadata is attached to the
5816 terminator instruction of a basic block that is not really an irreducible loop
5817 header, the behavior is undefined. The intent of this metadata is to improve the
5818 accuracy of the block frequency propagation. For example, in the code below, the
5819 block ``header0`` may have a loop header weight (relative to the other headers of
5820 the irreducible loop) of 100:
5822 .. code-block:: llvm
5826 br i1 %cmp, label %t1, label %t2, !irr_loop !0
5829 !0 = !{"loop_header_weight", i64 100}
5831 Irreducible loop header weights are typically based on profile data.
5833 .. _md_invariant.group:
5835 '``invariant.group``' Metadata
5836 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5838 The experimental ``invariant.group`` metadata may be attached to
5839 ``load``/``store`` instructions referencing a single metadata with no entries.
5840 The existence of the ``invariant.group`` metadata on the instruction tells
5841 the optimizer that every ``load`` and ``store`` to the same pointer operand
5842 can be assumed to load or store the same
5843 value (but see the ``llvm.launder.invariant.group`` intrinsic which affects
5844 when two pointers are considered the same). Pointers returned by bitcast or
5845 getelementptr with only zero indices are considered the same.
5849 .. code-block:: llvm
5851 @unknownPtr = external global i8
5854 store i8 42, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0
5855 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
5857 %a = load i8, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that value under %ptr didn't change
5858 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
5860 %newPtr = call i8* @getPointer(i8* %ptr)
5861 %c = load i8, i8* %newPtr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't assume anything, because we only have information about %ptr
5863 %unknownValue = load i8, i8* @unknownPtr
5864 store i8 %unknownValue, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that %unknownValue == 42
5866 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
5867 %newPtr2 = call i8* @llvm.launder.invariant.group(i8* %ptr)
5868 %d = load i8, i8* %newPtr2, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't step through launder.invariant.group to get value of %ptr
5871 declare void @foo(i8*)
5872 declare i8* @getPointer(i8*)
5873 declare i8* @llvm.launder.invariant.group(i8*)
5877 The invariant.group metadata must be dropped when replacing one pointer by
5878 another based on aliasing information. This is because invariant.group is tied
5879 to the SSA value of the pointer operand.
5881 .. code-block:: llvm
5883 %v = load i8, i8* %x, !invariant.group !0
5884 ; if %x mustalias %y then we can replace the above instruction with
5885 %v = load i8, i8* %y
5887 Note that this is an experimental feature, which means that its semantics might
5888 change in the future.
5893 See :doc:`TypeMetadata`.
5895 '``associated``' Metadata
5896 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5898 The ``associated`` metadata may be attached to a global object
5899 declaration with a single argument that references another global object.
5901 This metadata prevents discarding of the global object in linker GC
5902 unless the referenced object is also discarded. The linker support for
5903 this feature is spotty. For best compatibility, globals carrying this
5906 - Be in a comdat with the referenced global.
5907 - Be in @llvm.compiler.used.
5908 - Have an explicit section with a name which is a valid C identifier.
5910 It does not have any effect on non-ELF targets.
5914 .. code-block:: text
5917 @a = global i32 1, comdat $a
5918 @b = internal global i32 2, comdat $a, section "abc", !associated !0
5925 The ``prof`` metadata is used to record profile data in the IR.
5926 The first operand of the metadata node indicates the profile metadata
5927 type. There are currently 3 types:
5928 :ref:`branch_weights<prof_node_branch_weights>`,
5929 :ref:`function_entry_count<prof_node_function_entry_count>`, and
5930 :ref:`VP<prof_node_VP>`.
5932 .. _prof_node_branch_weights:
5937 Branch weight metadata attached to a branch, select, switch or call instruction
5938 represents the likeliness of the associated branch being taken.
5939 For more information, see :doc:`BranchWeightMetadata`.
5941 .. _prof_node_function_entry_count:
5943 function_entry_count
5944 """"""""""""""""""""
5946 Function entry count metadata can be attached to function definitions
5947 to record the number of times the function is called. Used with BFI
5948 information, it is also used to derive the basic block profile count.
5949 For more information, see :doc:`BranchWeightMetadata`.
5956 VP (value profile) metadata can be attached to instructions that have
5957 value profile information. Currently this is indirect calls (where it
5958 records the hottest callees) and calls to memory intrinsics such as memcpy,
5959 memmove, and memset (where it records the hottest byte lengths).
5961 Each VP metadata node contains "VP" string, then a uint32_t value for the value
5962 profiling kind, a uint64_t value for the total number of times the instruction
5963 is executed, followed by uint64_t value and execution count pairs.
5964 The value profiling kind is 0 for indirect call targets and 1 for memory
5965 operations. For indirect call targets, each profile value is a hash
5966 of the callee function name, and for memory operations each value is the
5969 Note that the value counts do not need to add up to the total count
5970 listed in the third operand (in practice only the top hottest values
5971 are tracked and reported).
5973 Indirect call example:
5975 .. code-block:: llvm
5977 call void %f(), !prof !1
5978 !1 = !{!"VP", i32 0, i64 1600, i64 7651369219802541373, i64 1030, i64 -4377547752858689819, i64 410}
5980 Note that the VP type is 0 (the second operand), which indicates this is
5981 an indirect call value profile data. The third operand indicates that the
5982 indirect call executed 1600 times. The 4th and 6th operands give the
5983 hashes of the 2 hottest target functions' names (this is the same hash used
5984 to represent function names in the profile database), and the 5th and 7th
5985 operands give the execution count that each of the respective prior target
5986 functions was called.
5988 Module Flags Metadata
5989 =====================
5991 Information about the module as a whole is difficult to convey to LLVM's
5992 subsystems. The LLVM IR isn't sufficient to transmit this information.
5993 The ``llvm.module.flags`` named metadata exists in order to facilitate
5994 this. These flags are in the form of key / value pairs --- much like a
5995 dictionary --- making it easy for any subsystem who cares about a flag to
5998 The ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata contains a list of metadata triplets.
5999 Each triplet has the following form:
6001 - The first element is a *behavior* flag, which specifies the behavior
6002 when two (or more) modules are merged together, and it encounters two
6003 (or more) metadata with the same ID. The supported behaviors are
6005 - The second element is a metadata string that is a unique ID for the
6006 metadata. Each module may only have one flag entry for each unique ID (not
6007 including entries with the **Require** behavior).
6008 - The third element is the value of the flag.
6010 When two (or more) modules are merged together, the resulting
6011 ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata is the union of the modules' flags. That is, for
6012 each unique metadata ID string, there will be exactly one entry in the merged
6013 modules ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata table, and the value for that entry will
6014 be determined by the merge behavior flag, as described below. The only exception
6015 is that entries with the *Require* behavior are always preserved.
6017 The following behaviors are supported:
6028 Emits an error if two values disagree, otherwise the resulting value
6029 is that of the operands.
6033 Emits a warning if two values disagree. The result value will be the
6034 operand for the flag from the first module being linked.
6038 Adds a requirement that another module flag be present and have a
6039 specified value after linking is performed. The value must be a
6040 metadata pair, where the first element of the pair is the ID of the
6041 module flag to be restricted, and the second element of the pair is
6042 the value the module flag should be restricted to. This behavior can
6043 be used to restrict the allowable results (via triggering of an
6044 error) of linking IDs with the **Override** behavior.
6048 Uses the specified value, regardless of the behavior or value of the
6049 other module. If both modules specify **Override**, but the values
6050 differ, an error will be emitted.
6054 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata nodes.
6058 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata
6059 nodes. However, duplicate entries in the second list are dropped
6060 during the append operation.
6064 Takes the max of the two values, which are required to be integers.
6066 It is an error for a particular unique flag ID to have multiple behaviors,
6067 except in the case of **Require** (which adds restrictions on another metadata
6068 value) or **Override**.
6070 An example of module flags:
6072 .. code-block:: llvm
6074 !0 = !{ i32 1, !"foo", i32 1 }
6075 !1 = !{ i32 4, !"bar", i32 37 }
6076 !2 = !{ i32 2, !"qux", i32 42 }
6077 !3 = !{ i32 3, !"qux",
6082 !llvm.module.flags = !{ !0, !1, !2, !3 }
6084 - Metadata ``!0`` has the ID ``!"foo"`` and the value '1'. The behavior
6085 if two or more ``!"foo"`` flags are seen is to emit an error if their
6086 values are not equal.
6088 - Metadata ``!1`` has the ID ``!"bar"`` and the value '37'. The
6089 behavior if two or more ``!"bar"`` flags are seen is to use the value
6092 - Metadata ``!2`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value '42'. The
6093 behavior if two or more ``!"qux"`` flags are seen is to emit a
6094 warning if their values are not equal.
6096 - Metadata ``!3`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value:
6102 The behavior is to emit an error if the ``llvm.module.flags`` does not
6103 contain a flag with the ID ``!"foo"`` that has the value '1' after linking is
6106 Objective-C Garbage Collection Module Flags Metadata
6107 ----------------------------------------------------
6109 On the Mach-O platform, Objective-C stores metadata about garbage
6110 collection in a special section called "image info". The metadata
6111 consists of a version number and a bitmask specifying what types of
6112 garbage collection are supported (if any) by the file. If two or more
6113 modules are linked together their garbage collection metadata needs to
6114 be merged rather than appended together.
6116 The Objective-C garbage collection module flags metadata consists of the
6117 following key-value pairs:
6126 * - ``Objective-C Version``
6127 - **[Required]** --- The Objective-C ABI version. Valid values are 1 and 2.
6129 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Version``
6130 - **[Required]** --- The version of the image info section. Currently
6133 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Section``
6134 - **[Required]** --- The section to place the metadata. Valid values are
6135 ``"__OBJC, __image_info, regular"`` for Objective-C ABI version 1, and
6136 ``"__DATA,__objc_imageinfo, regular, no_dead_strip"`` for
6137 Objective-C ABI version 2.
6139 * - ``Objective-C Garbage Collection``
6140 - **[Required]** --- Specifies whether garbage collection is supported or
6141 not. Valid values are 0, for no garbage collection, and 2, for garbage
6142 collection supported.
6144 * - ``Objective-C GC Only``
6145 - **[Optional]** --- Specifies that only garbage collection is supported.
6146 If present, its value must be 6. This flag requires that the
6147 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag have the value 2.
6149 Some important flag interactions:
6151 - If a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 is
6152 merged with a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to
6153 2, then the resulting module has the
6154 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag set to 0.
6155 - A module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 cannot be
6156 merged with a module with ``Objective-C GC Only`` set to 6.
6158 C type width Module Flags Metadata
6159 ----------------------------------
6161 The ARM backend emits a section into each generated object file describing the
6162 options that it was compiled with (in a compiler-independent way) to prevent
6163 linking incompatible objects, and to allow automatic library selection. Some
6164 of these options are not visible at the IR level, namely wchar_t width and enum
6167 To pass this information to the backend, these options are encoded in module
6168 flags metadata, using the following key-value pairs:
6178 - * 0 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 4
6179 * 1 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 2
6182 - * 0 --- Enums are at least as large as an ``int``.
6183 * 1 --- Enums are stored in the smallest integer type which can
6184 represent all of its values.
6186 For example, the following metadata section specifies that the module was
6187 compiled with a ``wchar_t`` width of 4 bytes, and the underlying type of an
6188 enum is the smallest type which can represent all of its values::
6190 !llvm.module.flags = !{!0, !1}
6191 !0 = !{i32 1, !"short_wchar", i32 1}
6192 !1 = !{i32 1, !"short_enum", i32 0}
6194 Automatic Linker Flags Named Metadata
6195 =====================================
6197 Some targets support embedding of flags to the linker inside individual object
6198 files. Typically this is used in conjunction with language extensions which
6199 allow source files to contain linker command line options, and have these
6200 automatically be transmitted to the linker via object files.
6202 These flags are encoded in the IR using named metadata with the name
6203 ``!llvm.linker.options``. Each operand is expected to be a metadata node
6204 which should be a list of other metadata nodes, each of which should be a
6205 list of metadata strings defining linker options.
6207 For example, the following metadata section specifies two separate sets of
6208 linker options, presumably to link against ``libz`` and the ``Cocoa``
6212 !1 = !{ !"-framework", !"Cocoa" }
6213 !llvm.linker.options = !{ !0, !1 }
6215 The metadata encoding as lists of lists of options, as opposed to a collapsed
6216 list of options, is chosen so that the IR encoding can use multiple option
6217 strings to specify e.g., a single library, while still having that specifier be
6218 preserved as an atomic element that can be recognized by a target specific
6219 assembly writer or object file emitter.
6221 Each individual option is required to be either a valid option for the target's
6222 linker, or an option that is reserved by the target specific assembly writer or
6223 object file emitter. No other aspect of these options is defined by the IR.
6225 Dependent Libs Named Metadata
6226 =============================
6228 Some targets support embedding of strings into object files to indicate
6229 a set of libraries to add to the link. Typically this is used in conjunction
6230 with language extensions which allow source files to explicitly declare the
6231 libraries they depend on, and have these automatically be transmitted to the
6232 linker via object files.
6234 The list is encoded in the IR using named metadata with the name
6235 ``!llvm.dependent-libraries``. Each operand is expected to be a metadata node
6236 which should contain a single string operand.
6238 For example, the following metadata section contains two library specfiers::
6240 !0 = !{!"a library specifier"}
6241 !1 = !{!"another library specifier"}
6242 !llvm.dependent-libraries = !{ !0, !1 }
6244 Each library specifier will be handled independently by the consuming linker.
6245 The effect of the library specifiers are defined by the consuming linker.
6252 Compiling with `ThinLTO <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/ThinLTO.html>`_
6253 causes the building of a compact summary of the module that is emitted into
6254 the bitcode. The summary is emitted into the LLVM assembly and identified
6255 in syntax by a caret ('``^``').
6257 The summary is parsed into a bitcode output, along with the Module
6258 IR, via the "``llvm-as``" tool. Tools that parse the Module IR for the purposes
6259 of optimization (e.g. "``clang -x ir``" and "``opt``"), will ignore the
6260 summary entries (just as they currently ignore summary entries in a bitcode
6263 Eventually, the summary will be parsed into a ModuleSummaryIndex object under
6264 the same conditions where summary index is currently built from bitcode.
6265 Specifically, tools that test the Thin Link portion of a ThinLTO compile
6266 (i.e. llvm-lto and llvm-lto2), or when parsing a combined index
6267 for a distributed ThinLTO backend via clang's "``-fthinlto-index=<>``" flag
6268 (this part is not yet implemented, use llvm-as to create a bitcode object
6269 before feeding into thin link tools for now).
6271 There are currently 3 types of summary entries in the LLVM assembly:
6272 :ref:`module paths<module_path_summary>`,
6273 :ref:`global values<gv_summary>`, and
6274 :ref:`type identifiers<typeid_summary>`.
6276 .. _module_path_summary:
6278 Module Path Summary Entry
6279 -------------------------
6281 Each module path summary entry lists a module containing global values included
6282 in the summary. For a single IR module there will be one such entry, but
6283 in a combined summary index produced during the thin link, there will be
6284 one module path entry per linked module with summary.
6288 .. code-block:: text
6290 ^0 = module: (path: "/path/to/file.o", hash: (2468601609, 1329373163, 1565878005, 638838075, 3148790418))
6292 The ``path`` field is a string path to the bitcode file, and the ``hash``
6293 field is the 160-bit SHA-1 hash of the IR bitcode contents, used for
6294 incremental builds and caching.
6298 Global Value Summary Entry
6299 --------------------------
6301 Each global value summary entry corresponds to a global value defined or
6302 referenced by a summarized module.
6306 .. code-block:: text
6308 ^4 = gv: (name: "f"[, summaries: (Summary)[, (Summary)]*]?) ; guid = 14740650423002898831
6310 For declarations, there will not be a summary list. For definitions, a
6311 global value will contain a list of summaries, one per module containing
6312 a definition. There can be multiple entries in a combined summary index
6313 for symbols with weak linkage.
6315 Each ``Summary`` format will depend on whether the global value is a
6316 :ref:`function<function_summary>`, :ref:`variable<variable_summary>`, or
6317 :ref:`alias<alias_summary>`.
6319 .. _function_summary:
6324 If the global value is a function, the ``Summary`` entry will look like:
6326 .. code-block:: text
6328 function: (module: ^0, flags: (linkage: external, notEligibleToImport: 0, live: 0, dsoLocal: 0), insts: 2[, FuncFlags]?[, Calls]?[, TypeIdInfo]?[, Refs]?
6330 The ``module`` field includes the summary entry id for the module containing
6331 this definition, and the ``flags`` field contains information such as
6332 the linkage type, a flag indicating whether it is legal to import the
6333 definition, whether it is globally live and whether the linker resolved it
6334 to a local definition (the latter two are populated during the thin link).
6335 The ``insts`` field contains the number of IR instructions in the function.
6336 Finally, there are several optional fields: :ref:`FuncFlags<funcflags_summary>`,
6337 :ref:`Calls<calls_summary>`, :ref:`TypeIdInfo<typeidinfo_summary>`,
6338 :ref:`Refs<refs_summary>`.
6340 .. _variable_summary:
6342 Global Variable Summary
6343 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6345 If the global value is a variable, the ``Summary`` entry will look like:
6347 .. code-block:: text
6349 variable: (module: ^0, flags: (linkage: external, notEligibleToImport: 0, live: 0, dsoLocal: 0)[, Refs]?
6351 The variable entry contains a subset of the fields in a
6352 :ref:`function summary <function_summary>`, see the descriptions there.
6359 If the global value is an alias, the ``Summary`` entry will look like:
6361 .. code-block:: text
6363 alias: (module: ^0, flags: (linkage: external, notEligibleToImport: 0, live: 0, dsoLocal: 0), aliasee: ^2)
6365 The ``module`` and ``flags`` fields are as described for a
6366 :ref:`function summary <function_summary>`. The ``aliasee`` field
6367 contains a reference to the global value summary entry of the aliasee.
6369 .. _funcflags_summary:
6374 The optional ``FuncFlags`` field looks like:
6376 .. code-block:: text
6378 funcFlags: (readNone: 0, readOnly: 0, noRecurse: 0, returnDoesNotAlias: 0)
6380 If unspecified, flags are assumed to hold the conservative ``false`` value of
6388 The optional ``Calls`` field looks like:
6390 .. code-block:: text
6392 calls: ((Callee)[, (Callee)]*)
6394 where each ``Callee`` looks like:
6396 .. code-block:: text
6398 callee: ^1[, hotness: None]?[, relbf: 0]?
6400 The ``callee`` refers to the summary entry id of the callee. At most one
6401 of ``hotness`` (which can take the values ``Unknown``, ``Cold``, ``None``,
6402 ``Hot``, and ``Critical``), and ``relbf`` (which holds the integer
6403 branch frequency relative to the entry frequency, scaled down by 2^8)
6404 may be specified. The defaults are ``Unknown`` and ``0``, respectively.
6411 The optional ``Refs`` field looks like:
6413 .. code-block:: text
6415 refs: ((Ref)[, (Ref)]*)
6417 where each ``Ref`` contains a reference to the summary id of the referenced
6418 value (e.g. ``^1``).
6420 .. _typeidinfo_summary:
6425 The optional ``TypeIdInfo`` field, used for
6426 `Control Flow Integrity <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/ControlFlowIntegrity.html>`_,
6429 .. code-block:: text
6431 typeIdInfo: [(TypeTests)]?[, (TypeTestAssumeVCalls)]?[, (TypeCheckedLoadVCalls)]?[, (TypeTestAssumeConstVCalls)]?[, (TypeCheckedLoadConstVCalls)]?
6433 These optional fields have the following forms:
6438 .. code-block:: text
6440 typeTests: (TypeIdRef[, TypeIdRef]*)
6442 Where each ``TypeIdRef`` refers to a :ref:`type id<typeid_summary>`
6443 by summary id or ``GUID``.
6445 TypeTestAssumeVCalls
6446 """"""""""""""""""""
6448 .. code-block:: text
6450 typeTestAssumeVCalls: (VFuncId[, VFuncId]*)
6452 Where each VFuncId has the format:
6454 .. code-block:: text
6456 vFuncId: (TypeIdRef, offset: 16)
6458 Where each ``TypeIdRef`` refers to a :ref:`type id<typeid_summary>`
6459 by summary id or ``GUID`` preceeded by a ``guid:`` tag.
6461 TypeCheckedLoadVCalls
6462 """""""""""""""""""""
6464 .. code-block:: text
6466 typeCheckedLoadVCalls: (VFuncId[, VFuncId]*)
6468 Where each VFuncId has the format described for ``TypeTestAssumeVCalls``.
6470 TypeTestAssumeConstVCalls
6471 """""""""""""""""""""""""
6473 .. code-block:: text
6475 typeTestAssumeConstVCalls: (ConstVCall[, ConstVCall]*)
6477 Where each ConstVCall has the format:
6479 .. code-block:: text
6481 (VFuncId, args: (Arg[, Arg]*))
6483 and where each VFuncId has the format described for ``TypeTestAssumeVCalls``,
6484 and each Arg is an integer argument number.
6486 TypeCheckedLoadConstVCalls
6487 """"""""""""""""""""""""""
6489 .. code-block:: text
6491 typeCheckedLoadConstVCalls: (ConstVCall[, ConstVCall]*)
6493 Where each ConstVCall has the format described for
6494 ``TypeTestAssumeConstVCalls``.
6498 Type ID Summary Entry
6499 ---------------------
6501 Each type id summary entry corresponds to a type identifier resolution
6502 which is generated during the LTO link portion of the compile when building
6503 with `Control Flow Integrity <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/ControlFlowIntegrity.html>`_,
6504 so these are only present in a combined summary index.
6508 .. code-block:: text
6510 ^4 = typeid: (name: "_ZTS1A", summary: (typeTestRes: (kind: allOnes, sizeM1BitWidth: 7[, alignLog2: 0]?[, sizeM1: 0]?[, bitMask: 0]?[, inlineBits: 0]?)[, WpdResolutions]?)) ; guid = 7004155349499253778
6512 The ``typeTestRes`` gives the type test resolution ``kind`` (which may
6513 be ``unsat``, ``byteArray``, ``inline``, ``single``, or ``allOnes``), and
6514 the ``size-1`` bit width. It is followed by optional flags, which default to 0,
6515 and an optional WpdResolutions (whole program devirtualization resolution)
6516 field that looks like:
6518 .. code-block:: text
6520 wpdResolutions: ((offset: 0, WpdRes)[, (offset: 1, WpdRes)]*
6522 where each entry is a mapping from the given byte offset to the whole-program
6523 devirtualization resolution WpdRes, that has one of the following formats:
6525 .. code-block:: text
6527 wpdRes: (kind: branchFunnel)
6528 wpdRes: (kind: singleImpl, singleImplName: "_ZN1A1nEi")
6529 wpdRes: (kind: indir)
6531 Additionally, each wpdRes has an optional ``resByArg`` field, which
6532 describes the resolutions for calls with all constant integer arguments:
6534 .. code-block:: text
6536 resByArg: (ResByArg[, ResByArg]*)
6540 .. code-block:: text
6542 args: (Arg[, Arg]*), byArg: (kind: UniformRetVal[, info: 0][, byte: 0][, bit: 0])
6544 Where the ``kind`` can be ``Indir``, ``UniformRetVal``, ``UniqueRetVal``
6545 or ``VirtualConstProp``. The ``info`` field is only used if the kind
6546 is ``UniformRetVal`` (indicates the uniform return value), or
6547 ``UniqueRetVal`` (holds the return value associated with the unique vtable
6548 (0 or 1)). The ``byte`` and ``bit`` fields are only used if the target does
6549 not support the use of absolute symbols to store constants.
6551 .. _intrinsicglobalvariables:
6553 Intrinsic Global Variables
6554 ==========================
6556 LLVM has a number of "magic" global variables that contain data that
6557 affect code generation or other IR semantics. These are documented here.
6558 All globals of this sort should have a section specified as
6559 "``llvm.metadata``". This section and all globals that start with
6560 "``llvm.``" are reserved for use by LLVM.
6564 The '``llvm.used``' Global Variable
6565 -----------------------------------
6567 The ``@llvm.used`` global is an array which has
6568 :ref:`appending linkage <linkage_appending>`. This array contains a list of
6569 pointers to named global variables, functions and aliases which may optionally
6570 have a pointer cast formed of bitcast or getelementptr. For example, a legal
6573 .. code-block:: llvm
6578 @llvm.used = appending global [2 x i8*] [
6580 i8* bitcast (i32* @Y to i8*)
6581 ], section "llvm.metadata"
6583 If a symbol appears in the ``@llvm.used`` list, then the compiler, assembler,
6584 and linker are required to treat the symbol as if there is a reference to the
6585 symbol that it cannot see (which is why they have to be named). For example, if
6586 a variable has internal linkage and no references other than that from the
6587 ``@llvm.used`` list, it cannot be deleted. This is commonly used to represent
6588 references from inline asms and other things the compiler cannot "see", and
6589 corresponds to "``attribute((used))``" in GNU C.
6591 On some targets, the code generator must emit a directive to the
6592 assembler or object file to prevent the assembler and linker from
6593 molesting the symbol.
6595 .. _gv_llvmcompilerused:
6597 The '``llvm.compiler.used``' Global Variable
6598 --------------------------------------------
6600 The ``@llvm.compiler.used`` directive is the same as the ``@llvm.used``
6601 directive, except that it only prevents the compiler from touching the
6602 symbol. On targets that support it, this allows an intelligent linker to
6603 optimize references to the symbol without being impeded as it would be
6606 This is a rare construct that should only be used in rare circumstances,
6607 and should not be exposed to source languages.
6609 .. _gv_llvmglobalctors:
6611 The '``llvm.global_ctors``' Global Variable
6612 -------------------------------------------
6614 .. code-block:: llvm
6616 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
6617 @llvm.global_ctors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @ctor, i8* @data }]
6619 The ``@llvm.global_ctors`` array contains a list of constructor
6620 functions, priorities, and an associated global or function.
6621 The functions referenced by this array will be called in ascending order
6622 of priority (i.e. lowest first) when the module is loaded. The order of
6623 functions with the same priority is not defined.
6625 If the third field is non-null, and points to a global variable
6626 or function, the initializer function will only run if the associated
6627 data from the current module is not discarded.
6629 .. _llvmglobaldtors:
6631 The '``llvm.global_dtors``' Global Variable
6632 -------------------------------------------
6634 .. code-block:: llvm
6636 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
6637 @llvm.global_dtors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @dtor, i8* @data }]
6639 The ``@llvm.global_dtors`` array contains a list of destructor
6640 functions, priorities, and an associated global or function.
6641 The functions referenced by this array will be called in descending
6642 order of priority (i.e. highest first) when the module is unloaded. The
6643 order of functions with the same priority is not defined.
6645 If the third field is non-null, and points to a global variable
6646 or function, the destructor function will only run if the associated
6647 data from the current module is not discarded.
6649 Instruction Reference
6650 =====================
6652 The LLVM instruction set consists of several different classifications
6653 of instructions: :ref:`terminator instructions <terminators>`, :ref:`binary
6654 instructions <binaryops>`, :ref:`bitwise binary
6655 instructions <bitwiseops>`, :ref:`memory instructions <memoryops>`, and
6656 :ref:`other instructions <otherops>`.
6660 Terminator Instructions
6661 -----------------------
6663 As mentioned :ref:`previously <functionstructure>`, every basic block in a
6664 program ends with a "Terminator" instruction, which indicates which
6665 block should be executed after the current block is finished. These
6666 terminator instructions typically yield a '``void``' value: they produce
6667 control flow, not values (the one exception being the
6668 ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`' instruction).
6670 The terminator instructions are: ':ref:`ret <i_ret>`',
6671 ':ref:`br <i_br>`', ':ref:`switch <i_switch>`',
6672 ':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`', ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`',
6673 ':ref:`callbr <i_callbr>`'
6674 ':ref:`resume <i_resume>`', ':ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>`',
6675 ':ref:`catchret <i_catchret>`',
6676 ':ref:`cleanupret <i_cleanupret>`',
6677 and ':ref:`unreachable <i_unreachable>`'.
6681 '``ret``' Instruction
6682 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6689 ret <type> <value> ; Return a value from a non-void function
6690 ret void ; Return from void function
6695 The '``ret``' instruction is used to return control flow (and optionally
6696 a value) from a function back to the caller.
6698 There are two forms of the '``ret``' instruction: one that returns a
6699 value and then causes control flow, and one that just causes control
6705 The '``ret``' instruction optionally accepts a single argument, the
6706 return value. The type of the return value must be a ':ref:`first
6707 class <t_firstclass>`' type.
6709 A function is not :ref:`well formed <wellformed>` if it has a non-void
6710 return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with no return value or
6711 a return value with a type that does not match its type, or if it has a
6712 void return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with a return
6718 When the '``ret``' instruction is executed, control flow returns back to
6719 the calling function's context. If the caller is a
6720 ":ref:`call <i_call>`" instruction, execution continues at the
6721 instruction after the call. If the caller was an
6722 ":ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`" instruction, execution continues at the
6723 beginning of the "normal" destination block. If the instruction returns
6724 a value, that value shall set the call or invoke instruction's return
6730 .. code-block:: llvm
6732 ret i32 5 ; Return an integer value of 5
6733 ret void ; Return from a void function
6734 ret { i32, i8 } { i32 4, i8 2 } ; Return a struct of values 4 and 2
6738 '``br``' Instruction
6739 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6746 br i1 <cond>, label <iftrue>, label <iffalse>
6747 br label <dest> ; Unconditional branch
6752 The '``br``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to a
6753 different basic block in the current function. There are two forms of
6754 this instruction, corresponding to a conditional branch and an
6755 unconditional branch.
6760 The conditional branch form of the '``br``' instruction takes a single
6761 '``i1``' value and two '``label``' values. The unconditional form of the
6762 '``br``' instruction takes a single '``label``' value as a target.
6767 Upon execution of a conditional '``br``' instruction, the '``i1``'
6768 argument is evaluated. If the value is ``true``, control flows to the
6769 '``iftrue``' ``label`` argument. If "cond" is ``false``, control flows
6770 to the '``iffalse``' ``label`` argument.
6775 .. code-block:: llvm
6778 %cond = icmp eq i32 %a, %b
6779 br i1 %cond, label %IfEqual, label %IfUnequal
6787 '``switch``' Instruction
6788 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6795 switch <intty> <value>, label <defaultdest> [ <intty> <val>, label <dest> ... ]
6800 The '``switch``' instruction is used to transfer control flow to one of
6801 several different places. It is a generalization of the '``br``'
6802 instruction, allowing a branch to occur to one of many possible
6808 The '``switch``' instruction uses three parameters: an integer
6809 comparison value '``value``', a default '``label``' destination, and an
6810 array of pairs of comparison value constants and '``label``'s. The table
6811 is not allowed to contain duplicate constant entries.
6816 The ``switch`` instruction specifies a table of values and destinations.
6817 When the '``switch``' instruction is executed, this table is searched
6818 for the given value. If the value is found, control flow is transferred
6819 to the corresponding destination; otherwise, control flow is transferred
6820 to the default destination.
6825 Depending on properties of the target machine and the particular
6826 ``switch`` instruction, this instruction may be code generated in
6827 different ways. For example, it could be generated as a series of
6828 chained conditional branches or with a lookup table.
6833 .. code-block:: llvm
6835 ; Emulate a conditional br instruction
6836 %Val = zext i1 %value to i32
6837 switch i32 %Val, label %truedest [ i32 0, label %falsedest ]
6839 ; Emulate an unconditional br instruction
6840 switch i32 0, label %dest [ ]
6842 ; Implement a jump table:
6843 switch i32 %val, label %otherwise [ i32 0, label %onzero
6845 i32 2, label %ontwo ]
6849 '``indirectbr``' Instruction
6850 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6857 indirectbr <somety>* <address>, [ label <dest1>, label <dest2>, ... ]
6862 The '``indirectbr``' instruction implements an indirect branch to a
6863 label within the current function, whose address is specified by
6864 "``address``". Address must be derived from a
6865 :ref:`blockaddress <blockaddress>` constant.
6870 The '``address``' argument is the address of the label to jump to. The
6871 rest of the arguments indicate the full set of possible destinations
6872 that the address may point to. Blocks are allowed to occur multiple
6873 times in the destination list, though this isn't particularly useful.
6875 This destination list is required so that dataflow analysis has an
6876 accurate understanding of the CFG.
6881 Control transfers to the block specified in the address argument. All
6882 possible destination blocks must be listed in the label list, otherwise
6883 this instruction has undefined behavior. This implies that jumps to
6884 labels defined in other functions have undefined behavior as well.
6889 This is typically implemented with a jump through a register.
6894 .. code-block:: llvm
6896 indirectbr i8* %Addr, [ label %bb1, label %bb2, label %bb3 ]
6900 '``invoke``' Instruction
6901 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6908 <result> = invoke [cconv] [ret attrs] [addrspace(<num>)] [<ty>|<fnty> <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
6909 [operand bundles] to label <normal label> unwind label <exception label>
6914 The '``invoke``' instruction causes control to transfer to a specified
6915 function, with the possibility of control flow transfer to either the
6916 '``normal``' label or the '``exception``' label. If the callee function
6917 returns with the "``ret``" instruction, control flow will return to the
6918 "normal" label. If the callee (or any indirect callees) returns via the
6919 ":ref:`resume <i_resume>`" instruction or other exception handling
6920 mechanism, control is interrupted and continued at the dynamically
6921 nearest "exception" label.
6923 The '``exception``' label is a `landing
6924 pad <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ for the exception. As such,
6925 '``exception``' label is required to have the
6926 ":ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>`" instruction, which contains the
6927 information about the behavior of the program after unwinding happens,
6928 as its first non-PHI instruction. The restrictions on the
6929 "``landingpad``" instruction's tightly couples it to the "``invoke``"
6930 instruction, so that the important information contained within the
6931 "``landingpad``" instruction can't be lost through normal code motion.
6936 This instruction requires several arguments:
6938 #. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
6939 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
6940 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions.
6941 #. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
6942 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
6944 #. The optional addrspace attribute can be used to indicate the address space
6945 of the called function. If it is not specified, the program address space
6946 from the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>` will be used.
6947 #. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
6948 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
6950 #. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the function being invoked. The
6951 argument types must match the types implied by this signature. This
6952 type can be omitted if the function is not varargs.
6953 #. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
6954 be invoked. In most cases, this is a direct function invocation, but
6955 indirect ``invoke``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
6957 #. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
6958 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
6959 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
6960 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
6961 extra arguments can be specified.
6962 #. '``normal label``': the label reached when the called function
6963 executes a '``ret``' instruction.
6964 #. '``exception label``': the label reached when a callee returns via
6965 the :ref:`resume <i_resume>` instruction or other exception handling
6967 #. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list.
6968 #. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
6973 This instruction is designed to operate as a standard '``call``'
6974 instruction in most regards. The primary difference is that it
6975 establishes an association with a label, which is used by the runtime
6976 library to unwind the stack.
6978 This instruction is used in languages with destructors to ensure that
6979 proper cleanup is performed in the case of either a ``longjmp`` or a
6980 thrown exception. Additionally, this is important for implementation of
6981 '``catch``' clauses in high-level languages that support them.
6983 For the purposes of the SSA form, the definition of the value returned
6984 by the '``invoke``' instruction is deemed to occur on the edge from the
6985 current block to the "normal" label. If the callee unwinds then no
6986 return value is available.
6991 .. code-block:: llvm
6993 %retval = invoke i32 @Test(i32 15) to label %Continue
6994 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
6995 %retval = invoke coldcc i32 %Testfnptr(i32 15) to label %Continue
6996 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
7000 '``callbr``' Instruction
7001 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7008 <result> = callbr [cconv] [ret attrs] [addrspace(<num>)] [<ty>|<fnty> <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
7009 [operand bundles] to label <normal label> or jump [other labels]
7014 The '``callbr``' instruction causes control to transfer to a specified
7015 function, with the possibility of control flow transfer to either the
7016 '``normal``' label or one of the '``other``' labels.
7018 This instruction should only be used to implement the "goto" feature of gcc
7019 style inline assembly. Any other usage is an error in the IR verifier.
7024 This instruction requires several arguments:
7026 #. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
7027 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
7028 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions.
7029 #. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
7030 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
7032 #. The optional addrspace attribute can be used to indicate the address space
7033 of the called function. If it is not specified, the program address space
7034 from the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>` will be used.
7035 #. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
7036 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
7038 #. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the function being called. The
7039 argument types must match the types implied by this signature. This
7040 type can be omitted if the function is not varargs.
7041 #. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
7042 be called. In most cases, this is a direct function call, but
7043 indirect ``callbr``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
7045 #. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
7046 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
7047 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
7048 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
7049 extra arguments can be specified.
7050 #. '``normal label``': the label reached when the called function
7051 executes a '``ret``' instruction.
7052 #. '``other labels``': the labels reached when a callee transfers control
7053 to a location other than the normal '``normal label``'
7054 #. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list.
7055 #. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
7060 This instruction is designed to operate as a standard '``call``'
7061 instruction in most regards. The primary difference is that it
7062 establishes an association with additional labels to define where control
7063 flow goes after the call.
7065 The only use of this today is to implement the "goto" feature of gcc inline
7066 assembly where additional labels can be provided as locations for the inline
7067 assembly to jump to.
7072 .. code-block:: text
7074 callbr void asm "", "r,x"(i32 %x, i8 *blockaddress(@foo, %fail))
7075 to label %normal or jump [label %fail]
7079 '``resume``' Instruction
7080 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7087 resume <type> <value>
7092 The '``resume``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has no
7098 The '``resume``' instruction requires one argument, which must have the
7099 same type as the result of any '``landingpad``' instruction in the same
7105 The '``resume``' instruction resumes propagation of an existing
7106 (in-flight) exception whose unwinding was interrupted with a
7107 :ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction.
7112 .. code-block:: llvm
7114 resume { i8*, i32 } %exn
7118 '``catchswitch``' Instruction
7119 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7126 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind to caller
7127 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind label <default>
7132 The '``catchswitch``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling system
7133 <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to describe the set of possible catch handlers
7134 that may be executed by the :ref:`EH personality routine <personalityfn>`.
7139 The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
7140 ``catchswitch`` instruction. If the ``catchswitch`` is not inside a funclet,
7141 this operand may be the token ``none``.
7143 The ``default`` argument is the label of another basic block beginning with
7144 either a ``cleanuppad`` or ``catchswitch`` instruction. This unwind destination
7145 must be a legal target with respect to the ``parent`` links, as described in
7146 the `exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_.
7148 The ``handlers`` are a nonempty list of successor blocks that each begin with a
7149 :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction.
7154 Executing this instruction transfers control to one of the successors in
7155 ``handlers``, if appropriate, or continues to unwind via the unwind label if
7158 The ``catchswitch`` is both a terminator and a "pad" instruction, meaning that
7159 it must be both the first non-phi instruction and last instruction in the basic
7160 block. Therefore, it must be the only non-phi instruction in the block.
7165 .. code-block:: text
7168 %cs1 = catchswitch within none [label %handler0, label %handler1] unwind to caller
7170 %cs2 = catchswitch within %parenthandler [label %handler0] unwind label %cleanup
7174 '``catchret``' Instruction
7175 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7182 catchret from <token> to label <normal>
7187 The '``catchret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has a
7194 The first argument to a '``catchret``' indicates which ``catchpad`` it
7195 exits. It must be a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>`.
7196 The second argument to a '``catchret``' specifies where control will
7202 The '``catchret``' instruction ends an existing (in-flight) exception whose
7203 unwinding was interrupted with a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction. The
7204 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` gets a chance to execute arbitrary
7205 code to, for example, destroy the active exception. Control then transfers to
7208 The ``token`` argument must be a token produced by a ``catchpad`` instruction.
7209 If the specified ``catchpad`` is not the most-recently-entered not-yet-exited
7210 funclet pad (as described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
7211 the ``catchret``'s behavior is undefined.
7216 .. code-block:: text
7218 catchret from %catch label %continue
7222 '``cleanupret``' Instruction
7223 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7230 cleanupret from <value> unwind label <continue>
7231 cleanupret from <value> unwind to caller
7236 The '``cleanupret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has
7237 an optional successor.
7243 The '``cleanupret``' instruction requires one argument, which indicates
7244 which ``cleanuppad`` it exits, and must be a :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>`.
7245 If the specified ``cleanuppad`` is not the most-recently-entered not-yet-exited
7246 funclet pad (as described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
7247 the ``cleanupret``'s behavior is undefined.
7249 The '``cleanupret``' instruction also has an optional successor, ``continue``,
7250 which must be the label of another basic block beginning with either a
7251 ``cleanuppad`` or ``catchswitch`` instruction. This unwind destination must
7252 be a legal target with respect to the ``parent`` links, as described in the
7253 `exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_.
7258 The '``cleanupret``' instruction indicates to the
7259 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` that one
7260 :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>` it transferred control to has ended.
7261 It transfers control to ``continue`` or unwinds out of the function.
7266 .. code-block:: text
7268 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind to caller
7269 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind label %continue
7273 '``unreachable``' Instruction
7274 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7286 The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics. This
7287 instruction is used to inform the optimizer that a particular portion of
7288 the code is not reachable. This can be used to indicate that the code
7289 after a no-return function cannot be reached, and other facts.
7294 The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics.
7301 Unary operators require a single operand, execute an operation on
7302 it, and produce a single value. The operand might represent multiple
7303 data, as is the case with the :ref:`vector <t_vector>` data type. The
7304 result value has the same type as its operand.
7308 '``fneg``' Instruction
7309 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7316 <result> = fneg [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1> ; yields ty:result
7321 The '``fneg``' instruction returns the negation of its operand.
7326 The argument to the '``fneg``' instruction must be a
7327 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7328 floating-point values.
7333 The value produced is a copy of the operand with its sign bit flipped.
7334 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7335 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7336 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7341 .. code-block:: text
7343 <result> = fneg float %val ; yields float:result = -%var
7350 Binary operators are used to do most of the computation in a program.
7351 They require two operands of the same type, execute an operation on
7352 them, and produce a single value. The operands might represent multiple
7353 data, as is the case with the :ref:`vector <t_vector>` data type. The
7354 result value has the same type as its operands.
7356 There are several different binary operators:
7360 '``add``' Instruction
7361 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7368 <result> = add <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7369 <result> = add nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7370 <result> = add nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7371 <result> = add nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7376 The '``add``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
7381 The two arguments to the '``add``' instruction must be
7382 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7383 arguments must have identical types.
7388 The value produced is the integer sum of the two operands.
7390 If the sum has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
7391 mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
7394 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
7395 instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
7397 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
7398 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
7399 result value of the ``add`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
7400 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
7405 .. code-block:: text
7407 <result> = add i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 + %var
7411 '``fadd``' Instruction
7412 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7419 <result> = fadd [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7424 The '``fadd``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
7429 The two arguments to the '``fadd``' instruction must be
7430 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7431 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7436 The value produced is the floating-point sum of the two operands.
7437 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7438 environment <floatenv>`.
7439 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7440 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7441 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7446 .. code-block:: text
7448 <result> = fadd float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 + %var
7450 '``sub``' Instruction
7451 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7458 <result> = sub <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7459 <result> = sub nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7460 <result> = sub nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7461 <result> = sub nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7466 The '``sub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
7468 Note that the '``sub``' instruction is used to represent the '``neg``'
7469 instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
7474 The two arguments to the '``sub``' instruction must be
7475 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7476 arguments must have identical types.
7481 The value produced is the integer difference of the two operands.
7483 If the difference has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
7484 mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
7487 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
7488 instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
7490 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
7491 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
7492 result value of the ``sub`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
7493 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
7498 .. code-block:: text
7500 <result> = sub i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 - %var
7501 <result> = sub i32 0, %val ; yields i32:result = -%var
7505 '``fsub``' Instruction
7506 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7513 <result> = fsub [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7518 The '``fsub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
7523 The two arguments to the '``fsub``' instruction must be
7524 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7525 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7530 The value produced is the floating-point difference of the two operands.
7531 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7532 environment <floatenv>`.
7533 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7534 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7535 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7540 .. code-block:: text
7542 <result> = fsub float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 - %var
7543 <result> = fsub float -0.0, %val ; yields float:result = -%var
7545 '``mul``' Instruction
7546 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7553 <result> = mul <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7554 <result> = mul nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7555 <result> = mul nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7556 <result> = mul nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7561 The '``mul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
7566 The two arguments to the '``mul``' instruction must be
7567 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7568 arguments must have identical types.
7573 The value produced is the integer product of the two operands.
7575 If the result of the multiplication has unsigned overflow, the result
7576 returned is the mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the
7577 bit width of the result.
7579 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, and the
7580 result is the same width as the operands, this instruction returns the
7581 correct result for both signed and unsigned integers. If a full product
7582 (e.g. ``i32`` * ``i32`` -> ``i64``) is needed, the operands should be
7583 sign-extended or zero-extended as appropriate to the width of the full
7586 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
7587 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
7588 result value of the ``mul`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
7589 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
7594 .. code-block:: text
7596 <result> = mul i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 * %var
7600 '``fmul``' Instruction
7601 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7608 <result> = fmul [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7613 The '``fmul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
7618 The two arguments to the '``fmul``' instruction must be
7619 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7620 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7625 The value produced is the floating-point product of the two operands.
7626 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7627 environment <floatenv>`.
7628 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7629 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7630 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7635 .. code-block:: text
7637 <result> = fmul float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 * %var
7639 '``udiv``' Instruction
7640 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7647 <result> = udiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7648 <result> = udiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7653 The '``udiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
7658 The two arguments to the '``udiv``' instruction must be
7659 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7660 arguments must have identical types.
7665 The value produced is the unsigned integer quotient of the two operands.
7667 Note that unsigned integer division and signed integer division are
7668 distinct operations; for signed integer division, use '``sdiv``'.
7670 Division by zero is undefined behavior. For vectors, if any element
7671 of the divisor is zero, the operation has undefined behavior.
7674 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``udiv`` is
7675 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if %op1 is not a multiple of %op2 (as
7676 such, "((a udiv exact b) mul b) == a").
7681 .. code-block:: text
7683 <result> = udiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
7685 '``sdiv``' Instruction
7686 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7693 <result> = sdiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7694 <result> = sdiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7699 The '``sdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
7704 The two arguments to the '``sdiv``' instruction must be
7705 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7706 arguments must have identical types.
7711 The value produced is the signed integer quotient of the two operands
7712 rounded towards zero.
7714 Note that signed integer division and unsigned integer division are
7715 distinct operations; for unsigned integer division, use '``udiv``'.
7717 Division by zero is undefined behavior. For vectors, if any element
7718 of the divisor is zero, the operation has undefined behavior.
7719 Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can
7720 occur, for example, by doing a 32-bit division of -2147483648 by -1.
7722 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``sdiv`` is
7723 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the result would be rounded.
7728 .. code-block:: text
7730 <result> = sdiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
7734 '``fdiv``' Instruction
7735 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7742 <result> = fdiv [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7747 The '``fdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
7752 The two arguments to the '``fdiv``' instruction must be
7753 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7754 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7759 The value produced is the floating-point quotient of the two operands.
7760 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7761 environment <floatenv>`.
7762 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7763 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7764 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7769 .. code-block:: text
7771 <result> = fdiv float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 / %var
7773 '``urem``' Instruction
7774 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7781 <result> = urem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7786 The '``urem``' instruction returns the remainder from the unsigned
7787 division of its two arguments.
7792 The two arguments to the '``urem``' instruction must be
7793 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7794 arguments must have identical types.
7799 This instruction returns the unsigned integer *remainder* of a division.
7800 This instruction always performs an unsigned division to get the
7803 Note that unsigned integer remainder and signed integer remainder are
7804 distinct operations; for signed integer remainder, use '``srem``'.
7806 Taking the remainder of a division by zero is undefined behavior.
7807 For vectors, if any element of the divisor is zero, the operation has
7813 .. code-block:: text
7815 <result> = urem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
7817 '``srem``' Instruction
7818 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7825 <result> = srem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7830 The '``srem``' instruction returns the remainder from the signed
7831 division of its two operands. This instruction can also take
7832 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` versions of the values in which case the elements
7838 The two arguments to the '``srem``' instruction must be
7839 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7840 arguments must have identical types.
7845 This instruction returns the *remainder* of a division (where the result
7846 is either zero or has the same sign as the dividend, ``op1``), not the
7847 *modulo* operator (where the result is either zero or has the same sign
7848 as the divisor, ``op2``) of a value. For more information about the
7849 difference, see `The Math
7850 Forum <http://mathforum.org/dr.math/problems/anne.4.28.99.html>`_. For a
7851 table of how this is implemented in various languages, please see
7853 operation <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Modulo_operation>`_.
7855 Note that signed integer remainder and unsigned integer remainder are
7856 distinct operations; for unsigned integer remainder, use '``urem``'.
7858 Taking the remainder of a division by zero is undefined behavior.
7859 For vectors, if any element of the divisor is zero, the operation has
7861 Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can
7862 occur, for example, by taking the remainder of a 32-bit division of
7863 -2147483648 by -1. (The remainder doesn't actually overflow, but this
7864 rule lets srem be implemented using instructions that return both the
7865 result of the division and the remainder.)
7870 .. code-block:: text
7872 <result> = srem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
7876 '``frem``' Instruction
7877 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7884 <result> = frem [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7889 The '``frem``' instruction returns the remainder from the division of
7895 The two arguments to the '``frem``' instruction must be
7896 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7897 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7902 The value produced is the floating-point remainder of the two operands.
7903 This is the same output as a libm '``fmod``' function, but without any
7904 possibility of setting ``errno``. The remainder has the same sign as the
7906 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7907 environment <floatenv>`.
7908 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7909 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7910 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7915 .. code-block:: text
7917 <result> = frem float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 % %var
7921 Bitwise Binary Operations
7922 -------------------------
7924 Bitwise binary operators are used to do various forms of bit-twiddling
7925 in a program. They are generally very efficient instructions and can
7926 commonly be strength reduced from other instructions. They require two
7927 operands of the same type, execute an operation on them, and produce a
7928 single value. The resulting value is the same type as its operands.
7930 '``shl``' Instruction
7931 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7938 <result> = shl <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7939 <result> = shl nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7940 <result> = shl nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7941 <result> = shl nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7946 The '``shl``' instruction returns the first operand shifted to the left
7947 a specified number of bits.
7952 Both arguments to the '``shl``' instruction must be the same
7953 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
7954 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
7959 The value produced is ``op1`` \* 2\ :sup:`op2` mod 2\ :sup:`n`,
7960 where ``n`` is the width of the result. If ``op2`` is (statically or
7961 dynamically) equal to or larger than the number of bits in
7962 ``op1``, this instruction returns a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
7963 If the arguments are vectors, each vector element of ``op1`` is shifted
7964 by the corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
7966 If the ``nuw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a poison
7967 value if it shifts out any non-zero bits.
7968 If the ``nsw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a poison
7969 value if it shifts out any bits that disagree with the resultant sign bit.
7974 .. code-block:: text
7976 <result> = shl i32 4, %var ; yields i32: 4 << %var
7977 <result> = shl i32 4, 2 ; yields i32: 16
7978 <result> = shl i32 1, 10 ; yields i32: 1024
7979 <result> = shl i32 1, 32 ; undefined
7980 <result> = shl <2 x i32> < i32 1, i32 1>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 2, i32 4>
7982 '``lshr``' Instruction
7983 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7990 <result> = lshr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7991 <result> = lshr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7996 The '``lshr``' instruction (logical shift right) returns the first
7997 operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with zero fill.
8002 Both arguments to the '``lshr``' instruction must be the same
8003 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
8004 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
8009 This instruction always performs a logical shift right operation. The
8010 most significant bits of the result will be filled with zero bits after
8011 the shift. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
8012 than the number of bits in ``op1``, this instruction returns a :ref:`poison
8013 value <poisonvalues>`. If the arguments are vectors, each vector element
8014 of ``op1`` is shifted by the corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
8016 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``lshr`` is
8017 a poison value if any of the bits shifted out are non-zero.
8022 .. code-block:: text
8024 <result> = lshr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
8025 <result> = lshr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
8026 <result> = lshr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
8027 <result> = lshr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = 0x7F
8028 <result> = lshr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
8029 <result> = lshr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 0x7FFFFFFF, i32 1>
8031 '``ashr``' Instruction
8032 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8039 <result> = ashr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
8040 <result> = ashr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
8045 The '``ashr``' instruction (arithmetic shift right) returns the first
8046 operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with sign
8052 Both arguments to the '``ashr``' instruction must be the same
8053 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
8054 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
8059 This instruction always performs an arithmetic shift right operation,
8060 The most significant bits of the result will be filled with the sign bit
8061 of ``op1``. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
8062 than the number of bits in ``op1``, this instruction returns a :ref:`poison
8063 value <poisonvalues>`. If the arguments are vectors, each vector element
8064 of ``op1`` is shifted by the corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
8066 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``ashr`` is
8067 a poison value if any of the bits shifted out are non-zero.
8072 .. code-block:: text
8074 <result> = ashr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
8075 <result> = ashr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
8076 <result> = ashr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
8077 <result> = ashr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = -1
8078 <result> = ashr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
8079 <result> = ashr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 3> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 -1, i32 0>
8081 '``and``' Instruction
8082 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8089 <result> = and <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
8094 The '``and``' instruction returns the bitwise logical and of its two
8100 The two arguments to the '``and``' instruction must be
8101 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
8102 arguments must have identical types.
8107 The truth table used for the '``and``' instruction is:
8124 .. code-block:: text
8126 <result> = and i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 & %var
8127 <result> = and i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 8
8128 <result> = and i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 0
8130 '``or``' Instruction
8131 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8138 <result> = or <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
8143 The '``or``' instruction returns the bitwise logical inclusive or of its
8149 The two arguments to the '``or``' instruction must be
8150 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
8151 arguments must have identical types.
8156 The truth table used for the '``or``' instruction is:
8175 <result> = or i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 | %var
8176 <result> = or i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 47
8177 <result> = or i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
8179 '``xor``' Instruction
8180 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8187 <result> = xor <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
8192 The '``xor``' instruction returns the bitwise logical exclusive or of
8193 its two operands. The ``xor`` is used to implement the "one's
8194 complement" operation, which is the "~" operator in C.
8199 The two arguments to the '``xor``' instruction must be
8200 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
8201 arguments must have identical types.
8206 The truth table used for the '``xor``' instruction is:
8223 .. code-block:: text
8225 <result> = xor i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 ^ %var
8226 <result> = xor i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 39
8227 <result> = xor i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
8228 <result> = xor i32 %V, -1 ; yields i32:result = ~%V
8233 LLVM supports several instructions to represent vector operations in a
8234 target-independent manner. These instructions cover the element-access
8235 and vector-specific operations needed to process vectors effectively.
8236 While LLVM does directly support these vector operations, many
8237 sophisticated algorithms will want to use target-specific intrinsics to
8238 take full advantage of a specific target.
8240 .. _i_extractelement:
8242 '``extractelement``' Instruction
8243 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8250 <result> = extractelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <ty>
8251 <result> = extractelement <vscale x n x <ty>> <val>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <ty>
8256 The '``extractelement``' instruction extracts a single scalar element
8257 from a vector at a specified index.
8262 The first operand of an '``extractelement``' instruction is a value of
8263 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is an index indicating
8264 the position from which to extract the element. The index may be a
8265 variable of any integer type.
8270 The result is a scalar of the same type as the element type of ``val``.
8271 Its value is the value at position ``idx`` of ``val``. If ``idx``
8272 exceeds the length of ``val`` for a fixed-length vector, the result is a
8273 :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`. For a scalable vector, if the value
8274 of ``idx`` exceeds the runtime length of the vector, the result is a
8275 :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
8280 .. code-block:: text
8282 <result> = extractelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 0 ; yields i32
8284 .. _i_insertelement:
8286 '``insertelement``' Instruction
8287 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8294 <result> = insertelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <n x <ty>>
8295 <result> = insertelement <vscale x n x <ty>> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <vscale x n x <ty>>
8300 The '``insertelement``' instruction inserts a scalar element into a
8301 vector at a specified index.
8306 The first operand of an '``insertelement``' instruction is a value of
8307 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is a scalar value whose
8308 type must equal the element type of the first operand. The third operand
8309 is an index indicating the position at which to insert the value. The
8310 index may be a variable of any integer type.
8315 The result is a vector of the same type as ``val``. Its element values
8316 are those of ``val`` except at position ``idx``, where it gets the value
8317 ``elt``. If ``idx`` exceeds the length of ``val`` for a fixed-length vector,
8318 the result is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`. For a scalable vector,
8319 if the value of ``idx`` exceeds the runtime length of the vector, the result
8320 is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
8325 .. code-block:: text
8327 <result> = insertelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 1, i32 0 ; yields <4 x i32>
8329 .. _i_shufflevector:
8331 '``shufflevector``' Instruction
8332 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8339 <result> = shufflevector <n x <ty>> <v1>, <n x <ty>> <v2>, <m x i32> <mask> ; yields <m x <ty>>
8340 <result> = shufflevector <vscale x n x <ty>> <v1>, <vscale x n x <ty>> v2, <vscale x m x i32> <mask> ; yields <vscale x m x <ty>>
8345 The '``shufflevector``' instruction constructs a permutation of elements
8346 from two input vectors, returning a vector with the same element type as
8347 the input and length that is the same as the shuffle mask.
8352 The first two operands of a '``shufflevector``' instruction are vectors
8353 with the same type. The third argument is a shuffle mask whose element
8354 type is always 'i32'. The result of the instruction is a vector whose
8355 length is the same as the shuffle mask and whose element type is the
8356 same as the element type of the first two operands.
8358 The shuffle mask operand is required to be a constant vector with either
8359 constant integer or undef values.
8364 The elements of the two input vectors are numbered from left to right
8365 across both of the vectors. The shuffle mask operand specifies, for each
8366 element of the result vector, which element of the two input vectors the
8367 result element gets. If the shuffle mask is undef, the result vector is
8368 undef. If any element of the mask operand is undef, that element of the
8369 result is undef. If the shuffle mask selects an undef element from one
8370 of the input vectors, the resulting element is undef.
8372 For scalable vectors, the only valid mask values at present are
8373 ``zeroinitializer`` and ``undef``, since we cannot write all indices as
8374 literals for a vector with a length unknown at compile time.
8379 .. code-block:: text
8381 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
8382 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 4, i32 1, i32 5> ; yields <4 x i32>
8383 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> undef,
8384 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32> - Identity shuffle.
8385 <result> = shufflevector <8 x i32> %v1, <8 x i32> undef,
8386 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32>
8387 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
8388 <8 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3, i32 4, i32 5, i32 6, i32 7 > ; yields <8 x i32>
8390 Aggregate Operations
8391 --------------------
8393 LLVM supports several instructions for working with
8394 :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` values.
8398 '``extractvalue``' Instruction
8399 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8406 <result> = extractvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <idx>{, <idx>}*
8411 The '``extractvalue``' instruction extracts the value of a member field
8412 from an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
8417 The first operand of an '``extractvalue``' instruction is a value of
8418 :ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The other operands are
8419 constant indices to specify which value to extract in a similar manner
8420 as indices in a '``getelementptr``' instruction.
8422 The major differences to ``getelementptr`` indexing are:
8424 - Since the value being indexed is not a pointer, the first index is
8425 omitted and assumed to be zero.
8426 - At least one index must be specified.
8427 - Not only struct indices but also array indices must be in bounds.
8432 The result is the value at the position in the aggregate specified by
8438 .. code-block:: text
8440 <result> = extractvalue {i32, float} %agg, 0 ; yields i32
8444 '``insertvalue``' Instruction
8445 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8452 <result> = insertvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <idx>{, <idx>}* ; yields <aggregate type>
8457 The '``insertvalue``' instruction inserts a value into a member field in
8458 an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
8463 The first operand of an '``insertvalue``' instruction is a value of
8464 :ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The second operand is
8465 a first-class value to insert. The following operands are constant
8466 indices indicating the position at which to insert the value in a
8467 similar manner as indices in a '``extractvalue``' instruction. The value
8468 to insert must have the same type as the value identified by the
8474 The result is an aggregate of the same type as ``val``. Its value is
8475 that of ``val`` except that the value at the position specified by the
8476 indices is that of ``elt``.
8481 .. code-block:: llvm
8483 %agg1 = insertvalue {i32, float} undef, i32 1, 0 ; yields {i32 1, float undef}
8484 %agg2 = insertvalue {i32, float} %agg1, float %val, 1 ; yields {i32 1, float %val}
8485 %agg3 = insertvalue {i32, {float}} undef, float %val, 1, 0 ; yields {i32 undef, {float %val}}
8489 Memory Access and Addressing Operations
8490 ---------------------------------------
8492 A key design point of an SSA-based representation is how it represents
8493 memory. In LLVM, no memory locations are in SSA form, which makes things
8494 very simple. This section describes how to read, write, and allocate
8499 '``alloca``' Instruction
8500 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8507 <result> = alloca [inalloca] <type> [, <ty> <NumElements>] [, align <alignment>] [, addrspace(<num>)] ; yields type addrspace(num)*:result
8512 The '``alloca``' instruction allocates memory on the stack frame of the
8513 currently executing function, to be automatically released when this
8514 function returns to its caller. The object is always allocated in the
8515 address space for allocas indicated in the datalayout.
8520 The '``alloca``' instruction allocates ``sizeof(<type>)*NumElements``
8521 bytes of memory on the runtime stack, returning a pointer of the
8522 appropriate type to the program. If "NumElements" is specified, it is
8523 the number of elements allocated, otherwise "NumElements" is defaulted
8524 to be one. If a constant alignment is specified, the value result of the
8525 allocation is guaranteed to be aligned to at least that boundary. The
8526 alignment may not be greater than ``1 << 29``. If not specified, or if
8527 zero, the target can choose to align the allocation on any convenient
8528 boundary compatible with the type.
8530 '``type``' may be any sized type.
8535 Memory is allocated; a pointer is returned. The allocated memory is
8536 uninitialized, and loading from uninitialized memory produces an undefined
8537 value. The operation itself is undefined if there is insufficient stack
8538 space for the allocation.'``alloca``'d memory is automatically released
8539 when the function returns. The '``alloca``' instruction is commonly used
8540 to represent automatic variables that must have an address available. When
8541 the function returns (either with the ``ret`` or ``resume`` instructions),
8542 the memory is reclaimed. Allocating zero bytes is legal, but the returned
8543 pointer may not be unique. The order in which memory is allocated (ie.,
8544 which way the stack grows) is not specified.
8549 .. code-block:: llvm
8551 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
8552 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4 ; yields i32*:ptr
8553 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
8554 %ptr = alloca i32, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
8558 '``load``' Instruction
8559 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8566 <result> = load [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.load !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>][, !nonnull !<index>][, !dereferenceable !<deref_bytes_node>][, !dereferenceable_or_null !<deref_bytes_node>][, !align !<align_node>]
8567 <result> = load atomic [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>]
8568 !<index> = !{ i32 1 }
8569 !<deref_bytes_node> = !{i64 <dereferenceable_bytes>}
8570 !<align_node> = !{ i64 <value_alignment> }
8575 The '``load``' instruction is used to read from memory.
8580 The argument to the ``load`` instruction specifies the memory address from which
8581 to load. The type specified must be a :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of
8582 known size (i.e. not containing an :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>`). If
8583 the ``load`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed to
8584 modify the number or order of execution of this ``load`` with other
8585 :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
8587 If the ``load`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering
8588 <ordering>` and optional ``syncscope("<target-scope>")`` argument. The
8589 ``release`` and ``acq_rel`` orderings are not valid on ``load`` instructions.
8590 Atomic loads produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see
8591 multiple atomic stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or
8592 floating-point type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to
8593 eight and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit. ``align`` must be
8594 explicitly specified on atomic loads, and the load has undefined behavior if the
8595 alignment is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
8596 pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic loads.
8598 The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
8599 operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
8600 or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
8601 alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
8602 to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
8603 alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the alignment
8604 may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always safe. The
8605 maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``. An alignment value higher
8606 than the size of the loaded type implies memory up to the alignment
8607 value bytes can be safely loaded without trapping in the default
8608 address space. Access of the high bytes can interfere with debugging
8609 tools, so should not be accessed if the function has the
8610 ``sanitize_thread`` or ``sanitize_address`` attributes.
8612 The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single
8613 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
8614 ``i32`` entry of value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal``
8615 metadata on the instruction tells the optimizer and code generator
8616 that this load is not expected to be reused in the cache. The code
8617 generator may select special instructions to save cache bandwidth, such
8618 as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on x86.
8620 The optional ``!invariant.load`` metadata must reference a single
8621 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
8622 entries. If a load instruction tagged with the ``!invariant.load``
8623 metadata is executed, the optimizer may assume the memory location
8624 referenced by the load contains the same value at all points in the
8625 program where the memory location is known to be dereferenceable;
8626 otherwise, the behavior is undefined.
8628 The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
8629 ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no entries.
8630 See ``invariant.group`` metadata :ref:`invariant.group <md_invariant.group>`
8632 The optional ``!nonnull`` metadata must reference a single
8633 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
8634 entries. The existence of the ``!nonnull`` metadata on the
8635 instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to
8636 never be null. If the value is null at runtime, the behavior is undefined.
8637 This is analogous to the ``nonnull`` attribute on parameters and return
8638 values. This metadata can only be applied to loads of a pointer type.
8640 The optional ``!dereferenceable`` metadata must reference a single metadata
8641 name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64``
8643 See ``dereferenceable`` metadata :ref:`dereferenceable <md_dereferenceable>`
8645 The optional ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata must reference a single
8646 metadata name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
8648 See ``dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata :ref:`dereferenceable_or_null
8649 <md_dereferenceable_or_null>`
8651 The optional ``!align`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
8652 ``<align_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64`` entry.
8653 The existence of the ``!align`` metadata on the instruction tells the
8654 optimizer that the value loaded is known to be aligned to a boundary specified
8655 by the integer value in the metadata node. The alignment must be a power of 2.
8656 This is analogous to the ''align'' attribute on parameters and return values.
8657 This metadata can only be applied to loads of a pointer type. If the returned
8658 value is not appropriately aligned at runtime, the behavior is undefined.
8663 The location of memory pointed to is loaded. If the value being loaded
8664 is of scalar type then the number of bytes read does not exceed the
8665 minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
8666 example, loading an ``i24`` reads at most three bytes. When loading a
8667 value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
8668 of bytes, the result is undefined if the value was not originally
8669 written using a store of the same type.
8674 .. code-block:: llvm
8676 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
8677 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
8678 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
8682 '``store``' Instruction
8683 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8690 store [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
8691 store atomic [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
8696 The '``store``' instruction is used to write to memory.
8701 There are two arguments to the ``store`` instruction: a value to store and an
8702 address at which to store it. The type of the ``<pointer>`` operand must be a
8703 pointer to the :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of the ``<value>``
8704 operand. If the ``store`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not
8705 allowed to modify the number or order of execution of this ``store`` with other
8706 :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`. Only values of :ref:`first class
8707 <t_firstclass>` types of known size (i.e. not containing an :ref:`opaque
8708 structural type <t_opaque>`) can be stored.
8710 If the ``store`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering
8711 <ordering>` and optional ``syncscope("<target-scope>")`` argument. The
8712 ``acquire`` and ``acq_rel`` orderings aren't valid on ``store`` instructions.
8713 Atomic loads produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see
8714 multiple atomic stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or
8715 floating-point type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to
8716 eight and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit. ``align`` must be
8717 explicitly specified on atomic stores, and the store has undefined behavior if
8718 the alignment is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
8719 pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic stores.
8721 The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
8722 operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
8723 or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
8724 alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
8725 to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
8726 alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the
8727 alignment may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always
8728 safe. The maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``. An alignment
8729 value higher than the size of the stored type implies memory up to the
8730 alignment value bytes can be stored to without trapping in the default
8731 address space. Storing to the higher bytes however may result in data
8732 races if another thread can access the same address. Introducing a
8733 data race is not allowed. Storing to the extra bytes is not allowed
8734 even in situations where a data race is known to not exist if the
8735 function has the ``sanitize_address`` attribute.
8737 The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single metadata
8738 name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i32`` entry of
8739 value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal`` metadata on the instruction
8740 tells the optimizer and code generator that this load is not expected to
8741 be reused in the cache. The code generator may select special
8742 instructions to save cache bandwidth, such as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on
8745 The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a
8746 single metadata name ``<index>``. See ``invariant.group`` metadata.
8751 The contents of memory are updated to contain ``<value>`` at the
8752 location specified by the ``<pointer>`` operand. If ``<value>`` is
8753 of scalar type then the number of bytes written does not exceed the
8754 minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
8755 example, storing an ``i24`` writes at most three bytes. When writing a
8756 value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
8757 of bytes, it is unspecified what happens to the extra bits that do not
8758 belong to the type, but they will typically be overwritten.
8763 .. code-block:: llvm
8765 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
8766 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
8767 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
8771 '``fence``' Instruction
8772 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8779 fence [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering> ; yields void
8784 The '``fence``' instruction is used to introduce happens-before edges
8790 '``fence``' instructions take an :ref:`ordering <ordering>` argument which
8791 defines what *synchronizes-with* edges they add. They can only be given
8792 ``acquire``, ``release``, ``acq_rel``, and ``seq_cst`` orderings.
8797 A fence A which has (at least) ``release`` ordering semantics
8798 *synchronizes with* a fence B with (at least) ``acquire`` ordering
8799 semantics if and only if there exist atomic operations X and Y, both
8800 operating on some atomic object M, such that A is sequenced before X, X
8801 modifies M (either directly or through some side effect of a sequence
8802 headed by X), Y is sequenced before B, and Y observes M. This provides a
8803 *happens-before* dependency between A and B. Rather than an explicit
8804 ``fence``, one (but not both) of the atomic operations X or Y might
8805 provide a ``release`` or ``acquire`` (resp.) ordering constraint and
8806 still *synchronize-with* the explicit ``fence`` and establish the
8807 *happens-before* edge.
8809 A ``fence`` which has ``seq_cst`` ordering, in addition to having both
8810 ``acquire`` and ``release`` semantics specified above, participates in
8811 the global program order of other ``seq_cst`` operations and/or fences.
8813 A ``fence`` instruction can also take an optional
8814 ":ref:`syncscope <syncscope>`" argument.
8819 .. code-block:: text
8821 fence acquire ; yields void
8822 fence syncscope("singlethread") seq_cst ; yields void
8823 fence syncscope("agent") seq_cst ; yields void
8827 '``cmpxchg``' Instruction
8828 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8835 cmpxchg [weak] [volatile] <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <cmp>, <ty> <new> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <success ordering> <failure ordering> ; yields { ty, i1 }
8840 The '``cmpxchg``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory. It
8841 loads a value in memory and compares it to a given value. If they are
8842 equal, it tries to store a new value into the memory.
8847 There are three arguments to the '``cmpxchg``' instruction: an address
8848 to operate on, a value to compare to the value currently be at that
8849 address, and a new value to place at that address if the compared values
8850 are equal. The type of '<cmp>' must be an integer or pointer type whose
8851 bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less
8852 than or equal to a target-specific size limit. '<cmp>' and '<new>' must
8853 have the same type, and the type of '<pointer>' must be a pointer to
8854 that type. If the ``cmpxchg`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the
8855 optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of execution of
8856 this ``cmpxchg`` with other :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
8858 The success and failure :ref:`ordering <ordering>` arguments specify how this
8859 ``cmpxchg`` synchronizes with other atomic operations. Both ordering parameters
8860 must be at least ``monotonic``, the ordering constraint on failure must be no
8861 stronger than that on success, and the failure ordering cannot be either
8862 ``release`` or ``acq_rel``.
8864 A ``cmpxchg`` instruction can also take an optional
8865 ":ref:`syncscope <syncscope>`" argument.
8867 The pointer passed into cmpxchg must have alignment greater than or
8868 equal to the size in memory of the operand.
8873 The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``' operand
8874 is read and compared to '``<cmp>``'; if the values are equal, '``<new>``' is
8875 written to the location. The original value at the location is returned,
8876 together with a flag indicating success (true) or failure (false).
8878 If the cmpxchg operation is marked as ``weak`` then a spurious failure is
8879 permitted: the operation may not write ``<new>`` even if the comparison
8882 If the cmpxchg operation is strong (the default), the i1 value is 1 if and only
8883 if the value loaded equals ``cmp``.
8885 A successful ``cmpxchg`` is a read-modify-write instruction for the purpose of
8886 identifying release sequences. A failed ``cmpxchg`` is equivalent to an atomic
8887 load with an ordering parameter determined the second ordering parameter.
8892 .. code-block:: llvm
8895 %orig = load atomic i32, i32* %ptr unordered, align 4 ; yields i32
8899 %cmp = phi i32 [ %orig, %entry ], [%value_loaded, %loop]
8900 %squared = mul i32 %cmp, %cmp
8901 %val_success = cmpxchg i32* %ptr, i32 %cmp, i32 %squared acq_rel monotonic ; yields { i32, i1 }
8902 %value_loaded = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 0
8903 %success = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 1
8904 br i1 %success, label %done, label %loop
8911 '``atomicrmw``' Instruction
8912 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8919 atomicrmw [volatile] <operation> <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <value> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering> ; yields ty
8924 The '``atomicrmw``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory.
8929 There are three arguments to the '``atomicrmw``' instruction: an
8930 operation to apply, an address whose value to modify, an argument to the
8931 operation. The operation must be one of the following keywords:
8947 For most of these operations, the type of '<value>' must be an integer
8948 type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight
8949 and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit. For xchg, this
8950 may also be a floating point type with the same size constraints as
8951 integers. For fadd/fsub, this must be a floating point type. The
8952 type of the '``<pointer>``' operand must be a pointer to that type. If
8953 the ``atomicrmw`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not
8954 allowed to modify the number or order of execution of this
8955 ``atomicrmw`` with other :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
8957 A ``atomicrmw`` instruction can also take an optional
8958 ":ref:`syncscope <syncscope>`" argument.
8963 The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``'
8964 operand are atomically read, modified, and written back. The original
8965 value at the location is returned. The modification is specified by the
8968 - xchg: ``*ptr = val``
8969 - add: ``*ptr = *ptr + val``
8970 - sub: ``*ptr = *ptr - val``
8971 - and: ``*ptr = *ptr & val``
8972 - nand: ``*ptr = ~(*ptr & val)``
8973 - or: ``*ptr = *ptr | val``
8974 - xor: ``*ptr = *ptr ^ val``
8975 - max: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
8976 - min: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
8977 - umax: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
8979 - umin: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
8981 - fadd: ``*ptr = *ptr + val`` (using floating point arithmetic)
8982 - fsub: ``*ptr = *ptr - val`` (using floating point arithmetic)
8987 .. code-block:: llvm
8989 %old = atomicrmw add i32* %ptr, i32 1 acquire ; yields i32
8991 .. _i_getelementptr:
8993 '``getelementptr``' Instruction
8994 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9001 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, [inrange] <ty> <idx>}*
9002 <result> = getelementptr inbounds <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, [inrange] <ty> <idx>}*
9003 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ptr vector> <ptrval>, [inrange] <vector index type> <idx>
9008 The '``getelementptr``' instruction is used to get the address of a
9009 subelement of an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` data structure. It performs
9010 address calculation only and does not access memory. The instruction can also
9011 be used to calculate a vector of such addresses.
9016 The first argument is always a type used as the basis for the calculations.
9017 The second argument is always a pointer or a vector of pointers, and is the
9018 base address to start from. The remaining arguments are indices
9019 that indicate which of the elements of the aggregate object are indexed.
9020 The interpretation of each index is dependent on the type being indexed
9021 into. The first index always indexes the pointer value given as the
9022 second argument, the second index indexes a value of the type pointed to
9023 (not necessarily the value directly pointed to, since the first index
9024 can be non-zero), etc. The first type indexed into must be a pointer
9025 value, subsequent types can be arrays, vectors, and structs. Note that
9026 subsequent types being indexed into can never be pointers, since that
9027 would require loading the pointer before continuing calculation.
9029 The type of each index argument depends on the type it is indexing into.
9030 When indexing into a (optionally packed) structure, only ``i32`` integer
9031 **constants** are allowed (when using a vector of indices they must all
9032 be the **same** ``i32`` integer constant). When indexing into an array,
9033 pointer or vector, integers of any width are allowed, and they are not
9034 required to be constant. These integers are treated as signed values
9037 For example, let's consider a C code fragment and how it gets compiled
9053 int *foo(struct ST *s) {
9054 return &s[1].Z.B[5][13];
9057 The LLVM code generated by Clang is:
9059 .. code-block:: llvm
9061 %struct.RT = type { i8, [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }
9062 %struct.ST = type { i32, double, %struct.RT }
9064 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) nounwind uwtable readnone optsize ssp {
9066 %arrayidx = getelementptr inbounds %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i64 1, i32 2, i32 1, i64 5, i64 13
9073 In the example above, the first index is indexing into the
9074 '``%struct.ST*``' type, which is a pointer, yielding a '``%struct.ST``'
9075 = '``{ i32, double, %struct.RT }``' type, a structure. The second index
9076 indexes into the third element of the structure, yielding a
9077 '``%struct.RT``' = '``{ i8 , [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }``' type, another
9078 structure. The third index indexes into the second element of the
9079 structure, yielding a '``[10 x [20 x i32]]``' type, an array. The two
9080 dimensions of the array are subscripted into, yielding an '``i32``'
9081 type. The '``getelementptr``' instruction returns a pointer to this
9082 element, thus computing a value of '``i32*``' type.
9084 Note that it is perfectly legal to index partially through a structure,
9085 returning a pointer to an inner element. Because of this, the LLVM code
9086 for the given testcase is equivalent to:
9088 .. code-block:: llvm
9090 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) {
9091 %t1 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i32 1 ; yields %struct.ST*:%t1
9092 %t2 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %t1, i32 0, i32 2 ; yields %struct.RT*:%t2
9093 %t3 = getelementptr %struct.RT, %struct.RT* %t2, i32 0, i32 1 ; yields [10 x [20 x i32]]*:%t3
9094 %t4 = getelementptr [10 x [20 x i32]], [10 x [20 x i32]]* %t3, i32 0, i32 5 ; yields [20 x i32]*:%t4
9095 %t5 = getelementptr [20 x i32], [20 x i32]* %t4, i32 0, i32 13 ; yields i32*:%t5
9099 If the ``inbounds`` keyword is present, the result value of the
9100 ``getelementptr`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the base
9101 pointer is not an *in bounds* address of an allocated object, or if any
9102 of the addresses that would be formed by successive addition of the
9103 offsets implied by the indices to the base address with infinitely
9104 precise signed arithmetic are not an *in bounds* address of that
9105 allocated object. The *in bounds* addresses for an allocated object are
9106 all the addresses that point into the object, plus the address one byte
9107 past the end. The only *in bounds* address for a null pointer in the
9108 default address-space is the null pointer itself. In cases where the
9109 base is a vector of pointers the ``inbounds`` keyword applies to each
9110 of the computations element-wise.
9112 If the ``inbounds`` keyword is not present, the offsets are added to the
9113 base address with silently-wrapping two's complement arithmetic. If the
9114 offsets have a different width from the pointer, they are sign-extended
9115 or truncated to the width of the pointer. The result value of the
9116 ``getelementptr`` may be outside the object pointed to by the base
9117 pointer. The result value may not necessarily be used to access memory
9118 though, even if it happens to point into allocated storage. See the
9119 :ref:`Pointer Aliasing Rules <pointeraliasing>` section for more
9122 If the ``inrange`` keyword is present before any index, loading from or
9123 storing to any pointer derived from the ``getelementptr`` has undefined
9124 behavior if the load or store would access memory outside of the bounds of
9125 the element selected by the index marked as ``inrange``. The result of a
9126 pointer comparison or ``ptrtoint`` (including ``ptrtoint``-like operations
9127 involving memory) involving a pointer derived from a ``getelementptr`` with
9128 the ``inrange`` keyword is undefined, with the exception of comparisons
9129 in the case where both operands are in the range of the element selected
9130 by the ``inrange`` keyword, inclusive of the address one past the end of
9131 that element. Note that the ``inrange`` keyword is currently only allowed
9132 in constant ``getelementptr`` expressions.
9134 The getelementptr instruction is often confusing. For some more insight
9135 into how it works, see :doc:`the getelementptr FAQ <GetElementPtr>`.
9140 .. code-block:: llvm
9142 ; yields [12 x i8]*:aptr
9143 %aptr = getelementptr {i32, [12 x i8]}, {i32, [12 x i8]}* %saptr, i64 0, i32 1
9145 %vptr = getelementptr {i32, <2 x i8>}, {i32, <2 x i8>}* %svptr, i64 0, i32 1, i32 1
9147 %eptr = getelementptr [12 x i8], [12 x i8]* %aptr, i64 0, i32 1
9149 %iptr = getelementptr [10 x i32], [10 x i32]* @arr, i16 0, i16 0
9154 The ``getelementptr`` returns a vector of pointers, instead of a single address,
9155 when one or more of its arguments is a vector. In such cases, all vector
9156 arguments should have the same number of elements, and every scalar argument
9157 will be effectively broadcast into a vector during address calculation.
9159 .. code-block:: llvm
9161 ; All arguments are vectors:
9162 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
9163 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, <4 x i64> %offsets
9165 ; Add the same scalar offset to each pointer of a vector:
9166 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offset*sizeof(i8)
9167 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, i64 %offset
9169 ; Add distinct offsets to the same pointer:
9170 ; A[i] = ptr + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
9171 %A = getelementptr i8, i8* %ptr, <4 x i64> %offsets
9173 ; In all cases described above the type of the result is <4 x i8*>
9175 The two following instructions are equivalent:
9177 .. code-block:: llvm
9179 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
9180 <4 x i32> <i32 2, i32 2, i32 2, i32 2>,
9181 <4 x i32> <i32 1, i32 1, i32 1, i32 1>,
9183 <4 x i64> <i64 13, i64 13, i64 13, i64 13>
9185 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
9186 i32 2, i32 1, <4 x i32> %ind4, i64 13
9188 Let's look at the C code, where the vector version of ``getelementptr``
9193 // Let's assume that we vectorize the following loop:
9194 double *A, *B; int *C;
9195 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
9199 .. code-block:: llvm
9201 ; get pointers for 8 elements from array B
9202 %ptrs = getelementptr double, double* %B, <8 x i32> %C
9203 ; load 8 elements from array B into A
9204 %A = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v8f64.v8p0f64(<8 x double*> %ptrs,
9205 i32 8, <8 x i1> %mask, <8 x double> %passthru)
9207 Conversion Operations
9208 ---------------------
9210 The instructions in this category are the conversion instructions
9211 (casting) which all take a single operand and a type. They perform
9212 various bit conversions on the operand.
9216 '``trunc .. to``' Instruction
9217 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9224 <result> = trunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9229 The '``trunc``' instruction truncates its operand to the type ``ty2``.
9234 The '``trunc``' instruction takes a value to trunc, and a type to trunc
9235 it to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors
9236 of the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
9237 larger than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``. Equal sized
9238 types are not allowed.
9243 The '``trunc``' instruction truncates the high order bits in ``value``
9244 and converts the remaining bits to ``ty2``. Since the source size must
9245 be larger than the destination size, ``trunc`` cannot be a *no-op cast*.
9246 It will always truncate bits.
9251 .. code-block:: llvm
9253 %X = trunc i32 257 to i8 ; yields i8:1
9254 %Y = trunc i32 123 to i1 ; yields i1:true
9255 %Z = trunc i32 122 to i1 ; yields i1:false
9256 %W = trunc <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i8> ; yields <i8 8, i8 7>
9260 '``zext .. to``' Instruction
9261 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9268 <result> = zext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9273 The '``zext``' instruction zero extends its operand to type ``ty2``.
9278 The '``zext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
9279 to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
9280 the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
9281 smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
9286 The ``zext`` fills the high order bits of the ``value`` with zero bits
9287 until it reaches the size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
9289 When zero extending from i1, the result will always be either 0 or 1.
9294 .. code-block:: llvm
9296 %X = zext i32 257 to i64 ; yields i64:257
9297 %Y = zext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:1
9298 %Z = zext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
9302 '``sext .. to``' Instruction
9303 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9310 <result> = sext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9315 The '``sext``' sign extends ``value`` to the type ``ty2``.
9320 The '``sext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
9321 to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
9322 the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
9323 smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
9328 The '``sext``' instruction performs a sign extension by copying the sign
9329 bit (highest order bit) of the ``value`` until it reaches the bit size
9330 of the type ``ty2``.
9332 When sign extending from i1, the extension always results in -1 or 0.
9337 .. code-block:: llvm
9339 %X = sext i8 -1 to i16 ; yields i16 :65535
9340 %Y = sext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:-1
9341 %Z = sext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
9343 '``fptrunc .. to``' Instruction
9344 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9351 <result> = fptrunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9356 The '``fptrunc``' instruction truncates ``value`` to type ``ty2``.
9361 The '``fptrunc``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>`
9362 value to cast and a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to cast it to.
9363 The size of ``value`` must be larger than the size of ``ty2``. This
9364 implies that ``fptrunc`` cannot be used to make a *no-op cast*.
9369 The '``fptrunc``' instruction casts a ``value`` from a larger
9370 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to a smaller :ref:`floating-point
9372 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
9373 environment <floatenv>`.
9378 .. code-block:: llvm
9380 %X = fptrunc double 16777217.0 to float ; yields float:16777216.0
9381 %Y = fptrunc double 1.0E+300 to half ; yields half:+infinity
9383 '``fpext .. to``' Instruction
9384 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9391 <result> = fpext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9396 The '``fpext``' extends a floating-point ``value`` to a larger floating-point
9402 The '``fpext``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>`
9403 ``value`` to cast, and a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to cast it
9404 to. The source type must be smaller than the destination type.
9409 The '``fpext``' instruction extends the ``value`` from a smaller
9410 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to a larger :ref:`floating-point
9411 <t_floating>` type. The ``fpext`` cannot be used to make a
9412 *no-op cast* because it always changes bits. Use ``bitcast`` to make a
9413 *no-op cast* for a floating-point cast.
9418 .. code-block:: llvm
9420 %X = fpext float 3.125 to double ; yields double:3.125000e+00
9421 %Y = fpext double %X to fp128 ; yields fp128:0xL00000000000000004000900000000000
9423 '``fptoui .. to``' Instruction
9424 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9431 <result> = fptoui <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9436 The '``fptoui``' converts a floating-point ``value`` to its unsigned
9437 integer equivalent of type ``ty2``.
9442 The '``fptoui``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9443 scalar or vector :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
9444 cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
9445 ``ty`` is a vector floating-point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
9446 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
9451 The '``fptoui``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating-point
9452 <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
9453 unsigned integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the result
9454 is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
9459 .. code-block:: llvm
9461 %X = fptoui double 123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:123
9462 %Y = fptoui float 1.0E+300 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
9463 %Z = fptoui float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
9465 '``fptosi .. to``' Instruction
9466 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9473 <result> = fptosi <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9478 The '``fptosi``' instruction converts :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>`
9479 ``value`` to type ``ty2``.
9484 The '``fptosi``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9485 scalar or vector :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
9486 cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
9487 ``ty`` is a vector floating-point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
9488 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
9493 The '``fptosi``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating-point
9494 <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
9495 signed integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the result
9496 is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
9501 .. code-block:: llvm
9503 %X = fptosi double -123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:-123
9504 %Y = fptosi float 1.0E-247 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
9505 %Z = fptosi float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
9507 '``uitofp .. to``' Instruction
9508 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9515 <result> = uitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9520 The '``uitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as an unsigned integer
9521 and converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
9526 The '``uitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9527 scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
9528 ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type. If
9529 ``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating-point
9530 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
9535 The '``uitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as an unsigned
9536 integer quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating-point
9537 value. If the value cannot be exactly represented, it is rounded using
9538 the default rounding mode.
9544 .. code-block:: llvm
9546 %X = uitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
9547 %Y = uitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:255.0
9549 '``sitofp .. to``' Instruction
9550 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9557 <result> = sitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9562 The '``sitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as a signed integer and
9563 converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
9568 The '``sitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9569 scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
9570 ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type. If
9571 ``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating-point
9572 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
9577 The '``sitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as a signed integer
9578 quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating-point value. If the
9579 value cannot be exactly represented, it is rounded using the default rounding
9585 .. code-block:: llvm
9587 %X = sitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
9588 %Y = sitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:-1.0
9592 '``ptrtoint .. to``' Instruction
9593 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9600 <result> = ptrtoint <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9605 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts the pointer or a vector of
9606 pointers ``value`` to the integer (or vector of integers) type ``ty2``.
9611 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction takes a ``value`` to cast, which must be
9612 a value of type :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or a vector of pointers, and a
9613 type to cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
9614 a vector of integers type.
9619 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts ``value`` to integer type
9620 ``ty2`` by interpreting the pointer value as an integer and either
9621 truncating or zero extending that value to the size of the integer type.
9622 If ``value`` is smaller than ``ty2`` then a zero extension is done. If
9623 ``value`` is larger than ``ty2`` then a truncation is done. If they are
9624 the same size, then nothing is done (*no-op cast*) other than a type
9630 .. code-block:: llvm
9632 %X = ptrtoint i32* %P to i8 ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
9633 %Y = ptrtoint i32* %P to i64 ; yields zero extension on 32-bit architecture
9634 %Z = ptrtoint <4 x i32*> %P to <4 x i64>; yields vector zero extension for a vector of addresses on 32-bit architecture
9638 '``inttoptr .. to``' Instruction
9639 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9646 <result> = inttoptr <ty> <value> to <ty2>[, !dereferenceable !<deref_bytes_node>][, !dereferenceable_or_null !<deref_bytes_node] ; yields ty2
9651 The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts an integer ``value`` to a
9652 pointer type, ``ty2``.
9657 The '``inttoptr``' instruction takes an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value to
9658 cast, and a type to cast it to, which must be a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>`
9661 The optional ``!dereferenceable`` metadata must reference a single metadata
9662 name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64``
9664 See ``dereferenceable`` metadata.
9666 The optional ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata must reference a single
9667 metadata name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
9669 See ``dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata.
9674 The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` by
9675 applying either a zero extension or a truncation depending on the size
9676 of the integer ``value``. If ``value`` is larger than the size of a
9677 pointer then a truncation is done. If ``value`` is smaller than the size
9678 of a pointer then a zero extension is done. If they are the same size,
9679 nothing is done (*no-op cast*).
9684 .. code-block:: llvm
9686 %X = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields zero extension on 64-bit architecture
9687 %Y = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields no-op on 32-bit architecture
9688 %Z = inttoptr i64 0 to i32* ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
9689 %Z = inttoptr <4 x i32> %G to <4 x i8*>; yields truncation of vector G to four pointers
9693 '``bitcast .. to``' Instruction
9694 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9701 <result> = bitcast <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9706 The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` without
9712 The '``bitcast``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9713 non-aggregate first class value, and a type to cast it to, which must
9714 also be a non-aggregate :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. The
9715 bit sizes of ``value`` and the destination type, ``ty2``, must be
9716 identical. If the source type is a pointer, the destination type must
9717 also be a pointer of the same size. This instruction supports bitwise
9718 conversion of vectors to integers and to vectors of other types (as
9719 long as they have the same size).
9724 The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2``. It
9725 is always a *no-op cast* because no bits change with this
9726 conversion. The conversion is done as if the ``value`` had been stored
9727 to memory and read back as type ``ty2``. Pointer (or vector of
9728 pointers) types may only be converted to other pointer (or vector of
9729 pointers) types with the same address space through this instruction.
9730 To convert pointers to other types, use the :ref:`inttoptr <i_inttoptr>`
9731 or :ref:`ptrtoint <i_ptrtoint>` instructions first.
9736 .. code-block:: text
9738 %X = bitcast i8 255 to i8 ; yields i8 :-1
9739 %Y = bitcast i32* %x to sint* ; yields sint*:%x
9740 %Z = bitcast <2 x int> %V to i64; ; yields i64: %V
9741 %Z = bitcast <2 x i32*> %V to <2 x i64*> ; yields <2 x i64*>
9743 .. _i_addrspacecast:
9745 '``addrspacecast .. to``' Instruction
9746 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9753 <result> = addrspacecast <pty> <ptrval> to <pty2> ; yields pty2
9758 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts ``ptrval`` from ``pty`` in
9759 address space ``n`` to type ``pty2`` in address space ``m``.
9764 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction takes a pointer or vector of pointer value
9765 to cast and a pointer type to cast it to, which must have a different
9771 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts the pointer value
9772 ``ptrval`` to type ``pty2``. It can be a *no-op cast* or a complex
9773 value modification, depending on the target and the address space
9774 pair. Pointer conversions within the same address space must be
9775 performed with the ``bitcast`` instruction. Note that if the address space
9776 conversion is legal then both result and operand refer to the same memory
9782 .. code-block:: llvm
9784 %X = addrspacecast i32* %x to i32 addrspace(1)* ; yields i32 addrspace(1)*:%x
9785 %Y = addrspacecast i32 addrspace(1)* %y to i64 addrspace(2)* ; yields i64 addrspace(2)*:%y
9786 %Z = addrspacecast <4 x i32*> %z to <4 x float addrspace(3)*> ; yields <4 x float addrspace(3)*>:%z
9793 The instructions in this category are the "miscellaneous" instructions,
9794 which defy better classification.
9798 '``icmp``' Instruction
9799 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9806 <result> = icmp <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
9811 The '``icmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or a vector of
9812 boolean values based on comparison of its two integer, integer vector,
9813 pointer, or pointer vector operands.
9818 The '``icmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
9819 the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
9820 not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition codes are:
9823 #. ``ne``: not equal
9824 #. ``ugt``: unsigned greater than
9825 #. ``uge``: unsigned greater or equal
9826 #. ``ult``: unsigned less than
9827 #. ``ule``: unsigned less or equal
9828 #. ``sgt``: signed greater than
9829 #. ``sge``: signed greater or equal
9830 #. ``slt``: signed less than
9831 #. ``sle``: signed less or equal
9833 The remaining two arguments must be :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
9834 :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or integer :ref:`vector <t_vector>` typed. They
9835 must also be identical types.
9840 The '``icmp``' compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the condition
9841 code given as ``cond``. The comparison performed always yields either an
9842 :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` or vector of ``i1`` result, as follows:
9844 #. ``eq``: yields ``true`` if the operands are equal, ``false``
9845 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
9846 #. ``ne``: yields ``true`` if the operands are unequal, ``false``
9847 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
9848 #. ``ugt``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9849 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
9850 #. ``uge``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9851 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9852 #. ``ult``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9853 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
9854 #. ``ule``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9855 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
9856 #. ``sgt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9857 if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
9858 #. ``sge``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9859 if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9860 #. ``slt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9861 if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
9862 #. ``sle``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9863 if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
9865 If the operands are :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` typed, the pointer values
9866 are compared as if they were integers.
9868 If the operands are integer vectors, then they are compared element by
9869 element. The result is an ``i1`` vector with the same number of elements
9870 as the values being compared. Otherwise, the result is an ``i1``.
9875 .. code-block:: text
9877 <result> = icmp eq i32 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9878 <result> = icmp ne float* %X, %X ; yields: result=false
9879 <result> = icmp ult i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=true
9880 <result> = icmp sgt i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9881 <result> = icmp ule i16 -4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9882 <result> = icmp sge i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9886 '``fcmp``' Instruction
9887 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9894 <result> = fcmp [fast-math flags]* <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
9899 The '``fcmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or vector of boolean
9900 values based on comparison of its operands.
9902 If the operands are floating-point scalars, then the result type is a
9903 boolean (:ref:`i1 <t_integer>`).
9905 If the operands are floating-point vectors, then the result type is a
9906 vector of boolean with the same number of elements as the operands being
9912 The '``fcmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
9913 the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
9914 not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition codes are:
9916 #. ``false``: no comparison, always returns false
9917 #. ``oeq``: ordered and equal
9918 #. ``ogt``: ordered and greater than
9919 #. ``oge``: ordered and greater than or equal
9920 #. ``olt``: ordered and less than
9921 #. ``ole``: ordered and less than or equal
9922 #. ``one``: ordered and not equal
9923 #. ``ord``: ordered (no nans)
9924 #. ``ueq``: unordered or equal
9925 #. ``ugt``: unordered or greater than
9926 #. ``uge``: unordered or greater than or equal
9927 #. ``ult``: unordered or less than
9928 #. ``ule``: unordered or less than or equal
9929 #. ``une``: unordered or not equal
9930 #. ``uno``: unordered (either nans)
9931 #. ``true``: no comparison, always returns true
9933 *Ordered* means that neither operand is a QNAN while *unordered* means
9934 that either operand may be a QNAN.
9936 Each of ``val1`` and ``val2`` arguments must be either a :ref:`floating-point
9937 <t_floating>` type or a :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating-point type.
9938 They must have identical types.
9943 The '``fcmp``' instruction compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the
9944 condition code given as ``cond``. If the operands are vectors, then the
9945 vectors are compared element by element. Each comparison performed
9946 always yields an :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` result, as follows:
9948 #. ``false``: always yields ``false``, regardless of operands.
9949 #. ``oeq``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9950 is equal to ``op2``.
9951 #. ``ogt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9952 is greater than ``op2``.
9953 #. ``oge``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9954 is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9955 #. ``olt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9956 is less than ``op2``.
9957 #. ``ole``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9958 is less than or equal to ``op2``.
9959 #. ``one``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9960 is not equal to ``op2``.
9961 #. ``ord``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN.
9962 #. ``ueq``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9964 #. ``ugt``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9965 greater than ``op2``.
9966 #. ``uge``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9967 greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9968 #. ``ult``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9970 #. ``ule``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9971 less than or equal to ``op2``.
9972 #. ``une``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9973 not equal to ``op2``.
9974 #. ``uno``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN.
9975 #. ``true``: always yields ``true``, regardless of operands.
9977 The ``fcmp`` instruction can also optionally take any number of
9978 :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable
9979 otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations.
9981 Any set of fast-math flags are legal on an ``fcmp`` instruction, but the
9982 only flags that have any effect on its semantics are those that allow
9983 assumptions to be made about the values of input arguments; namely
9984 ``nnan``, ``ninf``, and ``reassoc``. See :ref:`fastmath` for more information.
9989 .. code-block:: text
9991 <result> = fcmp oeq float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=false
9992 <result> = fcmp one float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
9993 <result> = fcmp olt float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
9994 <result> = fcmp ueq double 1.0, 2.0 ; yields: result=false
9998 '``phi``' Instruction
9999 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10006 <result> = phi <ty> [ <val0>, <label0>], ...
10011 The '``phi``' instruction is used to implement the φ node in the SSA
10012 graph representing the function.
10017 The type of the incoming values is specified with the first type field.
10018 After this, the '``phi``' instruction takes a list of pairs as
10019 arguments, with one pair for each predecessor basic block of the current
10020 block. Only values of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type may be used as
10021 the value arguments to the PHI node. Only labels may be used as the
10024 There must be no non-phi instructions between the start of a basic block
10025 and the PHI instructions: i.e. PHI instructions must be first in a basic
10028 For the purposes of the SSA form, the use of each incoming value is
10029 deemed to occur on the edge from the corresponding predecessor block to
10030 the current block (but after any definition of an '``invoke``'
10031 instruction's return value on the same edge).
10036 At runtime, the '``phi``' instruction logically takes on the value
10037 specified by the pair corresponding to the predecessor basic block that
10038 executed just prior to the current block.
10043 .. code-block:: llvm
10045 Loop: ; Infinite loop that counts from 0 on up...
10046 %indvar = phi i32 [ 0, %LoopHeader ], [ %nextindvar, %Loop ]
10047 %nextindvar = add i32 %indvar, 1
10052 '``select``' Instruction
10053 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10060 <result> = select [fast-math flags] selty <cond>, <ty> <val1>, <ty> <val2> ; yields ty
10062 selty is either i1 or {<N x i1>}
10067 The '``select``' instruction is used to choose one value based on a
10068 condition, without IR-level branching.
10073 The '``select``' instruction requires an 'i1' value or a vector of 'i1'
10074 values indicating the condition, and two values of the same :ref:`first
10075 class <t_firstclass>` type.
10077 #. The optional ``fast-math flags`` marker indicates that the select has one or more
10078 :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`. These are optimization hints to enable
10079 otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations. Fast-math flags are only valid
10080 for selects that return a floating-point scalar or vector type.
10085 If the condition is an i1 and it evaluates to 1, the instruction returns
10086 the first value argument; otherwise, it returns the second value
10089 If the condition is a vector of i1, then the value arguments must be
10090 vectors of the same size, and the selection is done element by element.
10092 If the condition is an i1 and the value arguments are vectors of the
10093 same size, then an entire vector is selected.
10098 .. code-block:: llvm
10100 %X = select i1 true, i8 17, i8 42 ; yields i8:17
10104 '``call``' Instruction
10105 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10112 <result> = [tail | musttail | notail ] call [fast-math flags] [cconv] [ret attrs] [addrspace(<num>)]
10113 [<ty>|<fnty> <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs] [ operand bundles ]
10118 The '``call``' instruction represents a simple function call.
10123 This instruction requires several arguments:
10125 #. The optional ``tail`` and ``musttail`` markers indicate that the optimizers
10126 should perform tail call optimization. The ``tail`` marker is a hint that
10127 `can be ignored <CodeGenerator.html#sibcallopt>`_. The ``musttail`` marker
10128 means that the call must be tail call optimized in order for the program to
10129 be correct. The ``musttail`` marker provides these guarantees:
10131 #. The call will not cause unbounded stack growth if it is part of a
10132 recursive cycle in the call graph.
10133 #. Arguments with the :ref:`inalloca <attr_inalloca>` attribute are
10134 forwarded in place.
10135 #. If the musttail call appears in a function with the ``"thunk"`` attribute
10136 and the caller and callee both have varargs, than any unprototyped
10137 arguments in register or memory are forwarded to the callee. Similarly,
10138 the return value of the callee is returned the the caller's caller, even
10139 if a void return type is in use.
10141 Both markers imply that the callee does not access allocas from the caller.
10142 The ``tail`` marker additionally implies that the callee does not access
10143 varargs from the caller. Calls marked ``musttail`` must obey the following
10146 - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction,
10147 or a pointer bitcast followed by a ret instruction.
10148 - The ret instruction must return the (possibly bitcasted) value
10149 produced by the call or void.
10150 - The caller and callee prototypes must match. Pointer types of
10151 parameters or return types may differ in pointee type, but not
10153 - The calling conventions of the caller and callee must match.
10154 - All ABI-impacting function attributes, such as sret, byval, inreg,
10155 returned, and inalloca, must match.
10156 - The callee must be varargs iff the caller is varargs. Bitcasting a
10157 non-varargs function to the appropriate varargs type is legal so
10158 long as the non-varargs prefixes obey the other rules.
10160 Tail call optimization for calls marked ``tail`` is guaranteed to occur if
10161 the following conditions are met:
10163 - Caller and callee both have the calling convention ``fastcc``.
10164 - The call is in tail position (ret immediately follows call and ret
10165 uses value of call or is void).
10166 - Option ``-tailcallopt`` is enabled, or
10167 ``llvm::GuaranteedTailCallOpt`` is ``true``.
10168 - `Platform-specific constraints are
10169 met. <CodeGenerator.html#tailcallopt>`_
10171 #. The optional ``notail`` marker indicates that the optimizers should not add
10172 ``tail`` or ``musttail`` markers to the call. It is used to prevent tail
10173 call optimization from being performed on the call.
10175 #. The optional ``fast-math flags`` marker indicates that the call has one or more
10176 :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable
10177 otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations. Fast-math flags are only valid
10178 for calls that return a floating-point scalar or vector type.
10180 #. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
10181 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
10182 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions. The
10183 calling convention of the call must match the calling convention of
10184 the target function, or else the behavior is undefined.
10185 #. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
10186 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
10188 #. The optional addrspace attribute can be used to indicate the address space
10189 of the called function. If it is not specified, the program address space
10190 from the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>` will be used.
10191 #. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
10192 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
10194 #. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the function being called. The
10195 argument types must match the types implied by this signature. This
10196 type can be omitted if the function is not varargs.
10197 #. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
10198 be called. In most cases, this is a direct function call, but
10199 indirect ``call``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
10201 #. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
10202 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
10203 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
10204 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
10205 extra arguments can be specified.
10206 #. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list.
10207 #. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
10212 The '``call``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to
10213 a specified function, with its incoming arguments bound to the specified
10214 values. Upon a '``ret``' instruction in the called function, control
10215 flow continues with the instruction after the function call, and the
10216 return value of the function is bound to the result argument.
10221 .. code-block:: llvm
10223 %retval = call i32 @test(i32 %argc)
10224 call i32 (i8*, ...)* @printf(i8* %msg, i32 12, i8 42) ; yields i32
10225 %X = tail call i32 @foo() ; yields i32
10226 %Y = tail call fastcc i32 @foo() ; yields i32
10227 call void %foo(i8 97 signext)
10229 %struct.A = type { i32, i8 }
10230 %r = call %struct.A @foo() ; yields { i32, i8 }
10231 %gr = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 0 ; yields i32
10232 %gr1 = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 1 ; yields i8
10233 %Z = call void @foo() noreturn ; indicates that %foo never returns normally
10234 %ZZ = call zeroext i32 @bar() ; Return value is %zero extended
10236 llvm treats calls to some functions with names and arguments that match
10237 the standard C99 library as being the C99 library functions, and may
10238 perform optimizations or generate code for them under that assumption.
10239 This is something we'd like to change in the future to provide better
10240 support for freestanding environments and non-C-based languages.
10244 '``va_arg``' Instruction
10245 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10252 <resultval> = va_arg <va_list*> <arglist>, <argty>
10257 The '``va_arg``' instruction is used to access arguments passed through
10258 the "variable argument" area of a function call. It is used to implement
10259 the ``va_arg`` macro in C.
10264 This instruction takes a ``va_list*`` value and the type of the
10265 argument. It returns a value of the specified argument type and
10266 increments the ``va_list`` to point to the next argument. The actual
10267 type of ``va_list`` is target specific.
10272 The '``va_arg``' instruction loads an argument of the specified type
10273 from the specified ``va_list`` and causes the ``va_list`` to point to
10274 the next argument. For more information, see the variable argument
10275 handling :ref:`Intrinsic Functions <int_varargs>`.
10277 It is legal for this instruction to be called in a function which does
10278 not take a variable number of arguments, for example, the ``vfprintf``
10281 ``va_arg`` is an LLVM instruction instead of an :ref:`intrinsic
10282 function <intrinsics>` because it takes a type as an argument.
10287 See the :ref:`variable argument processing <int_varargs>` section.
10289 Note that the code generator does not yet fully support va\_arg on many
10290 targets. Also, it does not currently support va\_arg with aggregate
10291 types on any target.
10295 '``landingpad``' Instruction
10296 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10303 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> <clause>+
10304 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> cleanup <clause>*
10306 <clause> := catch <type> <value>
10307 <clause> := filter <array constant type> <array constant>
10312 The '``landingpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
10313 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
10314 is a landing pad --- one where the exception lands, and corresponds to the
10315 code found in the ``catch`` portion of a ``try``/``catch`` sequence. It
10316 defines values supplied by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon
10317 re-entry to the function. The ``resultval`` has the type ``resultty``.
10323 ``cleanup`` flag indicates that the landing pad block is a cleanup.
10325 A ``clause`` begins with the clause type --- ``catch`` or ``filter`` --- and
10326 contains the global variable representing the "type" that may be caught
10327 or filtered respectively. Unlike the ``catch`` clause, the ``filter``
10328 clause takes an array constant as its argument. Use
10329 "``[0 x i8**] undef``" for a filter which cannot throw. The
10330 '``landingpad``' instruction must contain *at least* one ``clause`` or
10331 the ``cleanup`` flag.
10336 The '``landingpad``' instruction defines the values which are set by the
10337 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon re-entry to the function, and
10338 therefore the "result type" of the ``landingpad`` instruction. As with
10339 calling conventions, how the personality function results are
10340 represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
10342 The clauses are applied in order from top to bottom. If two
10343 ``landingpad`` instructions are merged together through inlining, the
10344 clauses from the calling function are appended to the list of clauses.
10345 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
10346 the exception is compared against each ``clause`` in turn. If it doesn't
10347 match any of the clauses, and the ``cleanup`` flag is not set, then
10348 unwinding continues further up the call stack.
10350 The ``landingpad`` instruction has several restrictions:
10352 - A landing pad block is a basic block which is the unwind destination
10353 of an '``invoke``' instruction.
10354 - A landing pad block must have a '``landingpad``' instruction as its
10355 first non-PHI instruction.
10356 - There can be only one '``landingpad``' instruction within the landing
10358 - A basic block that is not a landing pad block may not include a
10359 '``landingpad``' instruction.
10364 .. code-block:: llvm
10366 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer.
10367 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
10369 ;; A landing pad that is a cleanup.
10370 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
10372 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer and can only throw a double.
10373 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
10375 filter [1 x i8**] [@_ZTId]
10379 '``catchpad``' Instruction
10380 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10387 <resultval> = catchpad within <catchswitch> [<args>*]
10392 The '``catchpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
10393 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
10394 begins a catch handler --- one where a personality routine attempts to transfer
10395 control to catch an exception.
10400 The ``catchswitch`` operand must always be a token produced by a
10401 :ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>` instruction in a predecessor block. This
10402 ensures that each ``catchpad`` has exactly one predecessor block, and it always
10403 terminates in a ``catchswitch``.
10405 The ``args`` correspond to whatever information the personality routine
10406 requires to know if this is an appropriate handler for the exception. Control
10407 will transfer to the ``catchpad`` if this is the first appropriate handler for
10410 The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to match the
10411 ``catchpad`` to corresponding :ref:`catchrets <i_catchret>` and other nested EH
10417 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown, the
10418 exception is compared against the ``args``. If it doesn't match, control will
10419 not reach the ``catchpad`` instruction. The representation of ``args`` is
10420 entirely target and personality function-specific.
10422 Like the :ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction, the ``catchpad``
10423 instruction must be the first non-phi of its parent basic block.
10425 The meaning of the tokens produced and consumed by ``catchpad`` and other "pad"
10426 instructions is described in the
10427 `Windows exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh>`_.
10429 When a ``catchpad`` has been "entered" but not yet "exited" (as
10430 described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
10431 it is undefined behavior to execute a :ref:`call <i_call>` or :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`
10432 that does not carry an appropriate :ref:`"funclet" bundle <ob_funclet>`.
10437 .. code-block:: text
10440 %cs = catchswitch within none [label %handler0] unwind to caller
10441 ;; A catch block which can catch an integer.
10443 %tok = catchpad within %cs [i8** @_ZTIi]
10447 '``cleanuppad``' Instruction
10448 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10455 <resultval> = cleanuppad within <parent> [<args>*]
10460 The '``cleanuppad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
10461 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
10462 is a cleanup block --- one where a personality routine attempts to
10463 transfer control to run cleanup actions.
10464 The ``args`` correspond to whatever additional
10465 information the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` requires to
10466 execute the cleanup.
10467 The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to
10468 match the ``cleanuppad`` to corresponding :ref:`cleanuprets <i_cleanupret>`.
10469 The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
10470 ``cleanuppad`` instruction. If the ``cleanuppad`` is not inside a funclet,
10471 this operand may be the token ``none``.
10476 The instruction takes a list of arbitrary values which are interpreted
10477 by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>`.
10482 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
10483 the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` transfers control to the
10484 ``cleanuppad`` with the aid of the personality-specific arguments.
10485 As with calling conventions, how the personality function results are
10486 represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
10488 The ``cleanuppad`` instruction has several restrictions:
10490 - A cleanup block is a basic block which is the unwind destination of
10491 an exceptional instruction.
10492 - A cleanup block must have a '``cleanuppad``' instruction as its
10493 first non-PHI instruction.
10494 - There can be only one '``cleanuppad``' instruction within the
10496 - A basic block that is not a cleanup block may not include a
10497 '``cleanuppad``' instruction.
10499 When a ``cleanuppad`` has been "entered" but not yet "exited" (as
10500 described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
10501 it is undefined behavior to execute a :ref:`call <i_call>` or :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`
10502 that does not carry an appropriate :ref:`"funclet" bundle <ob_funclet>`.
10507 .. code-block:: text
10509 %tok = cleanuppad within %cs []
10513 Intrinsic Functions
10514 ===================
10516 LLVM supports the notion of an "intrinsic function". These functions
10517 have well known names and semantics and are required to follow certain
10518 restrictions. Overall, these intrinsics represent an extension mechanism
10519 for the LLVM language that does not require changing all of the
10520 transformations in LLVM when adding to the language (or the bitcode
10521 reader/writer, the parser, etc...).
10523 Intrinsic function names must all start with an "``llvm.``" prefix. This
10524 prefix is reserved in LLVM for intrinsic names; thus, function names may
10525 not begin with this prefix. Intrinsic functions must always be external
10526 functions: you cannot define the body of intrinsic functions. Intrinsic
10527 functions may only be used in call or invoke instructions: it is illegal
10528 to take the address of an intrinsic function. Additionally, because
10529 intrinsic functions are part of the LLVM language, it is required if any
10530 are added that they be documented here.
10532 Some intrinsic functions can be overloaded, i.e., the intrinsic
10533 represents a family of functions that perform the same operation but on
10534 different data types. Because LLVM can represent over 8 million
10535 different integer types, overloading is used commonly to allow an
10536 intrinsic function to operate on any integer type. One or more of the
10537 argument types or the result type can be overloaded to accept any
10538 integer type. Argument types may also be defined as exactly matching a
10539 previous argument's type or the result type. This allows an intrinsic
10540 function which accepts multiple arguments, but needs all of them to be
10541 of the same type, to only be overloaded with respect to a single
10542 argument or the result.
10544 Overloaded intrinsics will have the names of its overloaded argument
10545 types encoded into its function name, each preceded by a period. Only
10546 those types which are overloaded result in a name suffix. Arguments
10547 whose type is matched against another type do not. For example, the
10548 ``llvm.ctpop`` function can take an integer of any width and returns an
10549 integer of exactly the same integer width. This leads to a family of
10550 functions such as ``i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %val)`` and
10551 ``i29 @llvm.ctpop.i29(i29 %val)``. Only one type, the return type, is
10552 overloaded, and only one type suffix is required. Because the argument's
10553 type is matched against the return type, it does not require its own
10556 For target developers who are defining intrinsics for back-end code
10557 generation, any intrinsic overloads based solely the distinction between
10558 integer or floating point types should not be relied upon for correct
10559 code generation. In such cases, the recommended approach for target
10560 maintainers when defining intrinsics is to create separate integer and
10561 FP intrinsics rather than rely on overloading. For example, if different
10562 codegen is required for ``llvm.target.foo(<4 x i32>)`` and
10563 ``llvm.target.foo(<4 x float>)`` then these should be split into
10564 different intrinsics.
10566 To learn how to add an intrinsic function, please see the `Extending
10567 LLVM Guide <ExtendingLLVM.html>`_.
10571 Variable Argument Handling Intrinsics
10572 -------------------------------------
10574 Variable argument support is defined in LLVM with the
10575 :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and these three intrinsic
10576 functions. These functions are related to the similarly named macros
10577 defined in the ``<stdarg.h>`` header file.
10579 All of these functions operate on arguments that use a target-specific
10580 value type "``va_list``". The LLVM assembly language reference manual
10581 does not define what this type is, so all transformations should be
10582 prepared to handle these functions regardless of the type used.
10584 This example shows how the :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and the
10585 variable argument handling intrinsic functions are used.
10587 .. code-block:: llvm
10589 ; This struct is different for every platform. For most platforms,
10590 ; it is merely an i8*.
10591 %struct.va_list = type { i8* }
10593 ; For Unix x86_64 platforms, va_list is the following struct:
10594 ; %struct.va_list = type { i32, i32, i8*, i8* }
10596 define i32 @test(i32 %X, ...) {
10597 ; Initialize variable argument processing
10598 %ap = alloca %struct.va_list
10599 %ap2 = bitcast %struct.va_list* %ap to i8*
10600 call void @llvm.va_start(i8* %ap2)
10602 ; Read a single integer argument
10603 %tmp = va_arg i8* %ap2, i32
10605 ; Demonstrate usage of llvm.va_copy and llvm.va_end
10607 %aq2 = bitcast i8** %aq to i8*
10608 call void @llvm.va_copy(i8* %aq2, i8* %ap2)
10609 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %aq2)
10611 ; Stop processing of arguments.
10612 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %ap2)
10616 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8*)
10617 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8*, i8*)
10618 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8*)
10622 '``llvm.va_start``' Intrinsic
10623 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10630 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8* <arglist>)
10635 The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic initializes ``*<arglist>`` for
10636 subsequent use by ``va_arg``.
10641 The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
10646 The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_start`` macro
10647 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it initializes the
10648 ``va_list`` element to which the argument points, so that the next call
10649 to ``va_arg`` will produce the first variable argument passed to the
10650 function. Unlike the C ``va_start`` macro, this intrinsic does not need
10651 to know the last argument of the function as the compiler can figure
10654 '``llvm.va_end``' Intrinsic
10655 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10662 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8* <arglist>)
10667 The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic destroys ``*<arglist>``, which has been
10668 initialized previously with ``llvm.va_start`` or ``llvm.va_copy``.
10673 The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` to destroy.
10678 The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_end`` macro
10679 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it destroys the ``va_list``
10680 element to which the argument points. Calls to
10681 :ref:`llvm.va_start <int_va_start>` and
10682 :ref:`llvm.va_copy <int_va_copy>` must be matched exactly with calls to
10687 '``llvm.va_copy``' Intrinsic
10688 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10695 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8* <destarglist>, i8* <srcarglist>)
10700 The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic copies the current argument position
10701 from the source argument list to the destination argument list.
10706 The first argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
10707 The second argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to copy from.
10712 The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_copy`` macro
10713 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it copies the source
10714 ``va_list`` element into the destination ``va_list`` element. This
10715 intrinsic is necessary because the `` llvm.va_start`` intrinsic may be
10716 arbitrarily complex and require, for example, memory allocation.
10718 Accurate Garbage Collection Intrinsics
10719 --------------------------------------
10721 LLVM's support for `Accurate Garbage Collection <GarbageCollection.html>`_
10722 (GC) requires the frontend to generate code containing appropriate intrinsic
10723 calls and select an appropriate GC strategy which knows how to lower these
10724 intrinsics in a manner which is appropriate for the target collector.
10726 These intrinsics allow identification of :ref:`GC roots on the
10727 stack <int_gcroot>`, as well as garbage collector implementations that
10728 require :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers.
10729 Frontends for type-safe garbage collected languages should generate
10730 these intrinsics to make use of the LLVM garbage collectors. For more
10731 details, see `Garbage Collection with LLVM <GarbageCollection.html>`_.
10733 Experimental Statepoint Intrinsics
10734 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10736 LLVM provides an second experimental set of intrinsics for describing garbage
10737 collection safepoints in compiled code. These intrinsics are an alternative
10738 to the ``llvm.gcroot`` intrinsics, but are compatible with the ones for
10739 :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers. The
10740 differences in approach are covered in the `Garbage Collection with LLVM
10741 <GarbageCollection.html>`_ documentation. The intrinsics themselves are
10742 described in :doc:`Statepoints`.
10746 '``llvm.gcroot``' Intrinsic
10747 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10754 declare void @llvm.gcroot(i8** %ptrloc, i8* %metadata)
10759 The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic declares the existence of a GC root to
10760 the code generator, and allows some metadata to be associated with it.
10765 The first argument specifies the address of a stack object that contains
10766 the root pointer. The second pointer (which must be either a constant or
10767 a global value address) contains the meta-data to be associated with the
10773 At runtime, a call to this intrinsic stores a null pointer into the
10774 "ptrloc" location. At compile-time, the code generator generates
10775 information to allow the runtime to find the pointer at GC safe points.
10776 The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic may only be used in a function which
10777 :ref:`specifies a GC algorithm <gc>`.
10781 '``llvm.gcread``' Intrinsic
10782 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10789 declare i8* @llvm.gcread(i8* %ObjPtr, i8** %Ptr)
10794 The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic identifies reads of references from heap
10795 locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require read
10801 The second argument is the address to read from, which should be an
10802 address allocated from the garbage collector. The first object is a
10803 pointer to the start of the referenced object, if needed by the language
10804 runtime (otherwise null).
10809 The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a load
10810 instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
10811 the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcread``'
10812 intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
10817 '``llvm.gcwrite``' Intrinsic
10818 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10825 declare void @llvm.gcwrite(i8* %P1, i8* %Obj, i8** %P2)
10830 The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic identifies writes of references to heap
10831 locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require write
10832 barriers (such as generational or reference counting collectors).
10837 The first argument is the reference to store, the second is the start of
10838 the object to store it to, and the third is the address of the field of
10839 Obj to store to. If the runtime does not require a pointer to the
10840 object, Obj may be null.
10845 The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a store
10846 instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
10847 the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcwrite``'
10848 intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
10851 Code Generator Intrinsics
10852 -------------------------
10854 These intrinsics are provided by LLVM to expose special features that
10855 may only be implemented with code generator support.
10857 '``llvm.returnaddress``' Intrinsic
10858 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10865 declare i8* @llvm.returnaddress(i32 <level>)
10870 The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic attempts to compute a
10871 target-specific value indicating the return address of the current
10872 function or one of its callers.
10877 The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
10878 address for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates its
10879 caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
10885 The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
10886 indicating the return address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
10887 cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
10888 be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
10889 used for debugging purposes.
10891 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
10892 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
10893 of the obvious source-language caller.
10895 '``llvm.addressofreturnaddress``' Intrinsic
10896 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10903 declare i8* @llvm.addressofreturnaddress()
10908 The '``llvm.addressofreturnaddress``' intrinsic returns a target-specific
10909 pointer to the place in the stack frame where the return address of the
10910 current function is stored.
10915 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
10916 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
10917 of the obvious source-language caller.
10919 This intrinsic is only implemented for x86 and aarch64.
10921 '``llvm.sponentry``' Intrinsic
10922 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10929 declare i8* @llvm.sponentry()
10934 The '``llvm.sponentry``' intrinsic returns the stack pointer value at
10935 the entry of the current function calling this intrinsic.
10940 Note this intrinsic is only verified on AArch64.
10942 '``llvm.frameaddress``' Intrinsic
10943 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10950 declare i8* @llvm.frameaddress(i32 <level>)
10955 The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic attempts to return the
10956 target-specific frame pointer value for the specified stack frame.
10961 The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
10962 frame pointer for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates
10963 its caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
10969 The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
10970 indicating the frame address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
10971 cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
10972 be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
10973 used for debugging purposes.
10975 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
10976 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
10977 of the obvious source-language caller.
10979 '``llvm.localescape``' and '``llvm.localrecover``' Intrinsics
10980 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10987 declare void @llvm.localescape(...)
10988 declare i8* @llvm.localrecover(i8* %func, i8* %fp, i32 %idx)
10993 The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic escapes offsets of a collection of static
10994 allocas, and the '``llvm.localrecover``' intrinsic applies those offsets to a
10995 live frame pointer to recover the address of the allocation. The offset is
10996 computed during frame layout of the caller of ``llvm.localescape``.
11001 All arguments to '``llvm.localescape``' must be pointers to static allocas or
11002 casts of static allocas. Each function can only call '``llvm.localescape``'
11003 once, and it can only do so from the entry block.
11005 The ``func`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a constant
11006 bitcasted pointer to a function defined in the current module. The code
11007 generator cannot determine the frame allocation offset of functions defined in
11010 The ``fp`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a frame pointer of a
11011 call frame that is currently live. The return value of '``llvm.localaddress``'
11012 is one way to produce such a value, but various runtimes also expose a suitable
11013 pointer in platform-specific ways.
11015 The ``idx`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' indicates which alloca passed to
11016 '``llvm.localescape``' to recover. It is zero-indexed.
11021 These intrinsics allow a group of functions to share access to a set of local
11022 stack allocations of a one parent function. The parent function may call the
11023 '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic once from the function entry block, and the
11024 child functions can use '``llvm.localrecover``' to access the escaped allocas.
11025 The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic blocks inlining, as inlining changes where
11026 the escaped allocas are allocated, which would break attempts to use
11027 '``llvm.localrecover``'.
11029 .. _int_read_register:
11030 .. _int_write_register:
11032 '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' Intrinsics
11033 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11040 declare i32 @llvm.read_register.i32(metadata)
11041 declare i64 @llvm.read_register.i64(metadata)
11042 declare void @llvm.write_register.i32(metadata, i32 @value)
11043 declare void @llvm.write_register.i64(metadata, i64 @value)
11049 The '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsics
11050 provides access to the named register. The register must be valid on
11051 the architecture being compiled to. The type needs to be compatible
11052 with the register being read.
11057 The '``llvm.read_register``' intrinsic returns the current value of the
11058 register, where possible. The '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsic sets
11059 the current value of the register, where possible.
11061 This is useful to implement named register global variables that need
11062 to always be mapped to a specific register, as is common practice on
11063 bare-metal programs including OS kernels.
11065 The compiler doesn't check for register availability or use of the used
11066 register in surrounding code, including inline assembly. Because of that,
11067 allocatable registers are not supported.
11069 Warning: So far it only works with the stack pointer on selected
11070 architectures (ARM, AArch64, PowerPC and x86_64). Significant amount of
11071 work is needed to support other registers and even more so, allocatable
11076 '``llvm.stacksave``' Intrinsic
11077 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11084 declare i8* @llvm.stacksave()
11089 The '``llvm.stacksave``' intrinsic is used to remember the current state
11090 of the function stack, for use with
11091 :ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. This is useful for
11092 implementing language features like scoped automatic variable sized
11098 This intrinsic returns a opaque pointer value that can be passed to
11099 :ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. When an
11100 ``llvm.stackrestore`` intrinsic is executed with a value saved from
11101 ``llvm.stacksave``, it effectively restores the state of the stack to
11102 the state it was in when the ``llvm.stacksave`` intrinsic executed. In
11103 practice, this pops any :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>` blocks from the stack that
11104 were allocated after the ``llvm.stacksave`` was executed.
11106 .. _int_stackrestore:
11108 '``llvm.stackrestore``' Intrinsic
11109 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11116 declare void @llvm.stackrestore(i8* %ptr)
11121 The '``llvm.stackrestore``' intrinsic is used to restore the state of
11122 the function stack to the state it was in when the corresponding
11123 :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` intrinsic executed. This is
11124 useful for implementing language features like scoped automatic variable
11125 sized arrays in C99.
11130 See the description for :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>`.
11132 .. _int_get_dynamic_area_offset:
11134 '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset``' Intrinsic
11135 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11142 declare i32 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i32()
11143 declare i64 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i64()
11148 The '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.*``' intrinsic family is used to
11149 get the offset from native stack pointer to the address of the most
11150 recent dynamic alloca on the caller's stack. These intrinsics are
11151 intendend for use in combination with
11152 :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` to get a
11153 pointer to the most recent dynamic alloca. This is useful, for example,
11154 for AddressSanitizer's stack unpoisoning routines.
11159 These intrinsics return a non-negative integer value that can be used to
11160 get the address of the most recent dynamic alloca, allocated by :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>`
11161 on the caller's stack. In particular, for targets where stack grows downwards,
11162 adding this offset to the native stack pointer would get the address of the most
11163 recent dynamic alloca. For targets where stack grows upwards, the situation is a bit more
11164 complicated, because subtracting this value from stack pointer would get the address
11165 one past the end of the most recent dynamic alloca.
11167 Although for most targets `llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
11168 returns just a zero, for others, such as PowerPC and PowerPC64, it returns a
11169 compile-time-known constant value.
11171 The return value type of :ref:`llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
11172 must match the target's default address space's (address space 0) pointer type.
11174 '``llvm.prefetch``' Intrinsic
11175 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11182 declare void @llvm.prefetch(i8* <address>, i32 <rw>, i32 <locality>, i32 <cache type>)
11187 The '``llvm.prefetch``' intrinsic is a hint to the code generator to
11188 insert a prefetch instruction if supported; otherwise, it is a noop.
11189 Prefetches have no effect on the behavior of the program but can change
11190 its performance characteristics.
11195 ``address`` is the address to be prefetched, ``rw`` is the specifier
11196 determining if the fetch should be for a read (0) or write (1), and
11197 ``locality`` is a temporal locality specifier ranging from (0) - no
11198 locality, to (3) - extremely local keep in cache. The ``cache type``
11199 specifies whether the prefetch is performed on the data (1) or
11200 instruction (0) cache. The ``rw``, ``locality`` and ``cache type``
11201 arguments must be constant integers.
11206 This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. In
11207 particular, prefetches cannot trap and do not produce a value. On
11208 targets that support this intrinsic, the prefetch can provide hints to
11209 the processor cache for better performance.
11211 '``llvm.pcmarker``' Intrinsic
11212 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11219 declare void @llvm.pcmarker(i32 <id>)
11224 The '``llvm.pcmarker``' intrinsic is a method to export a Program
11225 Counter (PC) in a region of code to simulators and other tools. The
11226 method is target specific, but it is expected that the marker will use
11227 exported symbols to transmit the PC of the marker. The marker makes no
11228 guarantees that it will remain with any specific instruction after
11229 optimizations. It is possible that the presence of a marker will inhibit
11230 optimizations. The intended use is to be inserted after optimizations to
11231 allow correlations of simulation runs.
11236 ``id`` is a numerical id identifying the marker.
11241 This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. Backends
11242 that do not support this intrinsic may ignore it.
11244 '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' Intrinsic
11245 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11252 declare i64 @llvm.readcyclecounter()
11257 The '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' intrinsic provides access to the cycle
11258 counter register (or similar low latency, high accuracy clocks) on those
11259 targets that support it. On X86, it should map to RDTSC. On Alpha, it
11260 should map to RPCC. As the backing counters overflow quickly (on the
11261 order of 9 seconds on alpha), this should only be used for small
11267 When directly supported, reading the cycle counter should not modify any
11268 memory. Implementations are allowed to either return a application
11269 specific value or a system wide value. On backends without support, this
11270 is lowered to a constant 0.
11272 Note that runtime support may be conditional on the privilege-level code is
11273 running at and the host platform.
11275 '``llvm.clear_cache``' Intrinsic
11276 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11283 declare void @llvm.clear_cache(i8*, i8*)
11288 The '``llvm.clear_cache``' intrinsic ensures visibility of modifications
11289 in the specified range to the execution unit of the processor. On
11290 targets with non-unified instruction and data cache, the implementation
11291 flushes the instruction cache.
11296 On platforms with coherent instruction and data caches (e.g. x86), this
11297 intrinsic is a nop. On platforms with non-coherent instruction and data
11298 cache (e.g. ARM, MIPS), the intrinsic is lowered either to appropriate
11299 instructions or a system call, if cache flushing requires special
11302 The default behavior is to emit a call to ``__clear_cache`` from the run
11305 This instrinsic does *not* empty the instruction pipeline. Modifications
11306 of the current function are outside the scope of the intrinsic.
11308 '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' Intrinsic
11309 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11316 declare void @llvm.instrprof.increment(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
11317 i32 <num-counters>, i32 <index>)
11322 The '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
11323 frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. These will be
11324 lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate execution counts of a
11325 program at runtime.
11330 The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
11331 name of the entity being instrumented. This should generally be the
11332 (mangled) function name for a set of counters.
11334 The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
11335 of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source, and
11336 the third is the number of counters associated with ``name``. It is an
11337 error if ``hash`` or ``num-counters`` differ between two instances of
11338 ``instrprof.increment`` that refer to the same name.
11340 The last argument refers to which of the counters for ``name`` should
11341 be incremented. It should be a value between 0 and ``num-counters``.
11346 This intrinsic represents an increment of a profiling counter. It will
11347 cause the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate the appropriate data
11348 structures and the code to increment the appropriate value, in a
11349 format that can be written out by a compiler runtime and consumed via
11350 the ``llvm-profdata`` tool.
11352 '``llvm.instrprof.increment.step``' Intrinsic
11353 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11360 declare void @llvm.instrprof.increment.step(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
11361 i32 <num-counters>,
11362 i32 <index>, i64 <step>)
11367 The '``llvm.instrprof.increment.step``' intrinsic is an extension to
11368 the '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' intrinsic with an additional fifth
11369 argument to specify the step of the increment.
11373 The first four arguments are the same as '``llvm.instrprof.increment``'
11376 The last argument specifies the value of the increment of the counter variable.
11380 See description of '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' instrinsic.
11383 '``llvm.instrprof.value.profile``' Intrinsic
11384 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11391 declare void @llvm.instrprof.value.profile(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
11392 i64 <value>, i32 <value_kind>,
11398 The '``llvm.instrprof.value.profile``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
11399 frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. This will be
11400 lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to find out the target values,
11401 instrumented expressions take in a program at runtime.
11406 The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
11407 name of the entity being instrumented. ``name`` should generally be the
11408 (mangled) function name for a set of counters.
11410 The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
11411 of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source. It
11412 is an error if ``hash`` differs between two instances of
11413 ``llvm.instrprof.*`` that refer to the same name.
11415 The third argument is the value of the expression being profiled. The profiled
11416 expression's value should be representable as an unsigned 64-bit value. The
11417 fourth argument represents the kind of value profiling that is being done. The
11418 supported value profiling kinds are enumerated through the
11419 ``InstrProfValueKind`` type declared in the
11420 ``<include/llvm/ProfileData/InstrProf.h>`` header file. The last argument is the
11421 index of the instrumented expression within ``name``. It should be >= 0.
11426 This intrinsic represents the point where a call to a runtime routine
11427 should be inserted for value profiling of target expressions. ``-instrprof``
11428 pass will generate the appropriate data structures and replace the
11429 ``llvm.instrprof.value.profile`` intrinsic with the call to the profile
11430 runtime library with proper arguments.
11432 '``llvm.thread.pointer``' Intrinsic
11433 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11440 declare i8* @llvm.thread.pointer()
11445 The '``llvm.thread.pointer``' intrinsic returns the value of the thread
11451 The '``llvm.thread.pointer``' intrinsic returns a pointer to the TLS area
11452 for the current thread. The exact semantics of this value are target
11453 specific: it may point to the start of TLS area, to the end, or somewhere
11454 in the middle. Depending on the target, this intrinsic may read a register,
11455 call a helper function, read from an alternate memory space, or perform
11456 other operations necessary to locate the TLS area. Not all targets support
11459 Standard C Library Intrinsics
11460 -----------------------------
11462 LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important standard C library
11463 functions. These intrinsics allow source-language front-ends to pass
11464 information about the alignment of the pointer arguments to the code
11465 generator, providing opportunity for more efficient code generation.
11469 '``llvm.memcpy``' Intrinsic
11470 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11475 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memcpy`` on any
11476 integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
11477 support all bit widths however.
11481 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
11482 i32 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11483 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
11484 i64 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11489 The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
11490 source location to the destination location.
11492 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memcpy.*``
11493 intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra isvolatile
11494 arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
11499 The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
11500 pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
11501 specifying the number of bytes to copy, and the fourth is a
11502 boolean indicating a volatile access.
11504 The :ref:`align <attr_align>` parameter attribute can be provided
11505 for the first and second arguments.
11507 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memcpy`` call is
11508 a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
11509 very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
11514 The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
11515 source location to the destination location, which are not allowed to
11516 overlap. It copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known
11517 to be aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as an attribute on
11520 If "len" is 0, the pointers may be NULL or dangling. However, they must still
11521 be appropriately aligned.
11525 '``llvm.memmove``' Intrinsic
11526 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11531 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memmove on any integer
11532 bit width and for different address space. Not all targets support all
11533 bit widths however.
11537 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
11538 i32 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11539 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
11540 i64 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11545 The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics move a block of memory from the
11546 source location to the destination location. It is similar to the
11547 '``llvm.memcpy``' intrinsic but allows the two memory locations to
11550 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memmove.*``
11551 intrinsics do not return a value, takes an extra isvolatile
11552 argument and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
11557 The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
11558 pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
11559 specifying the number of bytes to copy, and the fourth is a
11560 boolean indicating a volatile access.
11562 The :ref:`align <attr_align>` parameter attribute can be provided
11563 for the first and second arguments.
11565 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memmove`` call
11566 is a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is
11567 not very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
11572 The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
11573 source location to the destination location, which may overlap. It
11574 copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known to be
11575 aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as an attribute on
11578 If "len" is 0, the pointers may be NULL or dangling. However, they must still
11579 be appropriately aligned.
11583 '``llvm.memset.*``' Intrinsics
11584 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11589 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memset on any integer
11590 bit width and for different address spaces. However, not all targets
11591 support all bit widths.
11595 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
11596 i32 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11597 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
11598 i64 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11603 The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill a block of memory with a
11604 particular byte value.
11606 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memset``
11607 intrinsic does not return a value and takes an extra volatile
11608 argument. Also, the destination can be in an arbitrary address space.
11613 The first argument is a pointer to the destination to fill, the second
11614 is the byte value with which to fill it, the third argument is an
11615 integer argument specifying the number of bytes to fill, and the fourth
11616 is a boolean indicating a volatile access.
11618 The :ref:`align <attr_align>` parameter attribute can be provided
11619 for the first arguments.
11621 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memset`` call is
11622 a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
11623 very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
11628 The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill "len" bytes of memory starting
11629 at the destination location. If the argument is known to be
11630 aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as an attribute on
11633 If "len" is 0, the pointers may be NULL or dangling. However, they must still
11634 be appropriately aligned.
11636 '``llvm.sqrt.*``' Intrinsic
11637 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11642 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sqrt`` on any
11643 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11648 declare float @llvm.sqrt.f32(float %Val)
11649 declare double @llvm.sqrt.f64(double %Val)
11650 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sqrt.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11651 declare fp128 @llvm.sqrt.f128(fp128 %Val)
11652 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sqrt.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11657 The '``llvm.sqrt``' intrinsics return the square root of the specified value.
11662 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11667 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``sqrt``' function but without
11668 trapping or setting ``errno``. For types specified by IEEE-754, the result
11669 matches a conforming libm implementation.
11671 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11672 using a less accurate calculation.
11674 '``llvm.powi.*``' Intrinsic
11675 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11680 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.powi`` on any
11681 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11686 declare float @llvm.powi.f32(float %Val, i32 %power)
11687 declare double @llvm.powi.f64(double %Val, i32 %power)
11688 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.powi.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, i32 %power)
11689 declare fp128 @llvm.powi.f128(fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
11690 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.powi.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
11695 The '``llvm.powi.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
11696 specified (positive or negative) power. The order of evaluation of
11697 multiplications is not defined. When a vector of floating-point type is
11698 used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.
11703 The second argument is an integer power, and the first is a value to
11704 raise to that power.
11709 This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an
11710 unspecified sequence of rounding operations.
11712 '``llvm.sin.*``' Intrinsic
11713 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11718 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sin`` on any
11719 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11724 declare float @llvm.sin.f32(float %Val)
11725 declare double @llvm.sin.f64(double %Val)
11726 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sin.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11727 declare fp128 @llvm.sin.f128(fp128 %Val)
11728 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sin.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11733 The '``llvm.sin.*``' intrinsics return the sine of the operand.
11738 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11743 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``sin``' function but without
11744 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11746 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11747 using a less accurate calculation.
11749 '``llvm.cos.*``' Intrinsic
11750 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11755 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cos`` on any
11756 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11761 declare float @llvm.cos.f32(float %Val)
11762 declare double @llvm.cos.f64(double %Val)
11763 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.cos.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11764 declare fp128 @llvm.cos.f128(fp128 %Val)
11765 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.cos.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11770 The '``llvm.cos.*``' intrinsics return the cosine of the operand.
11775 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11780 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``cos``' function but without
11781 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11783 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11784 using a less accurate calculation.
11786 '``llvm.pow.*``' Intrinsic
11787 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11792 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.pow`` on any
11793 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11798 declare float @llvm.pow.f32(float %Val, float %Power)
11799 declare double @llvm.pow.f64(double %Val, double %Power)
11800 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.pow.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, x86_fp80 %Power)
11801 declare fp128 @llvm.pow.f128(fp128 %Val, fp128 %Power)
11802 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.pow.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, ppc_fp128 Power)
11807 The '``llvm.pow.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
11808 specified (positive or negative) power.
11813 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11818 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``pow``' function but without
11819 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11821 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11822 using a less accurate calculation.
11824 '``llvm.exp.*``' Intrinsic
11825 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11830 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp`` on any
11831 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11836 declare float @llvm.exp.f32(float %Val)
11837 declare double @llvm.exp.f64(double %Val)
11838 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11839 declare fp128 @llvm.exp.f128(fp128 %Val)
11840 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11845 The '``llvm.exp.*``' intrinsics compute the base-e exponential of the specified
11851 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11856 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``exp``' function but without
11857 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11859 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11860 using a less accurate calculation.
11862 '``llvm.exp2.*``' Intrinsic
11863 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11868 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp2`` on any
11869 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11874 declare float @llvm.exp2.f32(float %Val)
11875 declare double @llvm.exp2.f64(double %Val)
11876 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11877 declare fp128 @llvm.exp2.f128(fp128 %Val)
11878 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11883 The '``llvm.exp2.*``' intrinsics compute the base-2 exponential of the
11889 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11894 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``exp2``' function but without
11895 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11897 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11898 using a less accurate calculation.
11900 '``llvm.log.*``' Intrinsic
11901 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11906 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log`` on any
11907 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11912 declare float @llvm.log.f32(float %Val)
11913 declare double @llvm.log.f64(double %Val)
11914 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11915 declare fp128 @llvm.log.f128(fp128 %Val)
11916 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11921 The '``llvm.log.*``' intrinsics compute the base-e logarithm of the specified
11927 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11932 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``log``' function but without
11933 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11935 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11936 using a less accurate calculation.
11938 '``llvm.log10.*``' Intrinsic
11939 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11944 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log10`` on any
11945 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11950 declare float @llvm.log10.f32(float %Val)
11951 declare double @llvm.log10.f64(double %Val)
11952 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log10.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11953 declare fp128 @llvm.log10.f128(fp128 %Val)
11954 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log10.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11959 The '``llvm.log10.*``' intrinsics compute the base-10 logarithm of the
11965 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11970 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``log10``' function but without
11971 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11973 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11974 using a less accurate calculation.
11976 '``llvm.log2.*``' Intrinsic
11977 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11982 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log2`` on any
11983 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11988 declare float @llvm.log2.f32(float %Val)
11989 declare double @llvm.log2.f64(double %Val)
11990 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11991 declare fp128 @llvm.log2.f128(fp128 %Val)
11992 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11997 The '``llvm.log2.*``' intrinsics compute the base-2 logarithm of the specified
12003 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
12008 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``log2``' function but without
12009 trapping or setting ``errno``.
12011 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
12012 using a less accurate calculation.
12014 '``llvm.fma.*``' Intrinsic
12015 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12020 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fma`` on any
12021 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12026 declare float @llvm.fma.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
12027 declare double @llvm.fma.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
12028 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fma.f80(x86_fp80 %a, x86_fp80 %b, x86_fp80 %c)
12029 declare fp128 @llvm.fma.f128(fp128 %a, fp128 %b, fp128 %c)
12030 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fma.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %a, ppc_fp128 %b, ppc_fp128 %c)
12035 The '``llvm.fma.*``' intrinsics perform the fused multiply-add operation.
12040 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
12045 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``fma``' function but without
12046 trapping or setting ``errno``.
12048 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
12049 using a less accurate calculation.
12051 '``llvm.fabs.*``' Intrinsic
12052 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12057 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fabs`` on any
12058 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12063 declare float @llvm.fabs.f32(float %Val)
12064 declare double @llvm.fabs.f64(double %Val)
12065 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fabs.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12066 declare fp128 @llvm.fabs.f128(fp128 %Val)
12067 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fabs.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12072 The '``llvm.fabs.*``' intrinsics return the absolute value of the
12078 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12084 This function returns the same values as the libm ``fabs`` functions
12085 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12087 '``llvm.minnum.*``' Intrinsic
12088 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12093 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.minnum`` on any
12094 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12099 declare float @llvm.minnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
12100 declare double @llvm.minnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
12101 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.minnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
12102 declare fp128 @llvm.minnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
12103 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.minnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
12108 The '``llvm.minnum.*``' intrinsics return the minimum of the two
12115 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12121 Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for minNum, except for handling of
12122 signaling NaNs. This match's the behavior of libm's fmin.
12124 If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
12125 NaN only if both operands are NaN. The returned NaN is always
12126 quiet. If the operands compare equal, returns a value that compares
12127 equal to both operands. This means that fmin(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could
12128 return either -0.0 or 0.0.
12130 Unlike the IEEE-754 2008 behavior, this does not distinguish between
12131 signaling and quiet NaN inputs. If a target's implementation follows
12132 the standard and returns a quiet NaN if either input is a signaling
12133 NaN, the intrinsic lowering is responsible for quieting the inputs to
12134 correctly return the non-NaN input (e.g. by using the equivalent of
12135 ``llvm.canonicalize``).
12138 '``llvm.maxnum.*``' Intrinsic
12139 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12144 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.maxnum`` on any
12145 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12150 declare float @llvm.maxnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1l)
12151 declare double @llvm.maxnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
12152 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.maxnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
12153 declare fp128 @llvm.maxnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
12154 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.maxnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
12159 The '``llvm.maxnum.*``' intrinsics return the maximum of the two
12166 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12171 Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for maxNum except for the handling of
12172 signaling NaNs. This matches the behavior of libm's fmax.
12174 If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
12175 NaN only if both operands are NaN. The returned NaN is always
12176 quiet. If the operands compare equal, returns a value that compares
12177 equal to both operands. This means that fmax(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could
12178 return either -0.0 or 0.0.
12180 Unlike the IEEE-754 2008 behavior, this does not distinguish between
12181 signaling and quiet NaN inputs. If a target's implementation follows
12182 the standard and returns a quiet NaN if either input is a signaling
12183 NaN, the intrinsic lowering is responsible for quieting the inputs to
12184 correctly return the non-NaN input (e.g. by using the equivalent of
12185 ``llvm.canonicalize``).
12187 '``llvm.minimum.*``' Intrinsic
12188 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12193 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.minimum`` on any
12194 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12199 declare float @llvm.minimum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
12200 declare double @llvm.minimum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
12201 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.minimum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
12202 declare fp128 @llvm.minimum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
12203 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.minimum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
12208 The '``llvm.minimum.*``' intrinsics return the minimum of the two
12209 arguments, propagating NaNs and treating -0.0 as less than +0.0.
12215 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12220 If either operand is a NaN, returns NaN. Otherwise returns the lesser
12221 of the two arguments. -0.0 is considered to be less than +0.0 for this
12222 intrinsic. Note that these are the semantics specified in the draft of
12225 '``llvm.maximum.*``' Intrinsic
12226 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12231 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.maximum`` on any
12232 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12237 declare float @llvm.maximum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
12238 declare double @llvm.maximum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
12239 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.maximum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
12240 declare fp128 @llvm.maximum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
12241 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.maximum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
12246 The '``llvm.maximum.*``' intrinsics return the maximum of the two
12247 arguments, propagating NaNs and treating -0.0 as less than +0.0.
12253 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12258 If either operand is a NaN, returns NaN. Otherwise returns the greater
12259 of the two arguments. -0.0 is considered to be less than +0.0 for this
12260 intrinsic. Note that these are the semantics specified in the draft of
12263 '``llvm.copysign.*``' Intrinsic
12264 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12269 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.copysign`` on any
12270 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12275 declare float @llvm.copysign.f32(float %Mag, float %Sgn)
12276 declare double @llvm.copysign.f64(double %Mag, double %Sgn)
12277 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.copysign.f80(x86_fp80 %Mag, x86_fp80 %Sgn)
12278 declare fp128 @llvm.copysign.f128(fp128 %Mag, fp128 %Sgn)
12279 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.copysign.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Mag, ppc_fp128 %Sgn)
12284 The '``llvm.copysign.*``' intrinsics return a value with the magnitude of the
12285 first operand and the sign of the second operand.
12290 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12296 This function returns the same values as the libm ``copysign``
12297 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12299 '``llvm.floor.*``' Intrinsic
12300 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12305 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.floor`` on any
12306 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12311 declare float @llvm.floor.f32(float %Val)
12312 declare double @llvm.floor.f64(double %Val)
12313 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.floor.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12314 declare fp128 @llvm.floor.f128(fp128 %Val)
12315 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.floor.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12320 The '``llvm.floor.*``' intrinsics return the floor of the operand.
12325 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12331 This function returns the same values as the libm ``floor`` functions
12332 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12334 '``llvm.ceil.*``' Intrinsic
12335 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12340 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ceil`` on any
12341 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12346 declare float @llvm.ceil.f32(float %Val)
12347 declare double @llvm.ceil.f64(double %Val)
12348 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.ceil.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12349 declare fp128 @llvm.ceil.f128(fp128 %Val)
12350 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.ceil.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12355 The '``llvm.ceil.*``' intrinsics return the ceiling of the operand.
12360 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12366 This function returns the same values as the libm ``ceil`` functions
12367 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12369 '``llvm.trunc.*``' Intrinsic
12370 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12375 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.trunc`` on any
12376 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12381 declare float @llvm.trunc.f32(float %Val)
12382 declare double @llvm.trunc.f64(double %Val)
12383 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.trunc.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12384 declare fp128 @llvm.trunc.f128(fp128 %Val)
12385 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.trunc.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12390 The '``llvm.trunc.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12391 nearest integer not larger in magnitude than the operand.
12396 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12402 This function returns the same values as the libm ``trunc`` functions
12403 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12405 '``llvm.rint.*``' Intrinsic
12406 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12411 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.rint`` on any
12412 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12417 declare float @llvm.rint.f32(float %Val)
12418 declare double @llvm.rint.f64(double %Val)
12419 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.rint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12420 declare fp128 @llvm.rint.f128(fp128 %Val)
12421 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.rint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12426 The '``llvm.rint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12427 nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point exception if the
12428 operand isn't an integer.
12433 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12439 This function returns the same values as the libm ``rint`` functions
12440 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12442 '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' Intrinsic
12443 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12448 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.nearbyint`` on any
12449 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12454 declare float @llvm.nearbyint.f32(float %Val)
12455 declare double @llvm.nearbyint.f64(double %Val)
12456 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.nearbyint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12457 declare fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.f128(fp128 %Val)
12458 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12463 The '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12469 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12475 This function returns the same values as the libm ``nearbyint``
12476 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12478 '``llvm.round.*``' Intrinsic
12479 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12484 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.round`` on any
12485 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12490 declare float @llvm.round.f32(float %Val)
12491 declare double @llvm.round.f64(double %Val)
12492 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.round.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12493 declare fp128 @llvm.round.f128(fp128 %Val)
12494 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.round.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12499 The '``llvm.round.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12505 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12511 This function returns the same values as the libm ``round``
12512 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12514 '``llvm.lround.*``' Intrinsic
12515 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12520 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.lround`` on any
12521 floating-point type. Not all targets support all types however.
12525 declare i32 @llvm.lround.i32.f32(float %Val)
12526 declare i32 @llvm.lround.i32.f64(double %Val)
12527 declare i32 @llvm.lround.i32.f80(float %Val)
12528 declare i32 @llvm.lround.i32.f128(double %Val)
12529 declare i32 @llvm.lround.i32.ppcf128(double %Val)
12531 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f32(float %Val)
12532 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f64(double %Val)
12533 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f80(float %Val)
12534 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f128(double %Val)
12535 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.ppcf128(double %Val)
12540 The '``llvm.lround.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12546 The argument is a floating-point number and return is an integer type.
12551 This function returns the same values as the libm ``lround``
12552 functions would, but without setting errno.
12554 '``llvm.llround.*``' Intrinsic
12555 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12560 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.llround`` on any
12561 floating-point type. Not all targets support all types however.
12565 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f32(float %Val)
12566 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f64(double %Val)
12567 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f80(float %Val)
12568 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f128(double %Val)
12569 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.ppcf128(double %Val)
12574 The '``llvm.llround.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12580 The argument is a floating-point number and return is an integer type.
12585 This function returns the same values as the libm ``llround``
12586 functions would, but without setting errno.
12588 '``llvm.lrint.*``' Intrinsic
12589 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12594 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.lrint`` on any
12595 floating-point type. Not all targets support all types however.
12599 declare i32 @llvm.lrint.i32.f32(float %Val)
12600 declare i32 @llvm.lrint.i32.f64(double %Val)
12601 declare i32 @llvm.lrint.i32.f80(float %Val)
12602 declare i32 @llvm.lrint.i32.f128(double %Val)
12603 declare i32 @llvm.lrint.i32.ppcf128(double %Val)
12605 declare i64 @llvm.lrint.i64.f32(float %Val)
12606 declare i64 @llvm.lrint.i64.f64(double %Val)
12607 declare i64 @llvm.lrint.i64.f80(float %Val)
12608 declare i64 @llvm.lrint.i64.f128(double %Val)
12609 declare i64 @llvm.lrint.i64.ppcf128(double %Val)
12614 The '``llvm.lrint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12620 The argument is a floating-point number and return is an integer type.
12625 This function returns the same values as the libm ``lrint``
12626 functions would, but without setting errno.
12628 '``llvm.llrint.*``' Intrinsic
12629 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12634 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.llrint`` on any
12635 floating-point type. Not all targets support all types however.
12639 declare i64 @llvm.llrint.i64.f32(float %Val)
12640 declare i64 @llvm.llrint.i64.f64(double %Val)
12641 declare i64 @llvm.llrint.i64.f80(float %Val)
12642 declare i64 @llvm.llrint.i64.f128(double %Val)
12643 declare i64 @llvm.llrint.i64.ppcf128(double %Val)
12648 The '``llvm.llrint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12654 The argument is a floating-point number and return is an integer type.
12659 This function returns the same values as the libm ``llrint``
12660 functions would, but without setting errno.
12662 Bit Manipulation Intrinsics
12663 ---------------------------
12665 LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important bit manipulation
12666 operations. These allow efficient code generation for some algorithms.
12668 '``llvm.bitreverse.*``' Intrinsics
12669 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12674 This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bitreverse on any
12679 declare i16 @llvm.bitreverse.i16(i16 <id>)
12680 declare i32 @llvm.bitreverse.i32(i32 <id>)
12681 declare i64 @llvm.bitreverse.i64(i64 <id>)
12682 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.bitreverse.v4i32(<4 x i32> <id>)
12687 The '``llvm.bitreverse``' family of intrinsics is used to reverse the
12688 bitpattern of an integer value or vector of integer values; for example
12689 ``0b10110110`` becomes ``0b01101101``.
12694 The ``llvm.bitreverse.iN`` intrinsic returns an iN value that has bit
12695 ``M`` in the input moved to bit ``N-M`` in the output. The vector
12696 intrinsics, such as ``llvm.bitreverse.v4i32``, operate on a per-element
12697 basis and the element order is not affected.
12699 '``llvm.bswap.*``' Intrinsics
12700 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12705 This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bswap on any
12706 integer type that is an even number of bytes (i.e. BitWidth % 16 == 0).
12710 declare i16 @llvm.bswap.i16(i16 <id>)
12711 declare i32 @llvm.bswap.i32(i32 <id>)
12712 declare i64 @llvm.bswap.i64(i64 <id>)
12713 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.bswap.v4i32(<4 x i32> <id>)
12718 The '``llvm.bswap``' family of intrinsics is used to byte swap an integer
12719 value or vector of integer values with an even number of bytes (positive
12720 multiple of 16 bits).
12725 The ``llvm.bswap.i16`` intrinsic returns an i16 value that has the high
12726 and low byte of the input i16 swapped. Similarly, the ``llvm.bswap.i32``
12727 intrinsic returns an i32 value that has the four bytes of the input i32
12728 swapped, so that if the input bytes are numbered 0, 1, 2, 3 then the
12729 returned i32 will have its bytes in 3, 2, 1, 0 order. The
12730 ``llvm.bswap.i48``, ``llvm.bswap.i64`` and other intrinsics extend this
12731 concept to additional even-byte lengths (6 bytes, 8 bytes and more,
12732 respectively). The vector intrinsics, such as ``llvm.bswap.v4i32``,
12733 operate on a per-element basis and the element order is not affected.
12735 '``llvm.ctpop.*``' Intrinsic
12736 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12741 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.ctpop on any integer
12742 bit width, or on any vector with integer elements. Not all targets
12743 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12747 declare i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 <src>)
12748 declare i16 @llvm.ctpop.i16(i16 <src>)
12749 declare i32 @llvm.ctpop.i32(i32 <src>)
12750 declare i64 @llvm.ctpop.i64(i64 <src>)
12751 declare i256 @llvm.ctpop.i256(i256 <src>)
12752 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctpop.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>)
12757 The '``llvm.ctpop``' family of intrinsics counts the number of bits set
12763 The only argument is the value to be counted. The argument may be of any
12764 integer type, or a vector with integer elements. The return type must
12765 match the argument type.
12770 The '``llvm.ctpop``' intrinsic counts the 1's in a variable, or within
12771 each element of a vector.
12773 '``llvm.ctlz.*``' Intrinsic
12774 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12779 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ctlz`` on any
12780 integer bit width, or any vector whose elements are integers. Not all
12781 targets support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12785 declare i8 @llvm.ctlz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12786 declare i16 @llvm.ctlz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12787 declare i32 @llvm.ctlz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12788 declare i64 @llvm.ctlz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12789 declare i256 @llvm.ctlz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12790 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctlz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12795 The '``llvm.ctlz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
12796 leading zeros in a variable.
12801 The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
12802 any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
12803 type must match the first argument type.
12805 The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
12806 the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
12807 defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
12808 defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
12809 now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
12814 The '``llvm.ctlz``' intrinsic counts the leading (most significant)
12815 zeros in a variable, or within each element of the vector. If
12816 ``src == 0`` then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src``
12817 if ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
12818 ``llvm.ctlz(i32 2) = 30``.
12820 '``llvm.cttz.*``' Intrinsic
12821 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12826 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cttz`` on any
12827 integer bit width, or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
12828 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12832 declare i8 @llvm.cttz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12833 declare i16 @llvm.cttz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12834 declare i32 @llvm.cttz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12835 declare i64 @llvm.cttz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12836 declare i256 @llvm.cttz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12837 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.cttz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12842 The '``llvm.cttz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
12848 The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
12849 any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
12850 type must match the first argument type.
12852 The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
12853 the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
12854 defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
12855 defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
12856 now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
12861 The '``llvm.cttz``' intrinsic counts the trailing (least significant)
12862 zeros in a variable, or within each element of a vector. If ``src == 0``
12863 then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src`` if
12864 ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
12865 ``llvm.cttz(2) = 1``.
12869 '``llvm.fshl.*``' Intrinsic
12870 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12875 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fshl`` on any
12876 integer bit width or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
12877 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12881 declare i8 @llvm.fshl.i8 (i8 %a, i8 %b, i8 %c)
12882 declare i67 @llvm.fshl.i67(i67 %a, i67 %b, i67 %c)
12883 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.fshl.v2i32(<2 x i32> %a, <2 x i32> %b, <2 x i32> %c)
12888 The '``llvm.fshl``' family of intrinsic functions performs a funnel shift left:
12889 the first two values are concatenated as { %a : %b } (%a is the most significant
12890 bits of the wide value), the combined value is shifted left, and the most
12891 significant bits are extracted to produce a result that is the same size as the
12892 original arguments. If the first 2 arguments are identical, this is equivalent
12893 to a rotate left operation. For vector types, the operation occurs for each
12894 element of the vector. The shift argument is treated as an unsigned amount
12895 modulo the element size of the arguments.
12900 The first two arguments are the values to be concatenated. The third
12901 argument is the shift amount. The arguments may be any integer type or a
12902 vector with integer element type. All arguments and the return value must
12903 have the same type.
12908 .. code-block:: text
12910 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 %x, i8 %y, i8 %z) ; %r = i8: msb_extract((concat(x, y) << (z % 8)), 8)
12911 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 255, i8 0, i8 15) ; %r = i8: 128 (0b10000000)
12912 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 15, i8 15, i8 11) ; %r = i8: 120 (0b01111000)
12913 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 0, i8 255, i8 8) ; %r = i8: 0 (0b00000000)
12915 '``llvm.fshr.*``' Intrinsic
12916 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12921 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fshr`` on any
12922 integer bit width or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
12923 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12927 declare i8 @llvm.fshr.i8 (i8 %a, i8 %b, i8 %c)
12928 declare i67 @llvm.fshr.i67(i67 %a, i67 %b, i67 %c)
12929 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.fshr.v2i32(<2 x i32> %a, <2 x i32> %b, <2 x i32> %c)
12934 The '``llvm.fshr``' family of intrinsic functions performs a funnel shift right:
12935 the first two values are concatenated as { %a : %b } (%a is the most significant
12936 bits of the wide value), the combined value is shifted right, and the least
12937 significant bits are extracted to produce a result that is the same size as the
12938 original arguments. If the first 2 arguments are identical, this is equivalent
12939 to a rotate right operation. For vector types, the operation occurs for each
12940 element of the vector. The shift argument is treated as an unsigned amount
12941 modulo the element size of the arguments.
12946 The first two arguments are the values to be concatenated. The third
12947 argument is the shift amount. The arguments may be any integer type or a
12948 vector with integer element type. All arguments and the return value must
12949 have the same type.
12954 .. code-block:: text
12956 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 %x, i8 %y, i8 %z) ; %r = i8: lsb_extract((concat(x, y) >> (z % 8)), 8)
12957 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 255, i8 0, i8 15) ; %r = i8: 254 (0b11111110)
12958 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 15, i8 15, i8 11) ; %r = i8: 225 (0b11100001)
12959 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 0, i8 255, i8 8) ; %r = i8: 255 (0b11111111)
12961 Arithmetic with Overflow Intrinsics
12962 -----------------------------------
12964 LLVM provides intrinsics for fast arithmetic overflow checking.
12966 Each of these intrinsics returns a two-element struct. The first
12967 element of this struct contains the result of the corresponding
12968 arithmetic operation modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
12969 the result. Therefore, for example, the first element of the struct
12970 returned by ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32`` is always the same as the
12971 result of a 32-bit ``add`` instruction with the same operands, where
12972 the ``add`` is *not* modified by an ``nsw`` or ``nuw`` flag.
12974 The second element of the result is an ``i1`` that is 1 if the
12975 arithmetic operation overflowed and 0 otherwise. An operation
12976 overflows if, for any values of its operands ``A`` and ``B`` and for
12977 any ``N`` larger than the operands' width, ``ext(A op B) to iN`` is
12978 not equal to ``(ext(A) to iN) op (ext(B) to iN)`` where ``ext`` is
12979 ``sext`` for signed overflow and ``zext`` for unsigned overflow, and
12980 ``op`` is the underlying arithmetic operation.
12982 The behavior of these intrinsics is well-defined for all argument
12985 '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12986 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12991 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``
12992 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
12996 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12997 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12998 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12999 declare {<4 x i32>, <4 x i1>} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13004 The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13005 a signed addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether an overflow
13006 occurred during the signed summation.
13011 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
13012 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
13013 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
13014 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
13020 The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13021 a signed addition of the two variables. They return a structure --- the
13022 first element of which is the signed summation, and the second element
13023 of which is a bit specifying if the signed summation resulted in an
13029 .. code-block:: llvm
13031 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13032 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
13033 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
13034 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
13036 '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
13037 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13042 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``
13043 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13047 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13048 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13049 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13050 declare {<4 x i32>, <4 x i1>} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13055 The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13056 an unsigned addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether a carry
13057 occurred during the unsigned summation.
13062 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
13063 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
13064 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
13065 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
13071 The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13072 an unsigned addition of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
13073 first element of which is the sum, and the second element of which is a
13074 bit specifying if the unsigned summation resulted in a carry.
13079 .. code-block:: llvm
13081 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13082 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
13083 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
13084 br i1 %obit, label %carry, label %normal
13086 '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
13087 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13092 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``
13093 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13097 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13098 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13099 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13100 declare {<4 x i32>, <4 x i1>} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13105 The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13106 a signed subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
13107 overflow occurred during the signed subtraction.
13112 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
13113 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
13114 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
13115 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
13121 The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13122 a signed subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
13123 first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
13124 which is a bit specifying if the signed subtraction resulted in an
13130 .. code-block:: llvm
13132 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13133 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
13134 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
13135 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
13137 '``llvm.usub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
13138 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13143 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.usub.with.overflow``
13144 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13148 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13149 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13150 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13151 declare {<4 x i32>, <4 x i1>} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13156 The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13157 an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
13158 overflow occurred during the unsigned subtraction.
13163 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
13164 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
13165 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
13166 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
13172 The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13173 an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
13174 the first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
13175 which is a bit specifying if the unsigned subtraction resulted in an
13181 .. code-block:: llvm
13183 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13184 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
13185 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
13186 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
13188 '``llvm.smul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
13189 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13194 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.smul.with.overflow``
13195 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13199 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13200 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13201 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13202 declare {<4 x i32>, <4 x i1>} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13207 The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13208 a signed multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
13209 overflow occurred during the signed multiplication.
13214 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
13215 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
13216 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
13217 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
13223 The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13224 a signed multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
13225 the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second element
13226 of which is a bit specifying if the signed multiplication resulted in an
13232 .. code-block:: llvm
13234 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13235 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
13236 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
13237 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
13239 '``llvm.umul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
13240 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13245 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.umul.with.overflow``
13246 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13250 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13251 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13252 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13253 declare {<4 x i32>, <4 x i1>} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13258 The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13259 a unsigned multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
13260 overflow occurred during the unsigned multiplication.
13265 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
13266 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
13267 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
13268 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
13274 The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13275 an unsigned multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
13276 the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second
13277 element of which is a bit specifying if the unsigned multiplication
13278 resulted in an overflow.
13283 .. code-block:: llvm
13285 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13286 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
13287 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
13288 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
13290 Saturation Arithmetic Intrinsics
13291 ---------------------------------
13293 Saturation arithmetic is a version of arithmetic in which operations are
13294 limited to a fixed range between a minimum and maximum value. If the result of
13295 an operation is greater than the maximum value, the result is set (or
13296 "clamped") to this maximum. If it is below the minimum, it is clamped to this
13300 '``llvm.sadd.sat.*``' Intrinsics
13301 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13306 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sadd.sat``
13307 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13311 declare i16 @llvm.sadd.sat.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13312 declare i32 @llvm.sadd.sat.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13313 declare i64 @llvm.sadd.sat.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13314 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.sadd.sat.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13319 The '``llvm.sadd.sat``' family of intrinsic functions perform signed
13320 saturation addition on the 2 arguments.
13325 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13326 width, but they must have the same bit width. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13327 values that will undergo signed addition.
13332 The maximum value this operation can clamp to is the largest signed value
13333 representable by the bit width of the arguments. The minimum value is the
13334 smallest signed value representable by this bit width.
13340 .. code-block:: llvm
13342 %res = call i4 @llvm.sadd.sat.i4(i4 1, i4 2) ; %res = 3
13343 %res = call i4 @llvm.sadd.sat.i4(i4 5, i4 6) ; %res = 7
13344 %res = call i4 @llvm.sadd.sat.i4(i4 -4, i4 2) ; %res = -2
13345 %res = call i4 @llvm.sadd.sat.i4(i4 -4, i4 -5) ; %res = -8
13348 '``llvm.uadd.sat.*``' Intrinsics
13349 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13354 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.uadd.sat``
13355 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13359 declare i16 @llvm.uadd.sat.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13360 declare i32 @llvm.uadd.sat.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13361 declare i64 @llvm.uadd.sat.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13362 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.uadd.sat.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13367 The '``llvm.uadd.sat``' family of intrinsic functions perform unsigned
13368 saturation addition on the 2 arguments.
13373 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13374 width, but they must have the same bit width. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13375 values that will undergo unsigned addition.
13380 The maximum value this operation can clamp to is the largest unsigned value
13381 representable by the bit width of the arguments. Because this is an unsigned
13382 operation, the result will never saturate towards zero.
13388 .. code-block:: llvm
13390 %res = call i4 @llvm.uadd.sat.i4(i4 1, i4 2) ; %res = 3
13391 %res = call i4 @llvm.uadd.sat.i4(i4 5, i4 6) ; %res = 11
13392 %res = call i4 @llvm.uadd.sat.i4(i4 8, i4 8) ; %res = 15
13395 '``llvm.ssub.sat.*``' Intrinsics
13396 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13401 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ssub.sat``
13402 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13406 declare i16 @llvm.ssub.sat.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13407 declare i32 @llvm.ssub.sat.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13408 declare i64 @llvm.ssub.sat.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13409 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.ssub.sat.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13414 The '``llvm.ssub.sat``' family of intrinsic functions perform signed
13415 saturation subtraction on the 2 arguments.
13420 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13421 width, but they must have the same bit width. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13422 values that will undergo signed subtraction.
13427 The maximum value this operation can clamp to is the largest signed value
13428 representable by the bit width of the arguments. The minimum value is the
13429 smallest signed value representable by this bit width.
13435 .. code-block:: llvm
13437 %res = call i4 @llvm.ssub.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 1) ; %res = 1
13438 %res = call i4 @llvm.ssub.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 6) ; %res = -4
13439 %res = call i4 @llvm.ssub.sat.i4(i4 -4, i4 5) ; %res = -8
13440 %res = call i4 @llvm.ssub.sat.i4(i4 4, i4 -5) ; %res = 7
13443 '``llvm.usub.sat.*``' Intrinsics
13444 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13449 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.usub.sat``
13450 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13454 declare i16 @llvm.usub.sat.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13455 declare i32 @llvm.usub.sat.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13456 declare i64 @llvm.usub.sat.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13457 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.usub.sat.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13462 The '``llvm.usub.sat``' family of intrinsic functions perform unsigned
13463 saturation subtraction on the 2 arguments.
13468 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13469 width, but they must have the same bit width. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13470 values that will undergo unsigned subtraction.
13475 The minimum value this operation can clamp to is 0, which is the smallest
13476 unsigned value representable by the bit width of the unsigned arguments.
13477 Because this is an unsigned operation, the result will never saturate towards
13478 the largest possible value representable by this bit width.
13484 .. code-block:: llvm
13486 %res = call i4 @llvm.usub.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 1) ; %res = 1
13487 %res = call i4 @llvm.usub.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 6) ; %res = 0
13490 Fixed Point Arithmetic Intrinsics
13491 ---------------------------------
13493 A fixed point number represents a real data type for a number that has a fixed
13494 number of digits after a radix point (equivalent to the decimal point '.').
13495 The number of digits after the radix point is referred as the ``scale``. These
13496 are useful for representing fractional values to a specific precision. The
13497 following intrinsics perform fixed point arithmetic operations on 2 operands
13498 of the same scale, specified as the third argument.
13500 The `llvm.*mul.fix` family of intrinsic functions represents a multiplication
13501 of fixed point numbers through scaled integers. Therefore, fixed point
13502 multplication can be represented as
13505 %result = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.i4(i4 %a, i4 %b, i32 %scale)
13508 %a2 = sext i4 %a to i8
13509 %b2 = sext i4 %b to i8
13510 %mul = mul nsw nuw i8 %a, %b
13511 %scale2 = trunc i32 %scale to i8
13512 %r = ashr i8 %mul, i8 %scale2 ; this is for a target rounding down towards negative infinity
13513 %result = trunc i8 %r to i4
13515 For each of these functions, if the result cannot be represented exactly with
13516 the provided scale, the result is rounded. Rounding is unspecified since
13517 preferred rounding may vary for different targets. Rounding is specified
13518 through a target hook. Different pipelines should legalize or optimize this
13519 using the rounding specified by this hook if it is provided. Operations like
13520 constant folding, instruction combining, KnownBits, and ValueTracking should
13521 also use this hook, if provided, and not assume the direction of rounding. A
13522 rounded result must always be within one unit of precision from the true
13523 result. That is, the error between the returned result and the true result must
13524 be less than 1/2^(scale).
13527 '``llvm.smul.fix.*``' Intrinsics
13528 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13533 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.smul.fix``
13534 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13538 declare i16 @llvm.smul.fix.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b, i32 %scale)
13539 declare i32 @llvm.smul.fix.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b, i32 %scale)
13540 declare i64 @llvm.smul.fix.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b, i32 %scale)
13541 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.smul.fix.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b, i32 %scale)
13546 The '``llvm.smul.fix``' family of intrinsic functions perform signed
13547 fixed point multiplication on 2 arguments of the same scale.
13552 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13553 width, but they must have the same bit width. The arguments may also work with
13554 int vectors of the same length and int size. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13555 values that will undergo signed fixed point multiplication. The argument
13556 ``%scale`` represents the scale of both operands, and must be a constant
13562 This operation performs fixed point multiplication on the 2 arguments of a
13563 specified scale. The result will also be returned in the same scale specified
13564 in the third argument.
13566 If the result value cannot be precisely represented in the given scale, the
13567 value is rounded up or down to the closest representable value. The rounding
13568 direction is unspecified.
13570 It is undefined behavior if the result value does not fit within the range of
13571 the fixed point type.
13577 .. code-block:: llvm
13579 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 0) ; %res = 6 (2 x 3 = 6)
13580 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 1) ; %res = 3 (1.5 x 1 = 1.5)
13581 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 -2, i32 1) ; %res = -3 (1.5 x -1 = -1.5)
13583 ; The result in the following could be rounded up to -2 or down to -2.5
13584 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 -3, i32 1) ; %res = -5 (or -4) (1.5 x -1.5 = -2.25)
13587 '``llvm.umul.fix.*``' Intrinsics
13588 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13593 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.umul.fix``
13594 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13598 declare i16 @llvm.umul.fix.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b, i32 %scale)
13599 declare i32 @llvm.umul.fix.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b, i32 %scale)
13600 declare i64 @llvm.umul.fix.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b, i32 %scale)
13601 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.umul.fix.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b, i32 %scale)
13606 The '``llvm.umul.fix``' family of intrinsic functions perform unsigned
13607 fixed point multiplication on 2 arguments of the same scale.
13612 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13613 width, but they must have the same bit width. The arguments may also work with
13614 int vectors of the same length and int size. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13615 values that will undergo unsigned fixed point multiplication. The argument
13616 ``%scale`` represents the scale of both operands, and must be a constant
13622 This operation performs unsigned fixed point multiplication on the 2 arguments of a
13623 specified scale. The result will also be returned in the same scale specified
13624 in the third argument.
13626 If the result value cannot be precisely represented in the given scale, the
13627 value is rounded up or down to the closest representable value. The rounding
13628 direction is unspecified.
13630 It is undefined behavior if the result value does not fit within the range of
13631 the fixed point type.
13637 .. code-block:: llvm
13639 %res = call i4 @llvm.umul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 0) ; %res = 6 (2 x 3 = 6)
13640 %res = call i4 @llvm.umul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 1) ; %res = 3 (1.5 x 1 = 1.5)
13642 ; The result in the following could be rounded down to 3.5 or up to 4
13643 %res = call i4 @llvm.umul.fix.i4(i4 15, i4 1, i32 1) ; %res = 7 (or 8) (7.5 x 0.5 = 3.75)
13646 '``llvm.smul.fix.sat.*``' Intrinsics
13647 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13652 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.smul.fix.sat``
13653 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13657 declare i16 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b, i32 %scale)
13658 declare i32 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b, i32 %scale)
13659 declare i64 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b, i32 %scale)
13660 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.smul.fix.sat.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b, i32 %scale)
13665 The '``llvm.smul.fix.sat``' family of intrinsic functions perform signed
13666 fixed point saturation multiplication on 2 arguments of the same scale.
13671 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13672 width, but they must have the same bit width. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13673 values that will undergo signed fixed point multiplication. The argument
13674 ``%scale`` represents the scale of both operands, and must be a constant
13680 This operation performs fixed point multiplication on the 2 arguments of a
13681 specified scale. The result will also be returned in the same scale specified
13682 in the third argument.
13684 If the result value cannot be precisely represented in the given scale, the
13685 value is rounded up or down to the closest representable value. The rounding
13686 direction is unspecified.
13688 The maximum value this operation can clamp to is the largest signed value
13689 representable by the bit width of the first 2 arguments. The minimum value is the
13690 smallest signed value representable by this bit width.
13696 .. code-block:: llvm
13698 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 0) ; %res = 6 (2 x 3 = 6)
13699 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 1) ; %res = 3 (1.5 x 1 = 1.5)
13700 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 3, i4 -2, i32 1) ; %res = -3 (1.5 x -1 = -1.5)
13702 ; The result in the following could be rounded up to -2 or down to -2.5
13703 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 3, i4 -3, i32 1) ; %res = -5 (or -4) (1.5 x -1.5 = -2.25)
13706 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 7, i4 2, i32 0) ; %res = 7
13707 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 7, i4 2, i32 2) ; %res = 7
13708 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 -8, i4 2, i32 2) ; %res = -8
13709 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 -8, i4 -2, i32 2) ; %res = 7
13711 ; Scale can affect the saturation result
13712 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 4, i32 0) ; %res = 7 (2 x 4 -> clamped to 7)
13713 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 4, i32 1) ; %res = 4 (1 x 2 = 2)
13716 Specialised Arithmetic Intrinsics
13717 ---------------------------------
13719 '``llvm.canonicalize.*``' Intrinsic
13720 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13727 declare float @llvm.canonicalize.f32(float %a)
13728 declare double @llvm.canonicalize.f64(double %b)
13733 The '``llvm.canonicalize.*``' intrinsic returns the platform specific canonical
13734 encoding of a floating-point number. This canonicalization is useful for
13735 implementing certain numeric primitives such as frexp. The canonical encoding is
13736 defined by IEEE-754-2008 to be:
13740 2.1.8 canonical encoding: The preferred encoding of a floating-point
13741 representation in a format. Applied to declets, significands of finite
13742 numbers, infinities, and NaNs, especially in decimal formats.
13744 This operation can also be considered equivalent to the IEEE-754-2008
13745 conversion of a floating-point value to the same format. NaNs are handled
13746 according to section 6.2.
13748 Examples of non-canonical encodings:
13750 - x87 pseudo denormals, pseudo NaNs, pseudo Infinity, Unnormals. These are
13751 converted to a canonical representation per hardware-specific protocol.
13752 - Many normal decimal floating-point numbers have non-canonical alternative
13754 - Some machines, like GPUs or ARMv7 NEON, do not support subnormal values.
13755 These are treated as non-canonical encodings of zero and will be flushed to
13756 a zero of the same sign by this operation.
13758 Note that per IEEE-754-2008 6.2, systems that support signaling NaNs with
13759 default exception handling must signal an invalid exception, and produce a
13762 This function should always be implementable as multiplication by 1.0, provided
13763 that the compiler does not constant fold the operation. Likewise, division by
13764 1.0 and ``llvm.minnum(x, x)`` are possible implementations. Addition with
13765 -0.0 is also sufficient provided that the rounding mode is not -Infinity.
13767 ``@llvm.canonicalize`` must preserve the equality relation. That is:
13769 - ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == x)`` is equivalent to ``(x == x)``
13770 - ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == @llvm.canonicalize(y))`` is equivalent to
13773 Additionally, the sign of zero must be conserved:
13774 ``@llvm.canonicalize(-0.0) = -0.0`` and ``@llvm.canonicalize(+0.0) = +0.0``
13776 The payload bits of a NaN must be conserved, with two exceptions.
13777 First, environments which use only a single canonical representation of NaN
13778 must perform said canonicalization. Second, SNaNs must be quieted per the
13781 The canonicalization operation may be optimized away if:
13783 - The input is known to be canonical. For example, it was produced by a
13784 floating-point operation that is required by the standard to be canonical.
13785 - The result is consumed only by (or fused with) other floating-point
13786 operations. That is, the bits of the floating-point value are not examined.
13788 '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' Intrinsic
13789 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13796 declare float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
13797 declare double @llvm.fmuladd.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
13802 The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsic functions represent multiply-add
13803 expressions that can be fused if the code generator determines that (a) the
13804 target instruction set has support for a fused operation, and (b) that the
13805 fused operation is more efficient than the equivalent, separate pair of mul
13806 and add instructions.
13811 The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsics each take three arguments: two
13812 multiplicands, a and b, and an addend c.
13821 %0 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(%a, %b, %c)
13823 is equivalent to the expression a \* b + c, except that rounding will
13824 not be performed between the multiplication and addition steps if the
13825 code generator fuses the operations. Fusion is not guaranteed, even if
13826 the target platform supports it. If a fused multiply-add is required the
13827 corresponding llvm.fma.\* intrinsic function should be used
13828 instead. This never sets errno, just as '``llvm.fma.*``'.
13833 .. code-block:: llvm
13835 %r2 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c) ; yields float:r2 = (a * b) + c
13838 Experimental Vector Reduction Intrinsics
13839 ----------------------------------------
13841 Horizontal reductions of vectors can be expressed using the following
13842 intrinsics. Each one takes a vector operand as an input and applies its
13843 respective operation across all elements of the vector, returning a single
13844 scalar result of the same element type.
13847 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.*``' Intrinsic
13848 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13855 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13856 declare i64 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.v2i64(<2 x i64> %a)
13861 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.*``' intrinsics do an integer ``ADD``
13862 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
13863 the element-type of the vector input.
13867 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13869 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.v2.fadd.*``' Intrinsic
13870 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13877 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.v2.fadd.f32.v4f32(float %start_value, <4 x float> %a)
13878 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.v2.fadd.f64.v2f64(double %start_value, <2 x double> %a)
13883 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.v2.fadd.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
13884 ``ADD`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
13885 matches the element-type of the vector input.
13887 If the intrinsic call has the 'reassoc' or 'fast' flags set, then the
13888 reduction will not preserve the associativity of an equivalent scalarized
13889 counterpart. Otherwise the reduction will be *ordered*, thus implying that
13890 the operation respects the associativity of a scalarized reduction.
13895 The first argument to this intrinsic is a scalar start value for the reduction.
13896 The type of the start value matches the element-type of the vector input.
13897 The second argument must be a vector of floating-point values.
13904 %unord = call reassoc float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.v2.fadd.f32.v4f32(float 0.0, <4 x float> %input) ; unordered reduction
13905 %ord = call float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.v2.fadd.f32.v4f32(float %start_value, <4 x float> %input) ; ordered reduction
13908 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.*``' Intrinsic
13909 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13916 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13917 declare i64 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.v2i64(<2 x i64> %a)
13922 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.*``' intrinsics do an integer ``MUL``
13923 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
13924 the element-type of the vector input.
13928 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13930 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.v2.fmul.*``' Intrinsic
13931 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13938 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.v2.fmul.f32.v4f32(float %start_value, <4 x float> %a)
13939 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.v2.fmul.f64.v2f64(double %start_value, <2 x double> %a)
13944 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.v2.fmul.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
13945 ``MUL`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
13946 matches the element-type of the vector input.
13948 If the intrinsic call has the 'reassoc' or 'fast' flags set, then the
13949 reduction will not preserve the associativity of an equivalent scalarized
13950 counterpart. Otherwise the reduction will be *ordered*, thus implying that
13951 the operation respects the associativity of a scalarized reduction.
13956 The first argument to this intrinsic is a scalar start value for the reduction.
13957 The type of the start value matches the element-type of the vector input.
13958 The second argument must be a vector of floating-point values.
13965 %unord = call reassoc float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.v2.fmul.f32.v4f32(float 1.0, <4 x float> %input) ; unordered reduction
13966 %ord = call float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.v2.fmul.f32.v4f32(float %start_value, <4 x float> %input) ; ordered reduction
13968 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.and.*``' Intrinsic
13969 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13976 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.and.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13981 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.and.*``' intrinsics do a bitwise ``AND``
13982 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
13983 the element-type of the vector input.
13987 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13989 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.or.*``' Intrinsic
13990 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13997 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.or.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
14002 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.or.*``' intrinsics do a bitwise ``OR`` reduction
14003 of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches the
14004 element-type of the vector input.
14008 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
14010 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.xor.*``' Intrinsic
14011 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14018 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.xor.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
14023 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.xor.*``' intrinsics do a bitwise ``XOR``
14024 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
14025 the element-type of the vector input.
14029 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
14031 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smax.*``' Intrinsic
14032 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14039 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smax.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
14044 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smax.*``' intrinsics do a signed integer
14045 ``MAX`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
14046 matches the element-type of the vector input.
14050 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
14052 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smin.*``' Intrinsic
14053 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14060 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smin.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
14065 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smin.*``' intrinsics do a signed integer
14066 ``MIN`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
14067 matches the element-type of the vector input.
14071 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
14073 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umax.*``' Intrinsic
14074 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14081 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umax.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
14086 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umax.*``' intrinsics do an unsigned
14087 integer ``MAX`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The
14088 return type matches the element-type of the vector input.
14092 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
14094 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umin.*``' Intrinsic
14095 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14102 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umin.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
14107 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umin.*``' intrinsics do an unsigned
14108 integer ``MIN`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The
14109 return type matches the element-type of the vector input.
14113 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
14115 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.*``' Intrinsic
14116 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14123 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.v4f32(<4 x float> %a)
14124 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.v2f64(<2 x double> %a)
14129 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
14130 ``MAX`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
14131 matches the element-type of the vector input.
14133 If the intrinsic call has the ``nnan`` fast-math flag then the operation can
14134 assume that NaNs are not present in the input vector.
14138 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of floating-point values.
14140 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.*``' Intrinsic
14141 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14148 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.v4f32(<4 x float> %a)
14149 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.v2f64(<2 x double> %a)
14154 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
14155 ``MIN`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
14156 matches the element-type of the vector input.
14158 If the intrinsic call has the ``nnan`` fast-math flag then the operation can
14159 assume that NaNs are not present in the input vector.
14163 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of floating-point values.
14165 Half Precision Floating-Point Intrinsics
14166 ----------------------------------------
14168 For most target platforms, half precision floating-point is a
14169 storage-only format. This means that it is a dense encoding (in memory)
14170 but does not support computation in the format.
14172 This means that code must first load the half-precision floating-point
14173 value as an i16, then convert it to float with
14174 :ref:`llvm.convert.from.fp16 <int_convert_from_fp16>`. Computation can
14175 then be performed on the float value (including extending to double
14176 etc). To store the value back to memory, it is first converted to float
14177 if needed, then converted to i16 with
14178 :ref:`llvm.convert.to.fp16 <int_convert_to_fp16>`, then storing as an
14181 .. _int_convert_to_fp16:
14183 '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' Intrinsic
14184 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14191 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
14192 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f64(double %a)
14197 The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
14198 conventional floating-point type to half precision floating-point format.
14203 The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
14209 The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
14210 conventional floating-point format to half precision floating-point format. The
14211 return value is an ``i16`` which contains the converted number.
14216 .. code-block:: llvm
14218 %res = call i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
14219 store i16 %res, i16* @x, align 2
14221 .. _int_convert_from_fp16:
14223 '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' Intrinsic
14224 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14231 declare float @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f32(i16 %a)
14232 declare double @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f64(i16 %a)
14237 The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
14238 conversion from half precision floating-point format to single precision
14239 floating-point format.
14244 The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
14250 The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
14251 conversion from half single precision floating-point format to single
14252 precision floating-point format. The input half-float value is
14253 represented by an ``i16`` value.
14258 .. code-block:: llvm
14260 %a = load i16, i16* @x, align 2
14261 %res = call float @llvm.convert.from.fp16(i16 %a)
14263 .. _dbg_intrinsics:
14265 Debugger Intrinsics
14266 -------------------
14268 The LLVM debugger intrinsics (which all start with ``llvm.dbg.``
14269 prefix), are described in the `LLVM Source Level
14270 Debugging <SourceLevelDebugging.html#format-common-intrinsics>`_
14273 Exception Handling Intrinsics
14274 -----------------------------
14276 The LLVM exception handling intrinsics (which all start with
14277 ``llvm.eh.`` prefix), are described in the `LLVM Exception
14278 Handling <ExceptionHandling.html#format-common-intrinsics>`_ document.
14280 .. _int_trampoline:
14282 Trampoline Intrinsics
14283 ---------------------
14285 These intrinsics make it possible to excise one parameter, marked with
14286 the :ref:`nest <nest>` attribute, from a function. The result is a
14287 callable function pointer lacking the nest parameter - the caller does
14288 not need to provide a value for it. Instead, the value to use is stored
14289 in advance in a "trampoline", a block of memory usually allocated on the
14290 stack, which also contains code to splice the nest value into the
14291 argument list. This is used to implement the GCC nested function address
14294 For example, if the function is ``i32 f(i8* nest %c, i32 %x, i32 %y)``
14295 then the resulting function pointer has signature ``i32 (i32, i32)*``.
14296 It can be created as follows:
14298 .. code-block:: llvm
14300 %tramp = alloca [10 x i8], align 4 ; size and alignment only correct for X86
14301 %tramp1 = getelementptr [10 x i8], [10 x i8]* %tramp, i32 0, i32 0
14302 call i8* @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* %tramp1, i8* bitcast (i32 (i8*, i32, i32)* @f to i8*), i8* %nval)
14303 %p = call i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* %tramp1)
14304 %fp = bitcast i8* %p to i32 (i32, i32)*
14306 The call ``%val = call i32 %fp(i32 %x, i32 %y)`` is then equivalent to
14307 ``%val = call i32 %f(i8* %nval, i32 %x, i32 %y)``.
14311 '``llvm.init.trampoline``' Intrinsic
14312 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14319 declare void @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* <tramp>, i8* <func>, i8* <nval>)
14324 This fills the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` with executable code,
14325 turning it into a trampoline.
14330 The ``llvm.init.trampoline`` intrinsic takes three arguments, all
14331 pointers. The ``tramp`` argument must point to a sufficiently large and
14332 sufficiently aligned block of memory; this memory is written to by the
14333 intrinsic. Note that the size and the alignment are target-specific -
14334 LLVM currently provides no portable way of determining them, so a
14335 front-end that generates this intrinsic needs to have some
14336 target-specific knowledge. The ``func`` argument must hold a function
14337 bitcast to an ``i8*``.
14342 The block of memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is filled with target
14343 dependent code, turning it into a function. Then ``tramp`` needs to be
14344 passed to :ref:`llvm.adjust.trampoline <int_at>` to get a pointer which can
14345 be :ref:`bitcast (to a new function) and called <int_trampoline>`. The new
14346 function's signature is the same as that of ``func`` with any arguments
14347 marked with the ``nest`` attribute removed. At most one such ``nest``
14348 argument is allowed, and it must be of pointer type. Calling the new
14349 function is equivalent to calling ``func`` with the same argument list,
14350 but with ``nval`` used for the missing ``nest`` argument. If, after
14351 calling ``llvm.init.trampoline``, the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is
14352 modified, then the effect of any later call to the returned function
14353 pointer is undefined.
14357 '``llvm.adjust.trampoline``' Intrinsic
14358 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14365 declare i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* <tramp>)
14370 This performs any required machine-specific adjustment to the address of
14371 a trampoline (passed as ``tramp``).
14376 ``tramp`` must point to a block of memory which already has trampoline
14377 code filled in by a previous call to
14378 :ref:`llvm.init.trampoline <int_it>`.
14383 On some architectures the address of the code to be executed needs to be
14384 different than the address where the trampoline is actually stored. This
14385 intrinsic returns the executable address corresponding to ``tramp``
14386 after performing the required machine specific adjustments. The pointer
14387 returned can then be :ref:`bitcast and executed <int_trampoline>`.
14389 .. _int_mload_mstore:
14391 Masked Vector Load and Store Intrinsics
14392 ---------------------------------------
14394 LLVM provides intrinsics for predicated vector load and store operations. The predicate is specified by a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits of the mask are on, the intrinsic is identical to a regular vector load or store. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
14398 '``llvm.masked.load.*``' Intrinsics
14399 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14403 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data is a vector of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type.
14407 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
14408 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.load.v2f64.p0v2f64 (<2 x double>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
14409 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
14410 declare <8 x double*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f64.p0v8p0f64 (<8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x double*> <passthru>)
14411 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
14412 declare <8 x i32 ()*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f_i32f.p0v8p0f_i32f (<8 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x i32 ()*> <passthru>)
14417 Reads a vector from memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
14423 The first operand is the base pointer for the load. The second operand is the alignment of the source location. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the base pointer and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
14429 The '``llvm.masked.load``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked loads and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar load operations.
14430 The result of this operation is equivalent to a regular vector load instruction followed by a 'select' between the loaded and the passthru values, predicated on the same mask. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions on memory access to masked-off lanes.
14435 %res = call <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1>%mask, <16 x float> %passthru)
14437 ;; The result of the two following instructions is identical aside from potential memory access exception
14438 %loadlal = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
14439 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %loadlal, <16 x float> %passthru
14443 '``llvm.masked.store.*``' Intrinsics
14444 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14448 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type.
14452 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8i32.p0v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
14453 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
14454 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
14455 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8p0f64.p0v8p0f64 (<8 x double*> <value>, <8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
14456 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
14457 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v4p0f_i32f.p0v4p0f_i32f (<4 x i32 ()*> <value>, <4 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
14462 Writes a vector to memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
14467 The first operand is the vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is the base pointer for the store, it has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is the alignment of the destination location. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
14473 The '``llvm.masked.store``' intrinsics is designed for conditional writing of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked store and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
14474 The result of this operation is equivalent to a load-modify-store sequence. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions and data races on memory access to masked-off lanes.
14478 call void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32.p0v16f32(<16 x float> %value, <16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1> %mask)
14480 ;; The result of the following instructions is identical aside from potential data races and memory access exceptions
14481 %oldval = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
14482 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %value, <16 x float> %oldval
14483 store <16 x float> %res, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
14486 Masked Vector Gather and Scatter Intrinsics
14487 -------------------------------------------
14489 LLVM provides intrinsics for vector gather and scatter operations. They are similar to :ref:`Masked Vector Load and Store <int_mload_mstore>`, except they are designed for arbitrary memory accesses, rather than sequential memory accesses. Gather and scatter also employ a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
14493 '``llvm.masked.gather.*``' Intrinsics
14494 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14498 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data are multiple scalar values of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type gathered together into one vector.
14502 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.gather.v16f32.v16p0f32 (<16 x float*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
14503 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v2f64.v2p1f64 (<2 x double addrspace(1)*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
14504 declare <8 x float*> @llvm.masked.gather.v8p0f32.v8p0p0f32 (<8 x float**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x float*> <passthru>)
14509 Reads scalar values from arbitrary memory locations and gathers them into one vector. The memory locations are provided in the vector of pointers '``ptrs``'. The memory is accessed according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
14515 The first operand is a vector of pointers which holds all memory addresses to read. The second operand is an alignment of the source addresses. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the vector of pointers and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
14521 The '``llvm.masked.gather``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of multiple scalar values from arbitrary memory locations in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked gathers and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of scalar load operations.
14522 The semantics of this operation are equivalent to a sequence of conditional scalar loads with subsequent gathering all loaded values into a single vector. The mask restricts memory access to certain lanes and facilitates vectorization of predicated basic blocks.
14527 %res = call <4 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v4f64.v4p0f64 (<4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 8, <4 x i1> <i1 true, i1 true, i1 true, i1 true>, <4 x double> undef)
14529 ;; The gather with all-true mask is equivalent to the following instruction sequence
14530 %ptr0 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 0
14531 %ptr1 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 1
14532 %ptr2 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 2
14533 %ptr3 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 3
14535 %val0 = load double, double* %ptr0, align 8
14536 %val1 = load double, double* %ptr1, align 8
14537 %val2 = load double, double* %ptr2, align 8
14538 %val3 = load double, double* %ptr3, align 8
14540 %vec0 = insertelement <4 x double>undef, %val0, 0
14541 %vec01 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec0, %val1, 1
14542 %vec012 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec01, %val2, 2
14543 %vec0123 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec012, %val3, 3
14547 '``llvm.masked.scatter.*``' Intrinsics
14548 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14552 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type. Each vector element is stored in an arbitrary memory address. Scatter with overlapping addresses is guaranteed to be ordered from least-significant to most-significant element.
14556 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32.v8p0i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
14557 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v16f32.v16p1f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float addrspace(1)*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
14558 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v4p0f64.v4p0p0f64 (<4 x double*> <value>, <4 x double**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
14563 Writes each element from the value vector to the corresponding memory address. The memory addresses are represented as a vector of pointers. Writing is done according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
14568 The first operand is a vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is a vector of pointers, pointing to where the value elements should be stored. It has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is an alignment of the destination addresses. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
14574 The '``llvm.masked.scatter``' intrinsics is designed for writing selected vector elements to arbitrary memory addresses in a single IR operation. The operation may be conditional, when not all bits in the mask are switched on. It is useful for targets that support vector masked scatter and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
14578 ;; This instruction unconditionally stores data vector in multiple addresses
14579 call @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32.v8p0i32 (<8 x i32> %value, <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 4, <8 x i1> <true, true, .. true>)
14581 ;; It is equivalent to a list of scalar stores
14582 %val0 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 0
14583 %val1 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 1
14585 %val7 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 7
14586 %ptr0 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 0
14587 %ptr1 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 1
14589 %ptr7 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 7
14590 ;; Note: the order of the following stores is important when they overlap:
14591 store i32 %val0, i32* %ptr0, align 4
14592 store i32 %val1, i32* %ptr1, align 4
14594 store i32 %val7, i32* %ptr7, align 4
14597 Masked Vector Expanding Load and Compressing Store Intrinsics
14598 -------------------------------------------------------------
14600 LLVM provides intrinsics for expanding load and compressing store operations. Data selected from a vector according to a mask is stored in consecutive memory addresses (compressed store), and vice-versa (expanding load). These operations effective map to "if (cond.i) a[j++] = v.i" and "if (cond.i) v.i = a[j++]" patterns, respectively. Note that when the mask starts with '1' bits followed by '0' bits, these operations are identical to :ref:`llvm.masked.store <int_mstore>` and :ref:`llvm.masked.load <int_mload>`.
14602 .. _int_expandload:
14604 '``llvm.masked.expandload.*``' Intrinsics
14605 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14609 This is an overloaded intrinsic. Several values of integer, floating point or pointer data type are loaded from consecutive memory addresses and stored into the elements of a vector according to the mask.
14613 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.expandload.v16f32 (float* <ptr>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
14614 declare <2 x i64> @llvm.masked.expandload.v2i64 (i64* <ptr>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x i64> <passthru>)
14619 Reads a number of scalar values sequentially from memory location provided in '``ptr``' and spreads them in a vector. The '``mask``' holds a bit for each vector lane. The number of elements read from memory is equal to the number of '1' bits in the mask. The loaded elements are positioned in the destination vector according to the sequence of '1' and '0' bits in the mask. E.g., if the mask vector is '10010001', "explandload" reads 3 values from memory addresses ptr, ptr+1, ptr+2 and places them in lanes 0, 3 and 7 accordingly. The masked-off lanes are filled by elements from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
14625 The first operand is the base pointer for the load. It has the same underlying type as the element of the returned vector. The second operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The third is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type and the type of the '``passthru``' operand have the same vector type.
14630 The '``llvm.masked.expandload``' intrinsic is designed for reading multiple scalar values from adjacent memory addresses into possibly non-adjacent vector lanes. It is useful for targets that support vector expanding loads and allows vectorizing loop with cross-iteration dependency like in the following example:
14634 // In this loop we load from B and spread the elements into array A.
14635 double *A, B; int *C;
14636 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
14642 .. code-block:: llvm
14644 ; Load several elements from array B and expand them in a vector.
14645 ; The number of loaded elements is equal to the number of '1' elements in the Mask.
14646 %Tmp = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.expandload.v8f64(double* %Bptr, <8 x i1> %Mask, <8 x double> undef)
14647 ; Store the result in A
14648 call void @llvm.masked.store.v8f64.p0v8f64(<8 x double> %Tmp, <8 x double>* %Aptr, i32 8, <8 x i1> %Mask)
14650 ; %Bptr should be increased on each iteration according to the number of '1' elements in the Mask.
14651 %MaskI = bitcast <8 x i1> %Mask to i8
14652 %MaskIPopcnt = call i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %MaskI)
14653 %MaskI64 = zext i8 %MaskIPopcnt to i64
14654 %BNextInd = add i64 %BInd, %MaskI64
14657 Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example, by lowering it into a sequence of conditional scalar load operations and shuffles.
14658 If all mask elements are '1', the intrinsic behavior is equivalent to the regular unmasked vector load.
14660 .. _int_compressstore:
14662 '``llvm.masked.compressstore.*``' Intrinsics
14663 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14667 This is an overloaded intrinsic. A number of scalar values of integer, floating point or pointer data type are collected from an input vector and stored into adjacent memory addresses. A mask defines which elements to collect from the vector.
14671 declare void @llvm.masked.compressstore.v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, i32* <ptr>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
14672 declare void @llvm.masked.compressstore.v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, float* <ptr>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
14677 Selects elements from input vector '``value``' according to the '``mask``'. All selected elements are written into adjacent memory addresses starting at address '`ptr`', from lower to higher. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to select elements to be stored. The number of elements to be stored is equal to the number of active bits in the mask.
14682 The first operand is the input vector, from which elements are collected and written to memory. The second operand is the base pointer for the store, it has the same underlying type as the element of the input vector operand. The third operand is the mask, a vector of boolean values. The mask and the input vector must have the same number of vector elements.
14688 The '``llvm.masked.compressstore``' intrinsic is designed for compressing data in memory. It allows to collect elements from possibly non-adjacent lanes of a vector and store them contiguously in memory in one IR operation. It is useful for targets that support compressing store operations and allows vectorizing loops with cross-iteration dependences like in the following example:
14692 // In this loop we load elements from A and store them consecutively in B
14693 double *A, B; int *C;
14694 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
14700 .. code-block:: llvm
14702 ; Load elements from A.
14703 %Tmp = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.load.v8f64.p0v8f64(<8 x double>* %Aptr, i32 8, <8 x i1> %Mask, <8 x double> undef)
14704 ; Store all selected elements consecutively in array B
14705 call <void> @llvm.masked.compressstore.v8f64(<8 x double> %Tmp, double* %Bptr, <8 x i1> %Mask)
14707 ; %Bptr should be increased on each iteration according to the number of '1' elements in the Mask.
14708 %MaskI = bitcast <8 x i1> %Mask to i8
14709 %MaskIPopcnt = call i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %MaskI)
14710 %MaskI64 = zext i8 %MaskIPopcnt to i64
14711 %BNextInd = add i64 %BInd, %MaskI64
14714 Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example, by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
14720 This class of intrinsics provides information about the lifetime of
14721 memory objects and ranges where variables are immutable.
14725 '``llvm.lifetime.start``' Intrinsic
14726 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14733 declare void @llvm.lifetime.start(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
14738 The '``llvm.lifetime.start``' intrinsic specifies the start of a memory
14744 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
14745 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
14751 This intrinsic indicates that before this point in the code, the value
14752 of the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known
14753 to never be used and has an undefined value. A load from the pointer
14754 that precedes this intrinsic can be replaced with ``'undef'``.
14758 '``llvm.lifetime.end``' Intrinsic
14759 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14766 declare void @llvm.lifetime.end(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
14771 The '``llvm.lifetime.end``' intrinsic specifies the end of a memory
14777 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
14778 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
14784 This intrinsic indicates that after this point in the code, the value of
14785 the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known to
14786 never be used and has an undefined value. Any stores into the memory
14787 object following this intrinsic may be removed as dead.
14789 '``llvm.invariant.start``' Intrinsic
14790 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14794 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address space.
14798 declare {}* @llvm.invariant.start.p0i8(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
14803 The '``llvm.invariant.start``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of
14804 a memory object will not change.
14809 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
14810 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
14816 This intrinsic indicates that until an ``llvm.invariant.end`` that uses
14817 the return value, the referenced memory location is constant and
14820 '``llvm.invariant.end``' Intrinsic
14821 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14825 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address space.
14829 declare void @llvm.invariant.end.p0i8({}* <start>, i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
14834 The '``llvm.invariant.end``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of a
14835 memory object are mutable.
14840 The first argument is the matching ``llvm.invariant.start`` intrinsic.
14841 The second argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
14842 object, or -1 if it is variable sized and the third argument is a
14843 pointer to the object.
14848 This intrinsic indicates that the memory is mutable again.
14850 '``llvm.launder.invariant.group``' Intrinsic
14851 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14855 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address
14856 space. The returned pointer must belong to the same address space as the
14861 declare i8* @llvm.launder.invariant.group.p0i8(i8* <ptr>)
14866 The '``llvm.launder.invariant.group``' intrinsic can be used when an invariant
14867 established by ``invariant.group`` metadata no longer holds, to obtain a new
14868 pointer value that carries fresh invariant group information. It is an
14869 experimental intrinsic, which means that its semantics might change in the
14876 The ``llvm.launder.invariant.group`` takes only one argument, which is a pointer
14882 Returns another pointer that aliases its argument but which is considered different
14883 for the purposes of ``load``/``store`` ``invariant.group`` metadata.
14884 It does not read any accessible memory and the execution can be speculated.
14886 '``llvm.strip.invariant.group``' Intrinsic
14887 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14891 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address
14892 space. The returned pointer must belong to the same address space as the
14897 declare i8* @llvm.strip.invariant.group.p0i8(i8* <ptr>)
14902 The '``llvm.strip.invariant.group``' intrinsic can be used when an invariant
14903 established by ``invariant.group`` metadata no longer holds, to obtain a new pointer
14904 value that does not carry the invariant information. It is an experimental
14905 intrinsic, which means that its semantics might change in the future.
14911 The ``llvm.strip.invariant.group`` takes only one argument, which is a pointer
14917 Returns another pointer that aliases its argument but which has no associated
14918 ``invariant.group`` metadata.
14919 It does not read any memory and can be speculated.
14925 Constrained Floating-Point Intrinsics
14926 -------------------------------------
14928 These intrinsics are used to provide special handling of floating-point
14929 operations when specific rounding mode or floating-point exception behavior is
14930 required. By default, LLVM optimization passes assume that the rounding mode is
14931 round-to-nearest and that floating-point exceptions will not be monitored.
14932 Constrained FP intrinsics are used to support non-default rounding modes and
14933 accurately preserve exception behavior without compromising LLVM's ability to
14934 optimize FP code when the default behavior is used.
14936 Each of these intrinsics corresponds to a normal floating-point operation. The
14937 first two arguments and the return value are the same as the corresponding FP
14940 The third argument is a metadata argument specifying the rounding mode to be
14941 assumed. This argument must be one of the following strings:
14951 If this argument is "round.dynamic" optimization passes must assume that the
14952 rounding mode is unknown and may change at runtime. No transformations that
14953 depend on rounding mode may be performed in this case.
14955 The other possible values for the rounding mode argument correspond to the
14956 similarly named IEEE rounding modes. If the argument is any of these values
14957 optimization passes may perform transformations as long as they are consistent
14958 with the specified rounding mode.
14960 For example, 'x-0'->'x' is not a valid transformation if the rounding mode is
14961 "round.downward" or "round.dynamic" because if the value of 'x' is +0 then
14962 'x-0' should evaluate to '-0' when rounding downward. However, this
14963 transformation is legal for all other rounding modes.
14965 For values other than "round.dynamic" optimization passes may assume that the
14966 actual runtime rounding mode (as defined in a target-specific manner) matches
14967 the specified rounding mode, but this is not guaranteed. Using a specific
14968 non-dynamic rounding mode which does not match the actual rounding mode at
14969 runtime results in undefined behavior.
14971 The fourth argument to the constrained floating-point intrinsics specifies the
14972 required exception behavior. This argument must be one of the following
14981 If this argument is "fpexcept.ignore" optimization passes may assume that the
14982 exception status flags will not be read and that floating-point exceptions will
14983 be masked. This allows transformations to be performed that may change the
14984 exception semantics of the original code. For example, FP operations may be
14985 speculatively executed in this case whereas they must not be for either of the
14986 other possible values of this argument.
14988 If the exception behavior argument is "fpexcept.maytrap" optimization passes
14989 must avoid transformations that may raise exceptions that would not have been
14990 raised by the original code (such as speculatively executing FP operations), but
14991 passes are not required to preserve all exceptions that are implied by the
14992 original code. For example, exceptions may be potentially hidden by constant
14995 If the exception behavior argument is "fpexcept.strict" all transformations must
14996 strictly preserve the floating-point exception semantics of the original code.
14997 Any FP exception that would have been raised by the original code must be raised
14998 by the transformed code, and the transformed code must not raise any FP
14999 exceptions that would not have been raised by the original code. This is the
15000 exception behavior argument that will be used if the code being compiled reads
15001 the FP exception status flags, but this mode can also be used with code that
15002 unmasks FP exceptions.
15004 The number and order of floating-point exceptions is NOT guaranteed. For
15005 example, a series of FP operations that each may raise exceptions may be
15006 vectorized into a single instruction that raises each unique exception a single
15010 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd``' Intrinsic
15011 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15019 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
15020 metadata <rounding mode>,
15021 metadata <exception behavior>)
15026 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd``' intrinsic returns the sum of its
15033 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd``'
15034 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
15035 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
15037 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15038 behavior as described above.
15043 The value produced is the floating-point sum of the two value operands and has
15044 the same type as the operands.
15047 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub``' Intrinsic
15048 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15056 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
15057 metadata <rounding mode>,
15058 metadata <exception behavior>)
15063 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub``' intrinsic returns the difference
15064 of its two operands.
15070 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub``'
15071 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
15072 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
15074 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15075 behavior as described above.
15080 The value produced is the floating-point difference of the two value operands
15081 and has the same type as the operands.
15084 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul``' Intrinsic
15085 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15093 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
15094 metadata <rounding mode>,
15095 metadata <exception behavior>)
15100 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul``' intrinsic returns the product of
15107 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul``'
15108 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
15109 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
15111 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15112 behavior as described above.
15117 The value produced is the floating-point product of the two value operands and
15118 has the same type as the operands.
15121 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv``' Intrinsic
15122 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15130 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
15131 metadata <rounding mode>,
15132 metadata <exception behavior>)
15137 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv``' intrinsic returns the quotient of
15144 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv``'
15145 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
15146 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
15148 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15149 behavior as described above.
15154 The value produced is the floating-point quotient of the two value operands and
15155 has the same type as the operands.
15158 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.frem``' Intrinsic
15159 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15167 @llvm.experimental.constrained.frem(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
15168 metadata <rounding mode>,
15169 metadata <exception behavior>)
15174 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.frem``' intrinsic returns the remainder
15175 from the division of its two operands.
15181 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.frem``'
15182 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
15183 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
15185 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15186 behavior as described above. The rounding mode argument has no effect, since
15187 the result of frem is never rounded, but the argument is included for
15188 consistency with the other constrained floating-point intrinsics.
15193 The value produced is the floating-point remainder from the division of the two
15194 value operands and has the same type as the operands. The remainder has the
15195 same sign as the dividend.
15197 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fma``' Intrinsic
15198 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15206 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fma(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>, <type> <op3>,
15207 metadata <rounding mode>,
15208 metadata <exception behavior>)
15213 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fma``' intrinsic returns the result of a
15214 fused-multiply-add operation on its operands.
15219 The first three arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fma``'
15220 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector
15221 <t_vector>` of floating-point values. All arguments must have identical types.
15223 The fourth and fifth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception behavior
15224 as described above.
15229 The result produced is the product of the first two operands added to the third
15230 operand computed with infinite precision, and then rounded to the target
15233 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fptrunc``' Intrinsic
15234 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15242 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fptrunc(<type> <value>,
15243 metadata <rounding mode>,
15244 metadata <exception behavior>)
15249 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fptrunc``' intrinsic truncates ``value``
15255 The first argument to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fptrunc``'
15256 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector
15257 <t_vector>` of floating point values. This argument must be larger in size
15260 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15261 behavior as described above.
15266 The result produced is a floating point value truncated to be smaller in size
15269 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fpext``' Intrinsic
15270 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15278 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fpext(<type> <value>,
15279 metadata <exception behavior>)
15284 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fpext``' intrinsic extends a
15285 floating-point ``value`` to a larger floating-point value.
15290 The first argument to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fpext``'
15291 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector
15292 <t_vector>` of floating point values. This argument must be smaller in size
15295 The second argument specifies the exception behavior as described above.
15300 The result produced is a floating point value extended to be larger in size
15301 than the operand. All restrictions that apply to the fpext instruction also
15302 apply to this intrinsic.
15304 Constrained libm-equivalent Intrinsics
15305 --------------------------------------
15307 In addition to the basic floating-point operations for which constrained
15308 intrinsics are described above, there are constrained versions of various
15309 operations which provide equivalent behavior to a corresponding libm function.
15310 These intrinsics allow the precise behavior of these operations with respect to
15311 rounding mode and exception behavior to be controlled.
15313 As with the basic constrained floating-point intrinsics, the rounding mode
15314 and exception behavior arguments only control the behavior of the optimizer.
15315 They do not change the runtime floating-point environment.
15318 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sqrt``' Intrinsic
15319 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15327 @llvm.experimental.constrained.sqrt(<type> <op1>,
15328 metadata <rounding mode>,
15329 metadata <exception behavior>)
15334 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sqrt``' intrinsic returns the square root
15335 of the specified value, returning the same value as the libm '``sqrt``'
15336 functions would, but without setting ``errno``.
15341 The first argument and the return type are floating-point numbers of the same
15344 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15345 behavior as described above.
15350 This function returns the nonnegative square root of the specified value.
15351 If the value is less than negative zero, a floating-point exception occurs
15352 and the return value is architecture specific.
15355 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.pow``' Intrinsic
15356 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15364 @llvm.experimental.constrained.pow(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
15365 metadata <rounding mode>,
15366 metadata <exception behavior>)
15371 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.pow``' intrinsic returns the first operand
15372 raised to the (positive or negative) power specified by the second operand.
15377 The first two arguments and the return value are floating-point numbers of the
15378 same type. The second argument specifies the power to which the first argument
15381 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15382 behavior as described above.
15387 This function returns the first value raised to the second power,
15388 returning the same values as the libm ``pow`` functions would, and
15389 handles error conditions in the same way.
15392 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.powi``' Intrinsic
15393 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15401 @llvm.experimental.constrained.powi(<type> <op1>, i32 <op2>,
15402 metadata <rounding mode>,
15403 metadata <exception behavior>)
15408 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.powi``' intrinsic returns the first operand
15409 raised to the (positive or negative) power specified by the second operand. The
15410 order of evaluation of multiplications is not defined. When a vector of
15411 floating-point type is used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.
15417 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15418 type. The second argument is a 32-bit signed integer specifying the power to
15419 which the first argument should be raised.
15421 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15422 behavior as described above.
15427 This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an
15428 unspecified sequence of rounding operations.
15431 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sin``' Intrinsic
15432 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15440 @llvm.experimental.constrained.sin(<type> <op1>,
15441 metadata <rounding mode>,
15442 metadata <exception behavior>)
15447 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sin``' intrinsic returns the sine of the
15453 The first argument and the return type are floating-point numbers of the same
15456 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15457 behavior as described above.
15462 This function returns the sine of the specified operand, returning the
15463 same values as the libm ``sin`` functions would, and handles error
15464 conditions in the same way.
15467 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.cos``' Intrinsic
15468 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15476 @llvm.experimental.constrained.cos(<type> <op1>,
15477 metadata <rounding mode>,
15478 metadata <exception behavior>)
15483 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.cos``' intrinsic returns the cosine of the
15489 The first argument and the return type are floating-point numbers of the same
15492 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15493 behavior as described above.
15498 This function returns the cosine of the specified operand, returning the
15499 same values as the libm ``cos`` functions would, and handles error
15500 conditions in the same way.
15503 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp``' Intrinsic
15504 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15512 @llvm.experimental.constrained.exp(<type> <op1>,
15513 metadata <rounding mode>,
15514 metadata <exception behavior>)
15519 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp``' intrinsic computes the base-e
15520 exponential of the specified value.
15525 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15528 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15529 behavior as described above.
15534 This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp`` functions
15535 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
15538 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp2``' Intrinsic
15539 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15547 @llvm.experimental.constrained.exp2(<type> <op1>,
15548 metadata <rounding mode>,
15549 metadata <exception behavior>)
15554 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp2``' intrinsic computes the base-2
15555 exponential of the specified value.
15561 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15564 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15565 behavior as described above.
15570 This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp2`` functions
15571 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
15574 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log``' Intrinsic
15575 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15583 @llvm.experimental.constrained.log(<type> <op1>,
15584 metadata <rounding mode>,
15585 metadata <exception behavior>)
15590 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log``' intrinsic computes the base-e
15591 logarithm of the specified value.
15596 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15599 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15600 behavior as described above.
15606 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log`` functions
15607 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
15610 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log10``' Intrinsic
15611 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15619 @llvm.experimental.constrained.log10(<type> <op1>,
15620 metadata <rounding mode>,
15621 metadata <exception behavior>)
15626 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log10``' intrinsic computes the base-10
15627 logarithm of the specified value.
15632 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15635 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15636 behavior as described above.
15641 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log10`` functions
15642 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
15645 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log2``' Intrinsic
15646 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15654 @llvm.experimental.constrained.log2(<type> <op1>,
15655 metadata <rounding mode>,
15656 metadata <exception behavior>)
15661 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log2``' intrinsic computes the base-2
15662 logarithm of the specified value.
15667 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15670 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15671 behavior as described above.
15676 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log2`` functions
15677 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
15680 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.rint``' Intrinsic
15681 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15689 @llvm.experimental.constrained.rint(<type> <op1>,
15690 metadata <rounding mode>,
15691 metadata <exception behavior>)
15696 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.rint``' intrinsic returns the first
15697 operand rounded to the nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point
15698 exception if the operand is not an integer.
15703 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15706 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15707 behavior as described above.
15712 This function returns the same values as the libm ``rint`` functions
15713 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. The rounding mode is
15714 described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
15715 mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
15716 mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
15719 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.nearbyint``' Intrinsic
15720 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15728 @llvm.experimental.constrained.nearbyint(<type> <op1>,
15729 metadata <rounding mode>,
15730 metadata <exception behavior>)
15735 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.nearbyint``' intrinsic returns the first
15736 operand rounded to the nearest integer. It will not raise an inexact
15737 floating-point exception if the operand is not an integer.
15743 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15746 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15747 behavior as described above.
15752 This function returns the same values as the libm ``nearbyint`` functions
15753 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. The rounding mode is
15754 described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
15755 mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
15756 mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
15759 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.maxnum``' Intrinsic
15760 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15768 @llvm.experimental.constrained.maxnum(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>
15769 metadata <rounding mode>,
15770 metadata <exception behavior>)
15775 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.maxnum``' intrinsic returns the maximum
15776 of the two arguments.
15781 The first two arguments and the return value are floating-point numbers
15784 The third and forth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15785 behavior as described above.
15790 This function follows the IEEE-754 semantics for maxNum. The rounding mode is
15791 described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
15792 mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
15793 mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
15796 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.minnum``' Intrinsic
15797 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15805 @llvm.experimental.constrained.minnum(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>
15806 metadata <rounding mode>,
15807 metadata <exception behavior>)
15812 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.minnum``' intrinsic returns the minimum
15813 of the two arguments.
15818 The first two arguments and the return value are floating-point numbers
15821 The third and forth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15822 behavior as described above.
15827 This function follows the IEEE-754 semantics for minNum. The rounding mode is
15828 described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
15829 mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
15830 mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
15833 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.ceil``' Intrinsic
15834 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15842 @llvm.experimental.constrained.ceil(<type> <op1>,
15843 metadata <rounding mode>,
15844 metadata <exception behavior>)
15849 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.ceil``' intrinsic returns the ceiling of the
15855 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15858 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15859 behavior as described above. The rounding mode is currently unused for this
15865 This function returns the same values as the libm ``ceil`` functions
15866 would and handles error conditions in the same way.
15869 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.floor``' Intrinsic
15870 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15878 @llvm.experimental.constrained.floor(<type> <op1>,
15879 metadata <rounding mode>,
15880 metadata <exception behavior>)
15885 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.floor``' intrinsic returns the floor of the
15891 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15894 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15895 behavior as described above. The rounding mode is currently unused for this
15901 This function returns the same values as the libm ``floor`` functions
15902 would and handles error conditions in the same way.
15905 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.round``' Intrinsic
15906 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15914 @llvm.experimental.constrained.round(<type> <op1>,
15915 metadata <rounding mode>,
15916 metadata <exception behavior>)
15921 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.round``' intrinsic returns the first
15922 operand rounded to the nearest integer.
15927 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15930 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15931 behavior as described above. The rounding mode is currently unused for this
15937 This function returns the same values as the libm ``round`` functions
15938 would and handles error conditions in the same way.
15941 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.trunc``' Intrinsic
15942 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15950 @llvm.experimental.constrained.trunc(<type> <op1>,
15951 metadata <truncing mode>,
15952 metadata <exception behavior>)
15957 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.trunc``' intrinsic returns the first
15958 operand rounded to the nearest integer not larger in magnitude than the
15964 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15967 The second and third arguments specify the truncing mode and exception
15968 behavior as described above. The truncing mode is currently unused for this
15974 This function returns the same values as the libm ``trunc`` functions
15975 would and handles error conditions in the same way.
15981 This class of intrinsics is designed to be generic and has no specific
15984 '``llvm.var.annotation``' Intrinsic
15985 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15992 declare void @llvm.var.annotation(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15997 The '``llvm.var.annotation``' intrinsic.
16002 The first argument is a pointer to a value, the second is a pointer to a
16003 global string, the third is a pointer to a global string which is the
16004 source file name, and the last argument is the line number.
16009 This intrinsic allows annotation of local variables with arbitrary
16010 strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want
16011 to look for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are
16012 ignored by code generation and optimization.
16014 '``llvm.ptr.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
16015 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16020 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' on a
16021 pointer to an integer of any width. *NOTE* you must specify an address space for
16022 the pointer. The identifier for the default address space is the integer
16027 declare i8* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i8(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
16028 declare i16* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i16(i16* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
16029 declare i32* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i32(i32* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
16030 declare i64* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i64(i64* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
16031 declare i256* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i256(i256* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
16036 The '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' intrinsic.
16041 The first argument is a pointer to an integer value of arbitrary bitwidth
16042 (result of some expression), the second is a pointer to a global string, the
16043 third is a pointer to a global string which is the source file name, and the
16044 last argument is the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
16049 This intrinsic allows annotation of a pointer to an integer with arbitrary
16050 strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want to look
16051 for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are ignored by code
16052 generation and optimization.
16054 '``llvm.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
16055 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16060 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.annotation``' on
16061 any integer bit width.
16065 declare i8 @llvm.annotation.i8(i8 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
16066 declare i16 @llvm.annotation.i16(i16 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
16067 declare i32 @llvm.annotation.i32(i32 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
16068 declare i64 @llvm.annotation.i64(i64 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
16069 declare i256 @llvm.annotation.i256(i256 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
16074 The '``llvm.annotation``' intrinsic.
16079 The first argument is an integer value (result of some expression), the
16080 second is a pointer to a global string, the third is a pointer to a
16081 global string which is the source file name, and the last argument is
16082 the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
16087 This intrinsic allows annotations to be put on arbitrary expressions
16088 with arbitrary strings. This can be useful for special purpose
16089 optimizations that want to look for these annotations. These have no
16090 other defined use; they are ignored by code generation and optimization.
16092 '``llvm.codeview.annotation``' Intrinsic
16093 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16098 This annotation emits a label at its program point and an associated
16099 ``S_ANNOTATION`` codeview record with some additional string metadata. This is
16100 used to implement MSVC's ``__annotation`` intrinsic. It is marked
16101 ``noduplicate``, so calls to this intrinsic prevent inlining and should be
16102 considered expensive.
16106 declare void @llvm.codeview.annotation(metadata)
16111 The argument should be an MDTuple containing any number of MDStrings.
16113 '``llvm.trap``' Intrinsic
16114 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16121 declare void @llvm.trap() cold noreturn nounwind
16126 The '``llvm.trap``' intrinsic.
16136 This intrinsic is lowered to the target dependent trap instruction. If
16137 the target does not have a trap instruction, this intrinsic will be
16138 lowered to a call of the ``abort()`` function.
16140 '``llvm.debugtrap``' Intrinsic
16141 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16148 declare void @llvm.debugtrap() nounwind
16153 The '``llvm.debugtrap``' intrinsic.
16163 This intrinsic is lowered to code which is intended to cause an
16164 execution trap with the intention of requesting the attention of a
16167 '``llvm.stackprotector``' Intrinsic
16168 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16175 declare void @llvm.stackprotector(i8* <guard>, i8** <slot>)
16180 The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic takes the ``guard`` and stores it
16181 onto the stack at ``slot``. The stack slot is adjusted to ensure that it
16182 is placed on the stack before local variables.
16187 The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic requires two pointer arguments.
16188 The first argument is the value loaded from the stack guard
16189 ``@__stack_chk_guard``. The second variable is an ``alloca`` that has
16190 enough space to hold the value of the guard.
16195 This intrinsic causes the prologue/epilogue inserter to force the position of
16196 the ``AllocaInst`` stack slot to be before local variables on the stack. This is
16197 to ensure that if a local variable on the stack is overwritten, it will destroy
16198 the value of the guard. When the function exits, the guard on the stack is
16199 checked against the original guard by ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck``. If they are
16200 different, then ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` causes the program to abort by
16201 calling the ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function.
16203 '``llvm.stackguard``' Intrinsic
16204 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16211 declare i8* @llvm.stackguard()
16216 The ``llvm.stackguard`` intrinsic returns the system stack guard value.
16218 It should not be generated by frontends, since it is only for internal usage.
16219 The reason why we create this intrinsic is that we still support IR form Stack
16220 Protector in FastISel.
16230 On some platforms, the value returned by this intrinsic remains unchanged
16231 between loads in the same thread. On other platforms, it returns the same
16232 global variable value, if any, e.g. ``@__stack_chk_guard``.
16234 Currently some platforms have IR-level customized stack guard loading (e.g.
16235 X86 Linux) that is not handled by ``llvm.stackguard()``, while they should be
16238 '``llvm.objectsize``' Intrinsic
16239 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16246 declare i32 @llvm.objectsize.i32(i8* <object>, i1 <min>, i1 <nullunknown>, i1 <dynamic>)
16247 declare i64 @llvm.objectsize.i64(i8* <object>, i1 <min>, i1 <nullunknown>, i1 <dynamic>)
16252 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is designed to provide information to the
16253 optimizer to determine whether a) an operation (like memcpy) will overflow a
16254 buffer that corresponds to an object, or b) that a runtime check for overflow
16255 isn't necessary. An object in this context means an allocation of a specific
16256 class, structure, array, or other object.
16261 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic takes four arguments. The first argument is a
16262 pointer to or into the ``object``. The second argument determines whether
16263 ``llvm.objectsize`` returns 0 (if true) or -1 (if false) when the object size is
16264 unknown. The third argument controls how ``llvm.objectsize`` acts when ``null``
16265 in address space 0 is used as its pointer argument. If it's ``false``,
16266 ``llvm.objectsize`` reports 0 bytes available when given ``null``. Otherwise, if
16267 the ``null`` is in a non-zero address space or if ``true`` is given for the
16268 third argument of ``llvm.objectsize``, we assume its size is unknown. The fourth
16269 argument to ``llvm.objectsize`` determines if the value should be evaluated at
16272 The second, third, and fourth arguments only accept constants.
16277 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is lowered to a value representing the size of
16278 the object concerned. If the size cannot be determined, ``llvm.objectsize``
16279 returns ``i32/i64 -1 or 0`` (depending on the ``min`` argument).
16281 '``llvm.expect``' Intrinsic
16282 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16287 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.expect`` on any
16292 declare i1 @llvm.expect.i1(i1 <val>, i1 <expected_val>)
16293 declare i32 @llvm.expect.i32(i32 <val>, i32 <expected_val>)
16294 declare i64 @llvm.expect.i64(i64 <val>, i64 <expected_val>)
16299 The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic provides information about expected (the
16300 most probable) value of ``val``, which can be used by optimizers.
16305 The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic takes two arguments. The first argument is
16306 a value. The second argument is an expected value.
16311 This intrinsic is lowered to the ``val``.
16315 '``llvm.assume``' Intrinsic
16316 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16323 declare void @llvm.assume(i1 %cond)
16328 The ``llvm.assume`` allows the optimizer to assume that the provided
16329 condition is true. This information can then be used in simplifying other parts
16335 The condition which the optimizer may assume is always true.
16340 The intrinsic allows the optimizer to assume that the provided condition is
16341 always true whenever the control flow reaches the intrinsic call. No code is
16342 generated for this intrinsic, and instructions that contribute only to the
16343 provided condition are not used for code generation. If the condition is
16344 violated during execution, the behavior is undefined.
16346 Note that the optimizer might limit the transformations performed on values
16347 used by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic in order to preserve the instructions
16348 only used to form the intrinsic's input argument. This might prove undesirable
16349 if the extra information provided by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic does not cause
16350 sufficient overall improvement in code quality. For this reason,
16351 ``llvm.assume`` should not be used to document basic mathematical invariants
16352 that the optimizer can otherwise deduce or facts that are of little use to the
16357 '``llvm.ssa_copy``' Intrinsic
16358 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16365 declare type @llvm.ssa_copy(type %operand) returned(1) readnone
16370 The first argument is an operand which is used as the returned value.
16375 The ``llvm.ssa_copy`` intrinsic can be used to attach information to
16376 operations by copying them and giving them new names. For example,
16377 the PredicateInfo utility uses it to build Extended SSA form, and
16378 attach various forms of information to operands that dominate specific
16379 uses. It is not meant for general use, only for building temporary
16380 renaming forms that require value splits at certain points.
16384 '``llvm.type.test``' Intrinsic
16385 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16392 declare i1 @llvm.type.test(i8* %ptr, metadata %type) nounwind readnone
16398 The first argument is a pointer to be tested. The second argument is a
16399 metadata object representing a :doc:`type identifier <TypeMetadata>`.
16404 The ``llvm.type.test`` intrinsic tests whether the given pointer is associated
16405 with the given type identifier.
16407 '``llvm.type.checked.load``' Intrinsic
16408 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16415 declare {i8*, i1} @llvm.type.checked.load(i8* %ptr, i32 %offset, metadata %type) argmemonly nounwind readonly
16421 The first argument is a pointer from which to load a function pointer. The
16422 second argument is the byte offset from which to load the function pointer. The
16423 third argument is a metadata object representing a :doc:`type identifier
16429 The ``llvm.type.checked.load`` intrinsic safely loads a function pointer from a
16430 virtual table pointer using type metadata. This intrinsic is used to implement
16431 control flow integrity in conjunction with virtual call optimization. The
16432 virtual call optimization pass will optimize away ``llvm.type.checked.load``
16433 intrinsics associated with devirtualized calls, thereby removing the type
16434 check in cases where it is not needed to enforce the control flow integrity
16437 If the given pointer is associated with a type metadata identifier, this
16438 function returns true as the second element of its return value. (Note that
16439 the function may also return true if the given pointer is not associated
16440 with a type metadata identifier.) If the function's return value's second
16441 element is true, the following rules apply to the first element:
16443 - If the given pointer is associated with the given type metadata identifier,
16444 it is the function pointer loaded from the given byte offset from the given
16447 - If the given pointer is not associated with the given type metadata
16448 identifier, it is one of the following (the choice of which is unspecified):
16450 1. The function pointer that would have been loaded from an arbitrarily chosen
16451 (through an unspecified mechanism) pointer associated with the type
16454 2. If the function has a non-void return type, a pointer to a function that
16455 returns an unspecified value without causing side effects.
16457 If the function's return value's second element is false, the value of the
16458 first element is undefined.
16461 '``llvm.donothing``' Intrinsic
16462 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16469 declare void @llvm.donothing() nounwind readnone
16474 The ``llvm.donothing`` intrinsic doesn't perform any operation. It's one of only
16475 three intrinsics (besides ``llvm.experimental.patchpoint`` and
16476 ``llvm.experimental.gc.statepoint``) that can be called with an invoke
16487 This intrinsic does nothing, and it's removed by optimizers and ignored
16490 '``llvm.experimental.deoptimize``' Intrinsic
16491 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16498 declare type @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(...) [ "deopt"(...) ]
16503 This intrinsic, together with :ref:`deoptimization operand bundles
16504 <deopt_opbundles>`, allow frontends to express transfer of control and
16505 frame-local state from the currently executing (typically more specialized,
16506 hence faster) version of a function into another (typically more generic, hence
16509 In languages with a fully integrated managed runtime like Java and JavaScript
16510 this intrinsic can be used to implement "uncommon trap" or "side exit" like
16511 functionality. In unmanaged languages like C and C++, this intrinsic can be
16512 used to represent the slow paths of specialized functions.
16518 The intrinsic takes an arbitrary number of arguments, whose meaning is
16519 decided by the :ref:`lowering strategy<deoptimize_lowering>`.
16524 The ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` intrinsic executes an attached
16525 deoptimization continuation (denoted using a :ref:`deoptimization
16526 operand bundle <deopt_opbundles>`) and returns the value returned by
16527 the deoptimization continuation. Defining the semantic properties of
16528 the continuation itself is out of scope of the language reference --
16529 as far as LLVM is concerned, the deoptimization continuation can
16530 invoke arbitrary side effects, including reading from and writing to
16533 Deoptimization continuations expressed using ``"deopt"`` operand bundles always
16534 continue execution to the end of the physical frame containing them, so all
16535 calls to ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` must be in "tail position":
16537 - ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` cannot be invoked.
16538 - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction.
16539 - The ``ret`` instruction must return the value produced by the
16540 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` call if there is one, or void.
16542 Note that the above restrictions imply that the return type for a call to
16543 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` will match the return type of its immediate
16546 The inliner composes the ``"deopt"`` continuations of the caller into the
16547 ``"deopt"`` continuations present in the inlinee, and also updates calls to this
16548 intrinsic to return directly from the frame of the function it inlined into.
16550 All declarations of ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` must share the
16551 same calling convention.
16553 .. _deoptimize_lowering:
16558 Calls to ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` are lowered to calls to the
16559 symbol ``__llvm_deoptimize`` (it is the frontend's responsibility to
16560 ensure that this symbol is defined). The call arguments to
16561 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` are lowered as if they were formal
16562 arguments of the specified types, and not as varargs.
16565 '``llvm.experimental.guard``' Intrinsic
16566 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16573 declare void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1, ...) [ "deopt"(...) ]
16578 This intrinsic, together with :ref:`deoptimization operand bundles
16579 <deopt_opbundles>`, allows frontends to express guards or checks on
16580 optimistic assumptions made during compilation. The semantics of
16581 ``@llvm.experimental.guard`` is defined in terms of
16582 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` -- its body is defined to be
16585 .. code-block:: text
16587 define void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1 %pred, <args...>) {
16588 %realPred = and i1 %pred, undef
16589 br i1 %realPred, label %continue, label %leave [, !make.implicit !{}]
16592 call void @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(<args...>) [ "deopt"() ]
16600 with the optional ``[, !make.implicit !{}]`` present if and only if it
16601 is present on the call site. For more details on ``!make.implicit``,
16602 see :doc:`FaultMaps`.
16604 In words, ``@llvm.experimental.guard`` executes the attached
16605 ``"deopt"`` continuation if (but **not** only if) its first argument
16606 is ``false``. Since the optimizer is allowed to replace the ``undef``
16607 with an arbitrary value, it can optimize guard to fail "spuriously",
16608 i.e. without the original condition being false (hence the "not only
16609 if"); and this allows for "check widening" type optimizations.
16611 ``@llvm.experimental.guard`` cannot be invoked.
16614 '``llvm.experimental.widenable.condition``' Intrinsic
16615 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16622 declare i1 @llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()
16627 This intrinsic represents a "widenable condition" which is
16628 boolean expressions with the following property: whether this
16629 expression is `true` or `false`, the program is correct and
16632 Together with :ref:`deoptimization operand bundles <deopt_opbundles>`,
16633 ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition`` allows frontends to
16634 express guards or checks on optimistic assumptions made during
16635 compilation and represent them as branch instructions on special
16638 While this may appear similar in semantics to `undef`, it is very
16639 different in that an invocation produces a particular, singular
16640 value. It is also intended to be lowered late, and remain available
16641 for specific optimizations and transforms that can benefit from its
16642 special properties.
16652 The intrinsic ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()``
16653 returns either `true` or `false`. For each evaluation of a call
16654 to this intrinsic, the program must be valid and correct both if
16655 it returns `true` and if it returns `false`. This allows
16656 transformation passes to replace evaluations of this intrinsic
16657 with either value whenever one is beneficial.
16659 When used in a branch condition, it allows us to choose between
16660 two alternative correct solutions for the same problem, like
16663 .. code-block:: text
16665 %cond = call i1 @llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()
16666 br i1 %cond, label %solution_1, label %solution_2
16669 ; Apply memory-consuming but fast solution for a task.
16672 ; Cheap in memory but slow solution.
16674 Whether the result of intrinsic's call is `true` or `false`,
16675 it should be correct to pick either solution. We can switch
16676 between them by replacing the result of
16677 ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition`` with different
16680 This is how it can be used to represent guards as widenable branches:
16682 .. code-block:: text
16685 ; Unguarded instructions
16686 call void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1 %cond, <args...>) ["deopt"(<deopt_args...>)]
16687 ; Guarded instructions
16689 Can be expressed in an alternative equivalent form of explicit branch using
16690 ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition``:
16692 .. code-block:: text
16695 ; Unguarded instructions
16696 %widenable_condition = call i1 @llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()
16697 %guard_condition = and i1 %cond, %widenable_condition
16698 br i1 %guard_condition, label %guarded, label %deopt
16701 ; Guarded instructions
16704 call type @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(<args...>) [ "deopt"(<deopt_args...>) ]
16706 So the block `guarded` is only reachable when `%cond` is `true`,
16707 and it should be valid to go to the block `deopt` whenever `%cond`
16708 is `true` or `false`.
16710 ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition`` will never throw, thus
16711 it cannot be invoked.
16716 When ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()`` is used in
16717 condition of a guard represented as explicit branch, it is
16718 legal to widen the guard's condition with any additional
16721 Guard widening looks like replacement of
16723 .. code-block:: text
16725 %widenable_cond = call i1 @llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()
16726 %guard_cond = and i1 %cond, %widenable_cond
16727 br i1 %guard_cond, label %guarded, label %deopt
16731 .. code-block:: text
16733 %widenable_cond = call i1 @llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()
16734 %new_cond = and i1 %any_other_cond, %widenable_cond
16735 %new_guard_cond = and i1 %cond, %new_cond
16736 br i1 %new_guard_cond, label %guarded, label %deopt
16738 for this branch. Here `%any_other_cond` is an arbitrarily chosen
16739 well-defined `i1` value. By making guard widening, we may
16740 impose stricter conditions on `guarded` block and bail to the
16741 deopt when the new condition is not met.
16746 Default lowering strategy is replacing the result of
16747 call of ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition`` with
16748 constant `true`. However it is always correct to replace
16749 it with any other `i1` value. Any pass can
16750 freely do it if it can benefit from non-default lowering.
16753 '``llvm.load.relative``' Intrinsic
16754 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16761 declare i8* @llvm.load.relative.iN(i8* %ptr, iN %offset) argmemonly nounwind readonly
16766 This intrinsic loads a 32-bit value from the address ``%ptr + %offset``,
16767 adds ``%ptr`` to that value and returns it. The constant folder specifically
16768 recognizes the form of this intrinsic and the constant initializers it may
16769 load from; if a loaded constant initializer is known to have the form
16770 ``i32 trunc(x - %ptr)``, the intrinsic call is folded to ``x``.
16772 LLVM provides that the calculation of such a constant initializer will
16773 not overflow at link time under the medium code model if ``x`` is an
16774 ``unnamed_addr`` function. However, it does not provide this guarantee for
16775 a constant initializer folded into a function body. This intrinsic can be
16776 used to avoid the possibility of overflows when loading from such a constant.
16778 '``llvm.sideeffect``' Intrinsic
16779 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16786 declare void @llvm.sideeffect() inaccessiblememonly nounwind
16791 The ``llvm.sideeffect`` intrinsic doesn't perform any operation. Optimizers
16792 treat it as having side effects, so it can be inserted into a loop to
16793 indicate that the loop shouldn't be assumed to terminate (which could
16794 potentially lead to the loop being optimized away entirely), even if it's
16795 an infinite loop with no other side effects.
16805 This intrinsic actually does nothing, but optimizers must assume that it
16806 has externally observable side effects.
16808 '``llvm.is.constant.*``' Intrinsic
16809 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16814 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.is.constant with any argument type.
16818 declare i1 @llvm.is.constant.i32(i32 %operand) nounwind readnone
16819 declare i1 @llvm.is.constant.f32(float %operand) nounwind readnone
16820 declare i1 @llvm.is.constant.TYPENAME(TYPE %operand) nounwind readnone
16825 The '``llvm.is.constant``' intrinsic will return true if the argument
16826 is known to be a manifest compile-time constant. It is guaranteed to
16827 fold to either true or false before generating machine code.
16832 This intrinsic generates no code. If its argument is known to be a
16833 manifest compile-time constant value, then the intrinsic will be
16834 converted to a constant true value. Otherwise, it will be converted to
16835 a constant false value.
16837 In particular, note that if the argument is a constant expression
16838 which refers to a global (the address of which _is_ a constant, but
16839 not manifest during the compile), then the intrinsic evaluates to
16842 The result also intentionally depends on the result of optimization
16843 passes -- e.g., the result can change depending on whether a
16844 function gets inlined or not. A function's parameters are
16845 obviously not constant. However, a call like
16846 ``llvm.is.constant.i32(i32 %param)`` *can* return true after the
16847 function is inlined, if the value passed to the function parameter was
16850 On the other hand, if constant folding is not run, it will never
16851 evaluate to true, even in simple cases.
16853 Stack Map Intrinsics
16854 --------------------
16856 LLVM provides experimental intrinsics to support runtime patching
16857 mechanisms commonly desired in dynamic language JITs. These intrinsics
16858 are described in :doc:`StackMaps`.
16860 Element Wise Atomic Memory Intrinsics
16861 -------------------------------------
16863 These intrinsics are similar to the standard library memory intrinsics except
16864 that they perform memory transfer as a sequence of atomic memory accesses.
16866 .. _int_memcpy_element_unordered_atomic:
16868 '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic``' Intrinsic
16869 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16874 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic`` on
16875 any integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
16876 support all bit widths however.
16880 declare void @llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>,
16883 i32 <element_size>)
16884 declare void @llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>,
16887 i32 <element_size>)
16892 The '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic is a specialization of the
16893 '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsic. It differs in that the ``dest`` and ``src`` are treated
16894 as arrays with elements that are exactly ``element_size`` bytes, and the copy between
16895 buffers uses a sequence of :ref:`unordered atomic <ordering>` load/store operations
16896 that are a positive integer multiple of the ``element_size`` in size.
16901 The first three arguments are the same as they are in the :ref:`@llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`
16902 intrinsic, with the added constraint that ``len`` is required to be a positive integer
16903 multiple of the ``element_size``. If ``len`` is not a positive integer multiple of
16904 ``element_size``, then the behaviour of the intrinsic is undefined.
16906 ``element_size`` must be a compile-time constant positive power of two no greater than
16907 target-specific atomic access size limit.
16909 For each of the input pointers ``align`` parameter attribute must be specified. It
16910 must be a power of two no less than the ``element_size``. Caller guarantees that
16911 both the source and destination pointers are aligned to that boundary.
16916 The '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic copies ``len`` bytes of
16917 memory from the source location to the destination location. These locations are not
16918 allowed to overlap. The memory copy is performed as a sequence of load/store operations
16919 where each access is guaranteed to be a multiple of ``element_size`` bytes wide and
16920 aligned at an ``element_size`` boundary.
16922 The order of the copy is unspecified. The same value may be read from the source
16923 buffer many times, but only one write is issued to the destination buffer per
16924 element. It is well defined to have concurrent reads and writes to both source and
16925 destination provided those reads and writes are unordered atomic when specified.
16927 This intrinsic does not provide any additional ordering guarantees over those
16928 provided by a set of unordered loads from the source location and stores to the
16934 In the most general case call to the '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.*``' is
16935 lowered to a call to the symbol ``__llvm_memcpy_element_unordered_atomic_*``. Where '*'
16936 is replaced with an actual element size.
16938 Optimizer is allowed to inline memory copy when it's profitable to do so.
16940 '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic``' Intrinsic
16941 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16946 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use
16947 ``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic`` on any integer bit width and for
16948 different address spaces. Not all targets support all bit widths however.
16952 declare void @llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>,
16955 i32 <element_size>)
16956 declare void @llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>,
16959 i32 <element_size>)
16964 The '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic is a specialization
16965 of the '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsic. It differs in that the ``dest`` and
16966 ``src`` are treated as arrays with elements that are exactly ``element_size``
16967 bytes, and the copy between buffers uses a sequence of
16968 :ref:`unordered atomic <ordering>` load/store operations that are a positive
16969 integer multiple of the ``element_size`` in size.
16974 The first three arguments are the same as they are in the
16975 :ref:`@llvm.memmove <int_memmove>` intrinsic, with the added constraint that
16976 ``len`` is required to be a positive integer multiple of the ``element_size``.
16977 If ``len`` is not a positive integer multiple of ``element_size``, then the
16978 behaviour of the intrinsic is undefined.
16980 ``element_size`` must be a compile-time constant positive power of two no
16981 greater than a target-specific atomic access size limit.
16983 For each of the input pointers the ``align`` parameter attribute must be
16984 specified. It must be a power of two no less than the ``element_size``. Caller
16985 guarantees that both the source and destination pointers are aligned to that
16991 The '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic copies ``len`` bytes
16992 of memory from the source location to the destination location. These locations
16993 are allowed to overlap. The memory copy is performed as a sequence of load/store
16994 operations where each access is guaranteed to be a multiple of ``element_size``
16995 bytes wide and aligned at an ``element_size`` boundary.
16997 The order of the copy is unspecified. The same value may be read from the source
16998 buffer many times, but only one write is issued to the destination buffer per
16999 element. It is well defined to have concurrent reads and writes to both source
17000 and destination provided those reads and writes are unordered atomic when
17003 This intrinsic does not provide any additional ordering guarantees over those
17004 provided by a set of unordered loads from the source location and stores to the
17010 In the most general case call to the
17011 '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.*``' is lowered to a call to the symbol
17012 ``__llvm_memmove_element_unordered_atomic_*``. Where '*' is replaced with an
17013 actual element size.
17015 The optimizer is allowed to inline the memory copy when it's profitable to do so.
17017 .. _int_memset_element_unordered_atomic:
17019 '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic``' Intrinsic
17020 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17025 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic`` on
17026 any integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
17027 support all bit widths however.
17031 declare void @llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>,
17034 i32 <element_size>)
17035 declare void @llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>,
17038 i32 <element_size>)
17043 The '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic is a specialization of the
17044 '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsic. It differs in that the ``dest`` is treated as an array
17045 with elements that are exactly ``element_size`` bytes, and the assignment to that array
17046 uses uses a sequence of :ref:`unordered atomic <ordering>` store operations
17047 that are a positive integer multiple of the ``element_size`` in size.
17052 The first three arguments are the same as they are in the :ref:`@llvm.memset <int_memset>`
17053 intrinsic, with the added constraint that ``len`` is required to be a positive integer
17054 multiple of the ``element_size``. If ``len`` is not a positive integer multiple of
17055 ``element_size``, then the behaviour of the intrinsic is undefined.
17057 ``element_size`` must be a compile-time constant positive power of two no greater than
17058 target-specific atomic access size limit.
17060 The ``dest`` input pointer must have the ``align`` parameter attribute specified. It
17061 must be a power of two no less than the ``element_size``. Caller guarantees that
17062 the destination pointer is aligned to that boundary.
17067 The '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic sets the ``len`` bytes of
17068 memory starting at the destination location to the given ``value``. The memory is
17069 set with a sequence of store operations where each access is guaranteed to be a
17070 multiple of ``element_size`` bytes wide and aligned at an ``element_size`` boundary.
17072 The order of the assignment is unspecified. Only one write is issued to the
17073 destination buffer per element. It is well defined to have concurrent reads and
17074 writes to the destination provided those reads and writes are unordered atomic
17077 This intrinsic does not provide any additional ordering guarantees over those
17078 provided by a set of unordered stores to the destination.
17083 In the most general case call to the '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.*``' is
17084 lowered to a call to the symbol ``__llvm_memset_element_unordered_atomic_*``. Where '*'
17085 is replaced with an actual element size.
17087 The optimizer is allowed to inline the memory assignment when it's profitable to do so.
17089 Objective-C ARC Runtime Intrinsics
17090 ----------------------------------
17092 LLVM provides intrinsics that lower to Objective-C ARC runtime entry points.
17093 LLVM is aware of the semantics of these functions, and optimizes based on that
17094 knowledge. You can read more about the details of Objective-C ARC `here
17095 <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html>`_.
17097 '``llvm.objc.autorelease``' Intrinsic
17098 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17104 declare i8* @llvm.objc.autorelease(i8*)
17109 Lowers to a call to `objc_autorelease <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-autorelease>`_.
17111 '``llvm.objc.autoreleasePoolPop``' Intrinsic
17112 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17118 declare void @llvm.objc.autoreleasePoolPop(i8*)
17123 Lowers to a call to `objc_autoreleasePoolPop <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-autoreleasepoolpop-void-pool>`_.
17125 '``llvm.objc.autoreleasePoolPush``' Intrinsic
17126 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17132 declare i8* @llvm.objc.autoreleasePoolPush()
17137 Lowers to a call to `objc_autoreleasePoolPush <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-autoreleasepoolpush-void>`_.
17139 '``llvm.objc.autoreleaseReturnValue``' Intrinsic
17140 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17146 declare i8* @llvm.objc.autoreleaseReturnValue(i8*)
17151 Lowers to a call to `objc_autoreleaseReturnValue <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-autoreleasereturnvalue>`_.
17153 '``llvm.objc.copyWeak``' Intrinsic
17154 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17160 declare void @llvm.objc.copyWeak(i8**, i8**)
17165 Lowers to a call to `objc_copyWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-copyweak-id-dest-id-src>`_.
17167 '``llvm.objc.destroyWeak``' Intrinsic
17168 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17174 declare void @llvm.objc.destroyWeak(i8**)
17179 Lowers to a call to `objc_destroyWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-destroyweak-id-object>`_.
17181 '``llvm.objc.initWeak``' Intrinsic
17182 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17188 declare i8* @llvm.objc.initWeak(i8**, i8*)
17193 Lowers to a call to `objc_initWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-initweak>`_.
17195 '``llvm.objc.loadWeak``' Intrinsic
17196 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17202 declare i8* @llvm.objc.loadWeak(i8**)
17207 Lowers to a call to `objc_loadWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-loadweak>`_.
17209 '``llvm.objc.loadWeakRetained``' Intrinsic
17210 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17216 declare i8* @llvm.objc.loadWeakRetained(i8**)
17221 Lowers to a call to `objc_loadWeakRetained <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-loadweakretained>`_.
17223 '``llvm.objc.moveWeak``' Intrinsic
17224 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17230 declare void @llvm.objc.moveWeak(i8**, i8**)
17235 Lowers to a call to `objc_moveWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-moveweak-id-dest-id-src>`_.
17237 '``llvm.objc.release``' Intrinsic
17238 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17244 declare void @llvm.objc.release(i8*)
17249 Lowers to a call to `objc_release <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-release-id-value>`_.
17251 '``llvm.objc.retain``' Intrinsic
17252 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17258 declare i8* @llvm.objc.retain(i8*)
17263 Lowers to a call to `objc_retain <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-retain>`_.
17265 '``llvm.objc.retainAutorelease``' Intrinsic
17266 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17272 declare i8* @llvm.objc.retainAutorelease(i8*)
17277 Lowers to a call to `objc_retainAutorelease <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-retainautorelease>`_.
17279 '``llvm.objc.retainAutoreleaseReturnValue``' Intrinsic
17280 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17286 declare i8* @llvm.objc.retainAutoreleaseReturnValue(i8*)
17291 Lowers to a call to `objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-retainautoreleasereturnvalue>`_.
17293 '``llvm.objc.retainAutoreleasedReturnValue``' Intrinsic
17294 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17300 declare i8* @llvm.objc.retainAutoreleasedReturnValue(i8*)
17305 Lowers to a call to `objc_retainAutoreleasedReturnValue <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-retainautoreleasedreturnvalue>`_.
17307 '``llvm.objc.retainBlock``' Intrinsic
17308 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17314 declare i8* @llvm.objc.retainBlock(i8*)
17319 Lowers to a call to `objc_retainBlock <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-retainblock>`_.
17321 '``llvm.objc.storeStrong``' Intrinsic
17322 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17328 declare void @llvm.objc.storeStrong(i8**, i8*)
17333 Lowers to a call to `objc_storeStrong <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-storestrong-id-object-id-value>`_.
17335 '``llvm.objc.storeWeak``' Intrinsic
17336 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17342 declare i8* @llvm.objc.storeWeak(i8**, i8*)
17347 Lowers to a call to `objc_storeWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-storeweak>`_.
17349 Preserving Debug Information Intrinsics
17350 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17352 These intrinsics are used to carry certain debuginfo together with
17353 IR-level operations. For example, it may be desirable to
17354 know the structure/union name and the original user-level field
17355 indices. Such information got lost in IR GetElementPtr instruction
17356 since the IR types are different from debugInfo types and unions
17357 are converted to structs in IR.
17359 '``llvm.preserve.array.access.index``' Intrinsic
17360 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17367 @llvm.preserve.array.access.index.p0s_union.anons.p0a10s_union.anons(<type> base,
17374 The '``llvm.preserve.array.access.index``' intrinsic returns the getelementptr address
17375 based on array base ``base``, array dimension ``dim`` and the last access index ``index``
17376 into the array. The return type ``ret_type`` is a pointer type to the array element.
17377 The array ``dim`` and ``index`` are preserved which is more robust than
17378 getelementptr instruction which may be subject to compiler transformation.
17383 The ``base`` is the array base address. The ``dim`` is the array dimension.
17384 The ``base`` is a pointer if ``dim`` equals 0.
17385 The ``index`` is the last access index into the array or pointer.
17390 The '``llvm.preserve.array.access.index``' intrinsic produces the same result
17391 as a getelementptr with base ``base`` and access operands ``{dim's 0's, index}``.
17393 '``llvm.preserve.union.access.index``' Intrinsic
17394 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17401 @llvm.preserve.union.access.index.p0s_union.anons.p0s_union.anons(<type> base,
17407 The '``llvm.preserve.union.access.index``' intrinsic carries the debuginfo field index
17408 ``di_index`` and returns the ``base`` address.
17409 The ``llvm.preserve.access.index`` type of metadata is attached to this call instruction
17410 to provide union debuginfo type.
17411 The metadata is a ``DICompositeType`` representing the debuginfo version of ``type``.
17412 The return type ``type`` is the same as the ``base`` type.
17417 The ``base`` is the union base address. The ``di_index`` is the field index in debuginfo.
17422 The '``llvm.preserve.union.access.index``' intrinsic returns the ``base`` address.
17424 '``llvm.preserve.struct.access.index``' Intrinsic
17425 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17432 @llvm.preserve.struct.access.index.p0i8.p0s_struct.anon.0s(<type> base,
17439 The '``llvm.preserve.struct.access.index``' intrinsic returns the getelementptr address
17440 based on struct base ``base`` and IR struct member index ``gep_index``.
17441 The ``llvm.preserve.access.index`` type of metadata is attached to this call instruction
17442 to provide struct debuginfo type.
17443 The metadata is a ``DICompositeType`` representing the debuginfo version of ``type``.
17444 The return type ``ret_type`` is a pointer type to the structure member.
17449 The ``base`` is the structure base address. The ``gep_index`` is the struct member index
17450 based on IR structures. The ``di_index`` is the struct member index based on debuginfo.
17455 The '``llvm.preserve.struct.access.index``' intrinsic produces the same result
17456 as a getelementptr with base ``base`` and access operands ``{0, gep_index}``.